Você está na página 1de 369

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MCC-TII Type Engines

Engine Selection Guide

Camshaft Controlled
Twostroke Engines

This Project Guide is intended to provide the information necessary for the layout of a marine propulsion
plant.

The information is to be considered as preliminary. It is intended for the project stage only and subject to
modification in the interest of technical progress. The Project Guide provides the general technical data
available at the date of issue.

It should be noted that all figures, values, measurements or information about performance stated in this
project guide are for guidance only and should not be used for detailed design purposes or as a substi-
tute for specific drawings and instructions prepared for such purposes.

Data updates
Data not finally calculated at the time of issue is marked Available on request. Such data may be made
available at a later date, however, for a specific project the data can be requested. Pages and table entries
marked Not applicable represent an option, function or selection which is not valid.

The latest, most current version of the individual Project Guide sections are available on the Internet at:
www.mandieselturbo.com under Products Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed.

Extent of Delivery
The final and binding design and outlines are to be supplied by our licensee, the engine maker, see Chap-
ter 20 of this Project Guide.

In order to facilitate negotiations between the yard, the engine maker and the customer, a set of Extent of
Delivery forms is available in which the basic and the optional executions are specified.

Electronic versions
This Project Guide book and the Extent of Delivery forms are available on a DVD and can also be found
on the Internet at: www.mandieselturbo.com under Products Marine Engines & Systems Low
Speed, where they can be downloaded.

1st Edition
June 2010

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide 198 79 51-0.1


All data provided in this document is non-binding. This data serves informational purposes only and is espe-
cially not guaranteed in any way.

Depending on the subsequent specific individual projects, the relevant data may be subject to changes and will
be assessed and determined individually for each project. This will depend on the particular characteristics of
each individual project, especially specific site and operational conditions.

If this document is delivered in another language than English and doubts arise concerning the translation, the
English text shall prevail.

MAN Diesel & Turbo


Teglholmsgade 41
DK2450 Copenhagen SV
Denmark
Telephone +45 33 85 11 00
Telefax +45 33 85 10 30
mandiesel-cph@mandiesel.com
www.mandieselturbo.com

Copyright 2010 MAN Diesel & Turbo, branch of MAN Diesel & Turbo SE, Germany, registered with the Danish
Commerce and Companies Agency under CVR Nr.: 31611792, (herein referred to as MAN Diesel & Turbo).

This document is the product and property of MAN Diesel & Turbo and is protected by applicable copyright laws.
Subject to modification in the interest of technical progress. Reproduction permitted provided source is given.
7010-0003-00ppr Jun 2010

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide 198 79 51-0.1


MAN B&W Contents

Engine Design......................................................................... 1
Engine Layout and Load Diagrams, SFOC .............................. 2
Turbocharger Selection & Exhaust Gas By-pass ..................... 3
Electricity Production ............................................................. 4
Installation Aspects................................................................. 5
List of Capacities: Pumps, Coolers & Exhaust Gas .................. 6
Fuel ....................................................................................... 7
Lubricating Oil ....................................................................... 8
Cylinder Lubrication . ............................................................. 9
Piston Rod Stuffing Box Drain Oil ........................................... 10
Central Cooling Water System . .............................................. 11
Seawater Cooling .................................................................. 12
Starting and Control Air . ........................................................ 13
Scavenge Air ......................................................................... 14
Exhaust Gas .......................................................................... 15
Engine Control System . ......................................................... 16
Vibration Aspects ................................................................... 17
Appendix ............................................................................... A

MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Contents

Chapter Section
1 Engine Design
The MC/MC-C Tier II Engine 1.01 1987468-2.1
Engine type designation 1.02 1983824-3.6
Power, Speed, Dimensions 1.03 1987942-6.0
Engine power range and fuel oil consumption 1.04 1985556-9.1
Performance curves 1.05 1985331-6.2
MC Engine description 1.06 1987471-6.1
Engine cross section, referral to PG 1.07 1985886-4.0

2 Engine Layout and Load Diagrams, SFOC
Engine layout and load diagrams 2.01 1983833-8.4
Propeller diameter and pitch, influence on optimum propeller speed 2.02 1983878-2.5
Layout diagram sizes 2.03 1986911-0.1
Engine layout and load diagrams, MC/MC-C engines 2.04 1986994-7.1
Diagram for actual project 2.05 1986908-7.1
Specific fuel oil consumption, ME versus MC engines 2.06 1985310-1.0
SFOC for high efficiency turbochargers 2.07 1987012-8.0
SFOC, reference conditions and guarantee 2.08 1987464-5.0
Examples of graphic calculation of SFOC 2.08 1987018-9.0
SFOC calculations 2.09 1987955-8.0
SFOC calculations, example 2.10 1986979-3.0
Fuel consumption at an arbitrary load 2.11 1986631-7.0
Emission control 2.12 1986636-6.2

3 Turbocharger Selection & Exhaust Gas By-pass
Turbocharger selection 3.01 1987618-1.1
Exhaust gas by-pass 3.02 1985895-9.0
NOx Reduction by SCR 3.03 1985894-7.2

4 Electricity Production
Electricity production 4.01 1985911-6.1
Designation of PTO 4.01 1986633-0.1
PTO/RCF 4.01 1984300-0.2
Space requirements for side mounted PTO/RCF for
K98MC/ME7 4.02 1984303-6.1
K98MC-C/ME-C7 4.02 1984324-0.1
S90MC-C/ME-C8 4.02 1984304-8.1
K90MC-C/ME-C6 4.02 1984325-2.1
S80MC-C/ME-C8 4.02 1984308-5.1
K80MC-C/ME-C6 4.02 1984309-7.1
S70MC-C/ME-C8/-GI 4.02 1984310-7.2
L70MC-C/ME-C8 4.02 1984311-9.1
S60MC-C/ME-C8/-GI 4.02 1984321-5.2
L60MC-C/ME-C8 4.02 1984313-2.1
S50MC-C/ME-C8 4.02 1984314-4.1
Engine preparations for PTO 4.03 1984315-6.2
PTO/BW GCR 4.04 1984316-8.6
Waste Heat Recovery Systems (WHR) 4.05 1985912-8.3

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Contents

Chapter Section
4 Electricity Production
L16/24 GenSet data 4.06 1984205-4.5
L21/31 GenSet data 4.07 1984206-6.5
L23/30H GenSet data 4.08 1984207-8.5
L27/38 GenSet data 4.09 1984209-1.5
L28/32H GenSet data 4.10 1984210-1.5
L32/40 GenSet data 4.11 1984211-3.2

5 Installation Aspects
Space requirements and overhaul heights 5.01 1984375-4.7
Space requirement for
K98MC7 5.02 1985991-7.0
K98MC-C7 5.02 1985992-9.0
S90MC-C8 5.02 1985990-5.0
K90MC-C6 5.02 1985772-5.0
S80MC-C8 5.02 1985989-5.0
K80MC-C6 5.02 1985775-0.0
S70MC-C8 5.02 1985983-4.0
L70MC-C8 5.02 1986652-1.0
S60MC-C8 5.02 1985779-8.0
L60MC-C8 5.02 1985980-9.0
S50MC-C8 5.02 1985979-9.0
Crane beam for overhaul of turbochargers 5.03 1987962-9.0
Crane beam for turbochargers 5.03 1984848-8.2
Engine room crane 5.04 1987943-8.0
Engine outline 5.05 1984731-3.3
Gallery outline 5.06 1984854-7.2
Centre of gravity 5.07 1984832-0.1
Water and oil in engine 5.08 1984831-9.1
Engine pipe connections 5.09 1984833-2.1
Counterflanges 5.10 1984834-4.1
Engine seating and holding down bolts 5.11 1984923-1.2
Engine seating profile 5.12 1987945-1.0
Engine top bracing 5.13 1984672-5.8
Mechanical top bracing 5.14 1987940-2.0
Hydraulic top bracing arrangement 5.15 1987938-0.0
Components for Engine Control System 5.16 1986030-2.0
Shaftline earthing device 5.17 1984929-2.4
MAN Diesels Alpha Controllable Pitch (CP) propeller 5.18 1987950-9.0
Hydraulic Power Unit for Alpha CP propeller 5.18 1985320-8.2
Alphatronic 2000 Propulsion Control System 5.18 1985322-1.3

6 List of Capacities: Pumps, Coolers & Exhaust Gas
Calculation of capacities 6.01 1987947-5.0
List of capacities and cooling water systems 6.02 1987463-3.0
List of capacities 6.03 1987948-7.0
List of capacities, S70MC-C8 6.03 1987092-9.0
Auxiliary system capacities for derated engines 6.04 1987149-5.0
Pump capacities, pressures and flow velocities 6.04 1987941-4.0
Example 1, Pumps and Cooler Capacity 6.04 1987217-8.0

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Contents

Chapter Section
6 List of Capacities: Pumps, Coolers & Exhaust Gas
Freshwater generator 6.04 1987141-0.0
Example 2, Fresh Water Production 6.04 1987219-1.0
Calculation of exhaust gas amount and temperature 6.04 1986176-4.0
Diagram for change of exhaust gas amount 6.04 1986177-6.0
Example 3, Expected Exhaust Gas 6.04 1987220-1.0

7 Fuel
Fuel oil system 7.01 1985639-7.2
Fuel oils 7.02 1983880-4.5
Fuel oil pipes and drain pipes 7.03 1985905-7.0
Fuel oil pipe insulation 7.04 1984051-8.3
Components for fuel oil system 7.05 1983951-2.6
Components for fuel oil system, venting box 7.05 1984735-0.2
Water in fuel emulsification 7.06 1983882-8.4

8 Lubricating Oil
Lubricating and cooling oil system 8.01 1985636-1.1
Lubricating and cooling oil pipes 8.01 1985909-4.0
Hydraulic Power Supply unit 8.02 1985637-3.0
Lubricating oil pipes for turbochargers 8.03 1984232-8.3
Lubricating oil centrifuges and list of lubricating oils 8.04 1983886-5.6
Components for lube oil system 8.05 1983887-7.4
Lubricating oil tank 8.06 1984855-9.1
Crankcase venting and bedplate drain pipes 8.07 1984856-0.1

9 Cylinder Lubrication
Cylinder lubricating oil system 9.01 1987946-3.0
MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubrication system 9.02 1987949-9.0
Alpha Adaptive Cylinder Oil Control (Alpha ACC) 9.02 1987997-7.0
MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubrication system for
K98MC/MC-C7, S90MC-C8, K90MC-C6 9.02 1986417-4.0
S80MC-C8, K80MC-C6 9.02 1986418-6.0
S/L70MC-C8 9.02 1986419-8.0
S/L60MC-C8 9.02 1986420-8.0
S50MC-C8 9.02 1986422-1.0
Mechanical cylinder lubricators 9.03 1987999-9.0
Cylinder lubricating oil supply system 9.03 1986598-2.0

10 Piston Rod Stuffing Box Drain Oil
Stuffing box drain oil system 10.01 1983974-0.5

11 Central Cooling Water System
Central cooling water system 11.01-02 1984696-5.4
Components for central cooling water system 11.03 1983987-2.5

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Contents

Chapter Section
12 Seawater Cooling
Seawater systems 12.01 1983892-4.4
Seawater cooling system 12.02 1983893-6.5
Seawater cooling pipes 12.03 1984930-2.1
Components for seawater cooling system 12.04 1983981-1.3
Jacket cooling water system 12.05 1983894-8.6
Jacket cooling water pipes 12.06 1984931-4.1
Components for jacket cooling water system 12.07 1983896-1.4
Temperature at start of engine 12.08 1983986-0.2

13 Starting and Control Air
Starting and control air systems 13.01 1983898-5.4
Components for starting air system 13.02 1986048-3.0
Starting and control air pipes 13.03 1985903-3.2

14 Scavenge Air
Scavenge air system 14.01 1984860-6.3
Auxiliary blowers 14.02 1986586-2.3
Operation panel for auxiliary blowers 14.02 1986587-4.0
Scavenge air pipes 14.03 1984863-1.1
Electric motor for auxiliary blower 14.04 1984864-3.1
Scavenge air cooler cleaning system 14.05 1987684-9.0
Scavenge air box drain system 14.06 1983913-0.5
Fire extinguishing system for scavenge air space 14.07 1984865-5.4

15 Exhaust Gas
Exhaust gas system 15.01 1983904-6.3
Exhaust gas pipes 15.02 1984070-9.3
Cleaning systems, MAN 15.02 1984071-0.5
Cleaning systems, water and soft blast 15.02 1987916-4.0
Cleaning systems, ABB and Mitsubishi 15.02 1984072-2.3
Exhaust gas system for main engine 15.03 1983905-8.2
Components of the exhaust gas system 15.04 1983907-1.2
Exhaust gas silencer 15.04 1984077-1.1

16 Engine Control System
Engine Control System MC/MC-C 16.01 1985634-8.2
Diagram of manoeuvring system 16.01 1987902-0.0
Manoeuvring system on engine 16.01 1987905-6.0
Sequence diagram 16.01 1987908-1.0
Governor parts and mode of operation 16.01 1987909-3.0
Governor and remote control components 16.01 1987911-5.0
Sequence diagram for Fixed Pitch Propeller 16.01 1986637-8.1
Controllable Pitch Propeller 16.02 1987975-0.0
Engine Control System interface to surrounding systems 16.03 1986641-3.1

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Contents

Chapter Section
17 Vibration Aspects
Vibration aspects 17.01 1984140-5.3
2nd order moments on 4, 5 and 6-cylinder engines 17.02 1988002-6.0
Electrically driven moment compensator 17.03 1984222-1.5
Power Related Unbalance (PRU) 17.04 1984673-7.2
Guide force moments 17.05 1984223-3.4
Guide force moments, data 17.05 1985904-5.3
Axial vibrations 17.06 1984224-5.4
Critical running 17.06 1984226-9.3
External forces and moments in layout point for
K98MC7 17.07 1985948-8.1
K98MC-C7 17.07 1985927-3.0
S90MC-C8 17.07 1985929-7.1
K90MC-C6 17.07 1985931-1.0
S80MC-C8 17.07 1985932-0.0
K80MC-C6 17.07 1985934-4.0
S70MC-C8 17.07 1985935-6.0
L70MC-C8 17.07 1985938-1.0
S60MC-C8 17.07 1985940-3.0
L60MC-C8 17.07 1985942-7.0
S50MC-C8 17.07 1985944-0.0

A Appendix
Symbols for piping A 1983866-2.3

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Index

Subject Section Subject Section


2nd order moment compensators............................17.02 C
2nd order moments on 4, 5 and 6-cylinder Central cooling water pumps...................................11.03
engines ...............................................................17.02 Central cooling water system . .......................... 11.01-02
Central cooling water thermostatic valve.................11.03
A Centre of gravity ........................................................5.07
Air cooler cleaning pipes..........................................14.05 Centrifuges, fuel oil.....................................................7.05
Air cooler cleaning unit.............................................14.05 Chain drive.................................................................1.06
Air spring, exhaust valve..........................................13.03 Cleaning systems, ABB and Mitsubishi ..................15.02
Alarm system.................................................16.01, 16.03 Cleaning systems, MAN ..........................................15.02
Alpha ACC, Alpha Adaptive Cylinder Oil Control.......9.02 Cleaning systems, water and soft blast ..................15.02
Alpha ACC, basic and minimum setting with.............9.02 Combined turbines.....................................................4.05
Alpha Adaptive Cylinder Oil Control (Alpha ACC) .....9.02 Compensator solutions, 2nd order moments..........17.02
Alpha Controllable Pitch (CP) propeller, Compensators (2nd order moments),
MAN Diesels..........................................................5.18 preparation for.....................................................17.02
Alpha CP propeller, Hydraulic Power Unit for............5.18 Components for central cooling water system ......11.03
Alphatronic 2000 Propulsion Control System ...........5.18 Components for Engine Control System ..................5.16
Arctic running condition.............................................3.02 Components for fuel oil system ................................7.05
Auto Pump Overboard System................................14.05 Components for fuel oil system, venting box ...........7.05
Auxiliary blower..........................................................1.06 Components for jacket cooling water system . .......12.07
Auxiliary blower control............................................14.02 Components for lube oil system ...............................8.05
Auxiliary blower, electric motor for...........................14.04 Components for seawater cooling system .............12.04
Auxiliary blower, operation panel for........................14.02 Components for starting air system ........................13.02
Auxiliary blowers .....................................................14.02 Components of the exhaust gas system ................15.04
Auxiliary blowers, emergency running......................14.02 Connecting rod...........................................................1.06
Auxiliary equipment system..........................16.01, 16.03 Constant ship speed lines..........................................2.01
Auxiliary Propulsion System/Take Home System......4.04 Consumption, cylinder oil...........................................1.03
Auxiliary system capacities for derated engines .......6.04 Consumption, lubricating oil......................................1.03
Axial vibration damper................................................1.06 Continuous service rating (S).....................................2.04
Axial vibrations ........................................................17.06 Control system for plants with CPP.........................16.01
Controllable Pitch Propeller ....................................16.02
B Cooler heat dissipations.............................................6.04
Balancing 1st order moments..................................17.02 Cooler, central cooling..............................................11.03
Balancing other forces and moments......................17.03 Cooler, jacket water.......................................11.03, 12.04
Basic and minimum setting with Alpha ACC.............9.02 Cooler, lubricating oil.......................................8.05, 11.03
Bedplate.....................................................................1.06 Cooler, scavenge air......................................11.03, 12.04
Bedplate drain pipes..................................................8.07 Cooling water systems, list of capacities and............6.02
Boiler, exhaust gas...................................................15.04 Cooling water temperature, recommended...............2.08
Counterflanges ..........................................................5.10
C Crane beam for overhaul of air cooler . .....................5.03
Calculation of capacities ...........................................6.01 Crane beam for overhaul of turbochargers ...............5.03
Calculation of exhaust data for derated engine.........6.04 Crane beam for turbochargers ..................................5.03
Calculation of exhaust gas amount and Crankcase venting and bedplate drain pipes ..........8.07
temperature ..........................................................6.04 Crankshaft..................................................................1.06
Cams..........................................................................1.06 Critical running ........................................................17.06
Camshaft....................................................................1.06 Cross section, engine.................................................1.07
Capacities of the engine, calculation of.....................6.04 Crosshead..................................................................1.06
Capacities, calculation of...........................................6.01 Cylinder cover............................................................1.06
Central cooler...........................................................11.03 Cylinder frame............................................................1.06
Central cooling system, advantages of....................11.01 Cylinder liner...............................................................1.06
Central cooling system, disadvantages of...............11.01 Cylinder lubricating oil pipes......................................9.02

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Index

Subject Section Subject Section


C E
Cylinder lubricating oil supply system .....................9.03 Engine outline . ..........................................................5.05
Cylinder lubricating oil system ..................................9.01 Engine pipe connections...................................5.05, 5.09
Cylinder lubrication....................................................1.06 Engine power.............................................................1.04
Cylinder Lubrication System, MAN B&W Alpha.........9.02 Engine power range and fuel oil consumption . ........1.04
Cylinder lubricators and service tank.........................9.01 Engine preparations for PTO .....................................4.03
Cylinder lubricators, mechanical................................9.03 Engine room crane ....................................................5.04
Cylinder oil consumption............................................1.03 Engine running points, propulsion..............................2.01
Cylinder oil feed rate, dosage....................................9.01 Engine seating and holding down bolts ....................5.11
Cylinder oils................................................................9.01 Engine seating profile ................................................5.12
Engine side control console and instrument panel..16.01
D Engine side control console with diagram...............16.01
Damper, axial vibration...............................................1.06 Engine space requirements........................................5.01
Damper, torsional vibration........................................1.06 Engine top bracing ....................................................5.13
Data sheet for propeller..............................................5.18 Engine type designation . ..........................................1.02
Design parameters, fuel oil system............................7.01 Example 1, Pumps and Cooler Capacity ..................6.04
Designation of PTO ...................................................4.01 Example 2, Fresh Water Production . ........................6.04
Diagram for actual project . .......................................2.05 Example 3, Expected Exhaust Gas ...........................6.04
Diagram for change of exhaust gas amount .............6.04 Examples of graphic calculation of SFOC ................2.08
Diagram of manoeuvring system ............................16.01 Exhaust data for derated engine, calculation of.........6.04
DMG/CFE Generators................................................4.03 Exhaust gas amount and temperature.......................6.04
Documentation, symbols for piping................................A Exhaust gas boiler....................................................15.04
Drain from water mist catcher..................................14.05 Exhaust gas by-pass . ...............................................3.02
Drain oil system, stuffing box...................................10.01 Exhaust gas compensator after turbocharger..........15.04
Drains, bedplate.........................................................8.07 Exhaust gas data at specified MCR (ISO)..................6.04
Exhaust gas pipes ...................................................15.02
E Exhaust gas receiver with variable by-pass...............3.02
Earthing device, shaftline...........................................5.17 Exhaust gas silencer ..............................................15.04
Electric motor for auxiliary blower . .........................14.04 Exhaust gas system........................................1.06, 15.01
Electrically driven moment compensator ................17.03 Exhaust gas system for main engine ......................15.03
Electricity production ................................................4.01 Exhaust turbocharger.................................................1.06
Emission control . ......................................................2.12 Exhaust valve.............................................................1.06
Emission limits, IMO NOx...........................................2.12 Exhaust valve air spring pipes..................................13.03
Emulsification, Water In Fuel (WIF).............................7.06 Expansion tank, jacket water system.......................12.07
Engine configurations related to SFOC......................6.01 Extended load diagram for speed derated engines...2.04
Engine control room console...................................16.01 External forces and moments in layout point
Engine Control System interface to for K80MC-C6......................................................17.07
surrounding systems .........................................16.03 for K90MC-C6......................................................17.07
Engine Control System MC/MC-C ..........................16.01 for K98MC7..........................................................17.07
Engine Control System, components for...................5.16 for K98MC-C7......................................................17.07
Engine cross section, referral to PG . ........................1.07 for L60MC-C8......................................................17.07
Engine design and IMO regulation compliance.........1.01 for L70MC-C8......................................................17.07
Engine layout (heavy propeller)..................................2.01 for S50MC-C8......................................................17.07
Engine layout and load diagrams ..............................2.01 for S60MC-C8......................................................17.07
Engine layout and load diagrams, for S70MC-C8......................................................17.07
MC/MC-C engines . ..............................................2.04 for S80MC-C8......................................................17.07
Engine load diagram..................................................2.04 for S90MC-C8......................................................17.07
Engine margin.............................................................2.01 External unbalanced moments.................................17.01
Engine masses and centre of gravity.........................5.05 Extreme ambient conditions.......................................3.02
Engine monitoring....................................................16.01

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Index

Subject Section Subject Section


F H
Filter, fuel oil...............................................................7.05 Heat loss in piping......................................................7.04
Fire extinguishing system for scavenge air space .14.07 Heat radiation and air consumption...........................6.02
Flow meter, fuel oil.....................................................7.05 Heat tracing, fuel oil pipe...........................................7.04
Flow velocities............................................................6.04 Heater, fuel oil.............................................................7.05
Flushing of lube oil system.........................................8.05 Heating of fuel drain pipe...........................................7.01
Flushing of the fuel oil system....................................7.05 Heavy fuel oil (HFO)....................................................7.01
Fouled hull..................................................................2.01 Heavy fuel oil specification, guiding...........................7.02
Frame box..................................................................1.06 High pressure pipes, fuel oil.......................................1.06
Fresh water treatment..............................................12.07 Holding down bolts, engine seating and....................5.11
Freshwater generator......................................6.04, 12.07 H-type guide force moment.....................................17.05
Freshwater production for derated engine, Hydraulic Power Supply unit .....................................8.02
calculation of..........................................................6.04 Hydraulic Power Unit for Alpha CP propeller ............5.18
Fuel and lubricating oil consumption.........................1.03 Hydraulic top bracing arrangement ..........................5.15
Fuel considerations....................................................7.01
Fuel consumption at an arbitrary load ......................2.11 I
Fuel drain pipe, heating of..........................................7.01 IMO NOx emission limits............................................2.12
Fuel flow velocity and viscosity..................................7.01 Indicator drive.............................................................1.06
Fuel oil centrifuges.....................................................7.05 Influence on the optimum propeller speed................2.02
Fuel oil circulating pumps..........................................7.05 Instrument panel, engine side control console........16.01
Fuel oil drains.............................................................7.01 Insulation, fuel oil pipe................................................7.04
Fuel oil filter................................................................7.05
Fuel oil flow meter......................................................7.05 J
Fuel oil heater.............................................................7.05 Jacket cooling water pipes .....................................12.06
Fuel oil high pressure pipes........................................1.06 Jacket cooling water system . .................................12.05
Fuel oil pipe heat tracing............................................7.04 Jacket cooling water temperature control..................6.04
Fuel oil pipe insulation . .............................................7.04 Jacket water cooler.......................................11.03, 12.04
Fuel oil pipes and drain pipes ...................................7.03 Jacket water cooling pump...........................11.03, 12.07
Fuel oil pump..............................................................1.06 Jacket water preheater.............................................12.07
Fuel oil pumps............................................................7.01 Jacket water system................................................11.03
Fuel oil supply pumps................................................7.05 Jacket water thermostatic valve...............................12.07
Fuel oil system ..........................................................7.01
Fuel oil system components......................................7.05 L
Fuel oil system, flushing of.........................................7.05 L16/24 GenSet data ..................................................4.06
Fuel oil venting box....................................................7.05 L21/31 GenSet data ..................................................4.07
Fuel oils .....................................................................7.02 L23/30H GenSet data ...............................................4.08
Fuel valves..................................................................1.06 L27/38 GenSet data ..................................................4.09
L28/32H GenSet data ...............................................4.10
G L32/40 GenSet data ..................................................4.11
Gallery arrangement...................................................1.06 Layout diagram sizes ................................................2.03
Gallery outline....................................................5.05, 5.06 Limits for continuous operation, operating curves.....2.04
Generator step-up gear and flexible coupling............4.04 List of capacities .......................................................6.03
Governor....................................................................1.06 List of capacities and cooling water systems ...........6.02
Governor and remote control components .............16.01 List of capacities, S70MC-C8 ...................................6.03
Governor parts and mode of operation . .................16.01 Load diagram, examples of the use of.......................2.04
Graphic calculation of SFOC, examples....................2.08 Low load operation...................................................16.01
Guide force moments . ............................................17.05 Low load operation, limits..........................................2.04
Guide force moments, data ....................................17.05 Lube oil system, flushing of........................................8.05
Guiding heavy fuel oil specification............................7.02 Lubricating and cooling oil pipes ..............................8.01
Lubricating and cooling oil system ...........................8.01

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Index

Subject Section Subject Section


L O
Lubricating oil centrifuges and list of lubricating oils .8.04 Oil, masses of.............................................................5.08
Lubricating oil consumption.......................................1.03 Operating curves and limits for continuous
Lubricating oil cooler.......................................8.05, 11.03 operation................................................................2.04
Lubricating oil data.....................................................1.04 Operation panel for auxiliary blowers . ....................14.02
Lubricating oil full flow filter........................................8.05 Optimising point (O)...................................................2.04
Lubricating oil pipes for turbochargers .....................8.03 Outline, engine...........................................................5.05
Lubricating oil pump...................................................8.05 Overcritical running..................................................17.06
Lubricating oil tank ....................................................8.06 Overhaul of engine, space requirements....................5.01
Lubricating oil temperature control valve...................8.05 Overload operation, limits..........................................2.04
Lubricating oils, list of................................................8.04
Lubrication of turbochargers......................................8.01 P
Lubricator control system..........................................9.02 Performance curves ..................................................1.05
Pipe connections, engine..................................5.05, 5.09
M Pipes, air cooler cleaning.........................................14.05
Main bearing...............................................................1.06 Pipes, bedplate drain.................................................8.07
MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubrication system Pipes, exhaust gas...................................................15.02
for K98MC/7, S90MC-C8, K90MC-C6..................9.02 Pipes, exhaust valve air spring.................................13.03
for S/L60MC-C8....................................................9.02 Pipes, fire extinguishing for scavenge air space......14.07
for S/L70MC-C8....................................................9.02 Pipes, fuel oil high pressure.......................................1.06
for S50MC-C8........................................................9.02 Pipes, jacket water cooling......................................12.06
for S80MC-C8, K80MC-C6...................................9.02 Pipes, scavenge air..................................................14.03
MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication, wiring Pipes, seawater cooling...........................................12.03
diagram..................................................................9.02 Pipes, starting air......................................................13.03
MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators on engine......9.02 Pipes, turbocharger lubricating oil.............................8.03
MAN Diesels Alpha Controllable Pitch (CP) Piping arrangements..................................................1.06
propeller . ..............................................................5.18 Piping, symbols for..........................................................A
Manoeuvring consoles.............................................16.01 Piston.........................................................................1.06
Manoeuvring system..................................................1.06 Piston rod...................................................................1.06
Manoeuvring system on engine ..............................16.01 Power management system..........................16.01, 16.03
Manoeuvring system, diagram of . ..........................16.01 Power Related Unbalance (PRU) ............................17.04
Marine diesel oil.........................................................7.01 Power Take Off (PTO).................................................4.01
Mass of water and oil.................................................5.08 Power Take Off/Gear Constant Ratio (PTO/GCR)......4.04
MC Engine description . ............................................1.06 Power Turbine Generator (PTG).................................4.05
Mechanical cylinder lubricators ................................9.03 Power, Speed, Dimensions .......................................1.03
Mechanical top bracing . ...........................................5.14 Preheater, jacket water.............................................12.07
Mode of operation, governor...................................16.01 Preheating of diesel engine......................................12.08
Moment compensators (2nd order), basic Propeller clearance.....................................................5.18
design regarding..................................................17.02 Propeller curve...........................................................2.01
Moment compensators (2nd order), Propeller design point................................................2.01
determine the need..............................................17.02 Propeller diameter and pitch, influence on
optimum propeller speed . ....................................2.02
N Propeller, data sheet...................................................5.18
Nodes and Compensators.......................................17.03 Propulsion and engine running points........................2.01
NOx reduction............................................................2.12 Propulsion control station on the main bridge...........5.18
NOx Reduction by SCR ............................................3.03 Propulsion Control System, Alphatronic 2000...........5.18
NOx reduction methods.............................................2.12 PTG, Power Turbine Generator..................................4.05
PTO, engine preparations for.....................................4.03
PTO/BW GCR ...........................................................4.04
PTO/RCF ...................................................................4.01

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Index

Subject Section Subject Section


P S
Pump capacities, pressures and flow velocities .......6.04 Shaftline earthing device ...........................................5.17
Pump Station, MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Shut down system....................................................16.01
Lubricators.............................................................9.02 Side mounted PTO/RCF, space requirement.............4.02
Pump, jacket water cooling...........................11.03, 12.04 Silencer, exhaust gas...............................................15.04
Pump, seawater cooling...........................................12.04 Slow down system........................................16.01, 16.03
Pumps, central cooling.............................................11.03 Slow turning before starting.....................................16.01
Pumps, fuel oil............................................................1.06 SMG/CFE Generators................................................4.03
Pumps, fuel oil circulating..........................................7.05 Soft blast cleaning, turbocharger cleaning...............15.02
Pumps, fuel oil supply................................................7.05 Space requirement
Pumps, jacket water cooling....................................12.07 for K80MC-C6........................................................5.02
Pumps, lubricating oil.................................................8.05 for K90MC-C6........................................................5.02
Pumps, seawater cooling.........................................11.03 for K98MC7............................................................5.02
for K98MC-C7........................................................5.02
R for L60MC-C8........................................................5.02
Recommendation for operation.................................2.04 for L70MC-C8........................................................5.02
Reduction station, control and safety air.................13.02 for S50MC-C8........................................................5.02
Reduction valve, turbocharger cleaning etc.............13.02 for S60MC-C8........................................................5.02
Remote control system.................................16.01, 16.03 for S70MC-C8........................................................5.02
Renk KAZ clutch for auxilliary propulsion systems....5.18 for S80MC-C8........................................................5.02
Reversing....................................................................1.06 for S90MC-C8........................................................5.02
Space requirements and overhaul heights . ..............5.01
S Space requirements for side mounted PTO/RCF
Safety system................................................16.01, 16.03 for K80MC-C/ME-C6.............................................4.02
Scavenge air box drain system ...............................14.06 for K90MC-C/ME-C6.............................................4.02
Scavenge air cooler..............................1.06, 11.03, 12.04 for K98MC/ME7.....................................................4.02
Scavenge air cooler cleaning system . ....................14.05 for K98MC-C/ME-C7.............................................4.02
Scavenge air cooler requirements............................14.02 for L60MC-C/ME-C8.............................................4.02
Scavenge air pipes . ................................................14.03 for L70MC-C/ME-C8.............................................4.02
Scavenge air system.......................................1.06, 14.01 for S50MC-C/ME-C8.............................................4.02
Sea margin and heavy weather..................................2.01 for S60MC-C/ME-C8/-GI.......................................4.02
Seawater cooling pipes ...........................................12.03 for S70MC-C/ME-C8/-GI.......................................4.02
Seawater cooling pump...........................................12.04 for S80MC-C/ME-C8.............................................4.02
Seawater cooling pumps..........................................11.03 for S90MC-C/ME-C8.............................................4.02
Seawater cooling system ........................................12.02 Spark arrester, exhaust gas......................................15.04
Seawater systems ...................................................12.01 Specific Fuel Oil Consumption (SFOC)......................1.04
Seawater thermostatic valve....................................12.04 Specific fuel oil consumption, ME versus
Selective Catalytic Reduction (SCR)..........................3.03 MC engines . .........................................................2.06
Sequence diagram ..................................................16.01 Specified maximum continuous rating (M).................2.04
Sequence diagram for Controllable Pitch Propeller 1 . 6.02 Spray shields, fuel oil and lubricating oil pipe ...........7.04
Sequence diagram for Fixed Pitch Propeller ..........16.01 Start of engine, temperature at................................12.08
Servo oil system for VBS type CP propeller...............5.18 Starting air compressors..........................................13.02
SFOC calculations . ...................................................2.09 Starting air receivers.................................................13.02
SFOC calculations, example .....................................2.10 Starting air system.....................................................1.06
SFOC for high efficiency turbochargers . ..................2.07 Starting air system, manoeuvring diagram..............16.01
SFOC guarantee.........................................................2.08 Starting air systems, components for......................13.02
SFOC, engine configurations related to.....................6.01 Starting air valve.........................................................1.06
SFOC, reference conditions and guarantee ..............2.08 Starting and control air pipes .................................13.03
SFOC, with constant speed.......................................2.09 Starting and control air systems .............................13.01
SFOC, with fixed pitch propeller................................2.09 Static converter, frequency........................................4.03

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Index

Subject Section Subject Section


S T
Steam Turbine Generator (STG).................................4.05 Turbines, combined....................................................4.05
STG, Steam Turbine Generator..................................4.05 Turbocharger arrangement and cleaning.................15.01
Stuffing box................................................................1.06 Turbocharger selection . ............................................3.01
Stuffing box drain oil system . ................................10.01 Turbocharger, exhaust................................................1.06
Supply system, cylinder lubricating oil.......................9.03 Turbochargers, lubrication of......................................8.01
Symbols for piping .........................................................A Turning gear.....................................................1.06, 13.02
System control units, MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Turning wheel.............................................................1.06
Lubricators.............................................................9.02
System, cylinder lubricating oil..................................9.01 U
System, engine control.............................................16.01 Undercritical running................................................17.06
System, exhaust gas................................................15.01
System, exhaust gas for main engine ..........15.03, 15.04 V
System, fire extinguishing for scavenge air space...14.07 VBS type CP propeller and range..............................5.18
System, fuel oil...........................................................7.01 Venting box, fuel oil....................................................7.05
System, jacket cooling water...................................12.05 Vibration aspects . ...................................................17.01
System, jacket water................................................11.03 Vibration limits valid for single order harmonics......17.05
System, lubricating and cooling oil............................8.01
System, MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication.........9.02 W
System, manoeuvring.................................................1.06 Waste Heat Recovery Systems (WHR) . ....................4.05
System, manoeuvring, on engine.............................16.01 Water and oil in engine . ............................................5.08
System, scavenge air...............................................14.01 Water in fuel emulsification ......................................7.06
System, scavenge air box drain...............................14.06 Water mist catcher, drain from.................................14.05
System, scavenge air cooler cleaning......................14.05 Water washing, turbocharger cleaning.....................15.02
System, seawater.....................................................12.01 Water, masses of........................................................5.08
System, seawater cooling........................................12.02 Wiring diagram, MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder
System, shut down...................................................16.01 Lubrication.............................................................9.02
System, starting air..................................................16.01
System, stuffing box drain oil...................................10.01 X
Systems, control and starting air.............................13.01 X-type guide force moment......................................17.05
Systems, starting air.................................................13.01
Systems, turbocharger cleaning...............................15.02

T
Tank, deaerating.......................................................12.07
Tank, lubricating oil.....................................................8.06
Telegraph system..........................................16.01, 16.03
Temperature at start of engine ...............................12.08
Temperature control valve, lubricating oil...................8.05
The MC/MC-C Tier II Engine .....................................1.01
Thermostatic valve, central cooling..........................11.03
Thermostatic valve, jacket water..............................12.07
Thermostatic valve, seawater...................................12.04
Thrust bearing............................................................1.06
Top bracing...............................................................17.05
Top bracing, engine . .................................................5.13
Torsional vibration damper.........................................1.06
Torsional vibrations...................................................17.06
Tuning wheel...............................................................1.06
Tunnel gear with hollow flexible coupling...................4.04

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel
MAN B&W

Engine Design

1
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 1.01
Page 1 of 2

The MC/MC-C Tier II Engine

Whether the freight rates rise or fall, an attractive Each cylinder is equipped with its own fuel in-
payback time for newbuildings starts with low in- jection pump, which consists of a simple plung-
vestment cost. Once in operation, the ease and er activated by the fuel cam directly. The optimal
flexibility in assigning engineers to operate the combination of NOx and SFOC (Specific Fuel Oil
engine plant are together with low consumption Consumption) is achieved by means of the Vari-
rates of fuels, lubes, parts and service among the able Injection Timing (VIT) incorporated in the fuel
important functional issues which contribute to pumps (applicable for MC/MC-C engines type 98-
the cost benefit. The MAN B&W MC/MC-C engine 50 only).
meets both requirements.
The cam controlled exhaust valve is opened hy-
The world market-leading two-stroke MC/MC-C draulically and closed by means of an air spring.
engine programme from MANDiesel has evolved
since the early 1980s to embrace bore sizes from Lubrication is either by means of a uni-lube oil
260 mm to 980 mm for propelling ocean-going system serving both crankshaft, chain drive, pis-
ships of all types and sizes. In fact, low-speed ton cooling and camshaft or a combination of a
two-stroke main engines of the MC/MC-C type main lubricating oil system and a separate cam-
have become industry standard in a huge number shaft lube oil system.
of ship types. Also land-based applications (pow-
er plants mainly) have found the MC/MC-C engine Cylinder lubrication is accomplished by electroni-
types attractive. cally controlled Alpha lubricators, securing a low
lube oil consumption, or timed mechanical lubri-
The MC/MC-C engine features chain driven cam- cators alternatively.
shaft, camshaft controlled fuel injection timing
and exhaust valve opening as well as a conven- The starting valves are opened pneumatically by
tional fuel oil pumps, all well-known and proven control air from the starting air distributor(s) and
technology familiar to marine engineers all over closed by a spring.
the world.

To conclude, the MAN B&W MC/MC-C engine Engine design and IMO regulation compli-
combines classic virtues of commonly known, ance
well-proven technology continuously upgraded
and up-rated to suit the requirements to modern The MC-C engine is the shorter, more com-
prime movers. Consequently, our latest cutting pact version of the MC engine. It is well suited
edge design and manufacturing features are built wherever a small engine room is requested, for in-
into each component. stance in container vessels.

For MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII designated engines,


Concept of the MC/MC-C engine the design and performance parameters have
been upgraded and optimised to comply with the
The engine concept is based on a mechanical International Maritime Organisation (IMO) Tier II
camshaft system for activation of the fuel injec- emission regulations.
tion and the exhaust valves. The engine is pro-
vided with a pneumatic/electric manoeuvring sys- The potential derating and part load SFOC figures
tem and the engine speed is controlled by an for the Tier II engines have also been updated.
electronic/hydraulic type governor.
For engines built to comply with IMO Tier I emis-
sion regulations, please refer to the Marine Engine
IMO Tier I Project Guide.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 74 68-2.1
MAN B&W 1.01
Page 2 of 2

The main features of the MC engine are described


in the following pages.

For further information about the application of


MC/MC-C engines based on ship particulars and
power demand, please refer to our publications
titled:

Propulsion Trends in Container Vessels

Propulsion Trends in Bulk Carriers

Propulsion Trends in Tankers

The publications are available at


www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
Technical Papers.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 74 68-2.1
MAN B&W 1.02
Page 1 of 1

Engine Type Designation

6 S 70 M E B/C 7 -GI -TII

Emission regulation TII IMO Tier level

(blank) Fuel oil only


Fuel injection concept GI Gas injection

Mark version

B Exhaust valve controlled


Design by camshaft
C Compact engine

Concept E Electronically controlled


C Camshaft controlled

Engine programme

Diameter of piston in cm

S Super long stroke


Stroke/bore ratio L Long stroke
K Short stroke

Number of cylinders

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/MEC/MEB/-GI engines 198 38 243.6


MAN B&W 1.03
Page 1 of 3

Power, Speed, Dimensions


Cyl. L1 kW Cyl. L1 kW

MEP SFOC MEP SFOC


6 37,380 bar g/kWh bar g/kWh
7 43,610 MCR
Minimum at 6 27,420 MCR
Minimum at
K98 8 49,840
Part Load
7 31,990
Part Load
kW/cyl. K90 kW/cyl.
MC7 9 56,070 6,230
L1 19.2 177 174
8 36,560 4,570
L1 18.0 177 174
MC-C6
10 62,300 L3 9 41,130 L3
Stroke: 5,780 3,910
11 68,530 15.4 171 168 Stroke: 10 45,700 14.4 171 168
2,660 mm 5,000 3,650
L2 L2
12 74,760 2,300 mm 11 50,270
4,630 L4 3,130 L4
14 87,220 12 54,840

90 97 r/min 89 104 r/min

MEP SFOC
6 36,120 bar g/kWh Lmin: 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl. 10 cyl. 11 cyl. 12 cyl.
7 42,140 MCR
Minimum at Mark 6 mm 12,802 14,404 16,006 17,608 20,060 21,662 23,264
K98 8 48,160
Part Load
Dry mass:
kW/cyl.
MC-C7 L1 19.2 177 174
9 54,180 6,020 MC-C6 t 991 1,111 1,259 1,415 1,561 1,686 1,826
10 60,200 5,620
L3
Stroke: 15.4 171 168
11 66,220 4,830 Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3
2,400 mm L2
12 72,240 MC-C6 mm 1,602 4,286 1,699 12,800 12,600 12,375
4,510 L4
14 84,280

97 104 r/min Cyl. L1 kW

MEP SFOC
bar g/kWh
Lmin: m 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl. 10 cyl. 11 cyl. 12 cyl. 14 cyl.
Minimum at
Mark 7 mm 12,865 14,615 16,410 19,135 20,885 22,635 24,385 27,885 MCR
Part Load*
S80 6 25,080 kW/cyl.
Dry mass: L1 20.0 171 168-169
7 29,260 4,180
MC7 t 1,156 1,315 1,536 1,697 1,882 2,034 2,190 2,446 MC-C8
8 33,440 L3
MC-C7 t 1,111 1,277 1,472 1,618 1,774 1,947 2,089 2,405 3,860
Stroke: 18.0 168 165-166
3,760
L2
3,200 mm
Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3 3,470 L4
MC7 mm 1,750 4,640 1,700 13,400 13,125 13,100
MC-C7 mm 1,750 4,370 1,700 12,825 - 12,650 72 78 r/min

Cyl. L1 kW * The Minimum SFOC at Part Load is somewhat dependent on the MCR layout
speed, i.e. the low SFOC figure relates to 78 r/min, the higher to 72 r/min.
MEP SFOC
bar g/kWh
Minimum at Lmin: 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl.
MCR
Part Load* Mark 8 mm 11,431 12,855 14,279 -
S90 kW/cyl.
L1 20.0 171 168-169
6 31,620 5,270 Dry mass:
MC-C8
7 36,890 L3 MC-C8 t 866 967 1,092 -
4,870
Stroke: 8 42,160 16.0 168 165-166
4,750
3,188 mm 9 47,430
L2 Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3
4,380 MC-C8 mm 1,424 5,000 1,736 14,325 13,175 12,950
L4

72 78 r/min

* The Minimum SFOC at Part Load is somewhat dependent on the MCR layout
speed, i.e. the low SFOC figure relates to 78 r/min, the higher to 72 r/min.

Lmin: 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl.


Mark 8 mm 12,802 14,404 16,006 17,608
Dry mass:
MC-C8 t 1,094 1,229 1,394 1,543

Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3
MC-C8 mm 1,602 5,000 1,800 14,500 13,525 14,275
H1

H3
H2

A B
C

L min

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 42-6.0
MAN B&W 1.03
Page 2 of 3
Cyl. L1 kW Cyl. L1 kW
MEP SFOC MEP SFOC
bar g/kWh bar g/kWh
6 21,660 MCR
Minimum at
MCR
Minimum at
Part Load Part Load
K80 7 25,270 kW/cyl. L70 5 16,350 kW/cyl.
L1 18.0 177 174 L1 20.0 175 172
8 28,880 3,610 6 19,620 3,270
MC-C6 MC-C8
9 32,490 3,090
L3 7 22,890 2,750
L3
Stroke: 10 36,100 14.4 171 168 Stroke: 8 26,160 16.0 169 166
2,890 2,620
L2 L2
2,300 mm 11 39,710 2,360 mm
2,470 L4 2,200
12 43,320 L4

89 104 r/min 91 108 r/min

Lmin: 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl. 10 cyl. 11 cyl. 12 cyl. Lmin: 5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl.
Mark 6 mm 10,864 12,288 13,712 15,136 17,800 19,224 20,648 Mark 8 mm 7,639 8,829 10,019 11,209
Dry mass: Dry mass:
MC-C6 t 736 830 926 1,065 1,178 1,276 1,374 MC-C8 t 465 501 586 683

Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3 Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3
MC-C6 mm 1,424 4,088 1,510 11,900 11,500 11,300 MC-C8 mm 1,190 3,980 1,262 11,250 10,475 10,475

Cyl. L1 kW Cyl. L1 kW

MEP SFOC MEP SFOC


bar g/kWh bar g/kWh
Minimum at Minimum at
MCR MCR
Part Load Part Load
S70 5 16,350 kW/cyl. S65 5 14,350 kW/cyl.
3,270 L1 20.0 174 171 L1 20.0 174 171
6 19,620 6 17,220 2,870
MC-C8 MC-C8
7 22,890 L3 7 20,090 L3
2,770 2,450
Stroke: 8 26,160 16.0 168 165 Stroke: 8 22,960 16.0 168 165
2,610 2,290
L2 L2
2,800 mm 2,730 mm
2,210 1,960
L4 L4

77 91 r/min 81 95 r/min

Lmin: 5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. Lmin: 5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl.
Mark 8 mm 8,308 9,498 10,688 11,878 Mark 8 mm 7,068 8,152 9,236 10,320
Dry mass: Dry mass:
MC-C t 495 569 624 704 MC-C8 t 401 474 538 604

Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3 Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3
MC-C mm 1,190 4,390 1,520 12,475 11,675 11,425 MC-C8 mm Data is available on request
H1

H3
H2

A B
C

L min

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 42-6.0
MAN B&W 1.03
Page 3 of 3
Cyl. L1 kW Cyl. L1 kW

MEP SFOC MEP SFOC


bar g/kWh bar g/kWh

MCR
Minimum at 5 8,300 MCR
Minimum at
Part Load Part Load
S60 5 11,900 kW/cyl. S50 6 9,960 kW/cyl.
L1 20.0 174 171 L1 20.0 175 172
6 14,280 2,380 7 11,620 1,660
MC-C8 MC-C8
7 16,660 L3 8 13,280 L3
2,010 1,410
Stroke: 8 19,040 16.0 168 165 Stroke: 9 14,940 16.0 169 166
1,900 1,330
L2 L2
2,400 mm 2,000 mm
1,610 L4 1,130 L4

89 105 r/min 108 127 r/min

Lmin: 5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. Lmin: 5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl.
Mark 8 mm 7,122 8,142 9,162 10,182 Mark 8 mm 5,924 6,774 7,624 8,474 9,324
Dry mass: Dry mass:
MC-C8 t 324 368 410 467 MC-C8 t 186 212 238 273 311

Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3 DiMCnsions: A B C H1 H2 H3
MC-C8 mm 1,020 3,770 1,300 10,700 10,000 9,800 MC-C8 mm 850 3,150 1,085 9,000 8,475 8,250

Cyl. L1 kW

MEP SFOC
bar g/kWh
5 11,700 MCR
Minimum at
Part Load
L60 6 14,040 kW/cyl.
L1 20.0 175 172
7 16,380 2,340
MC-C8
8 18,720 L3
2,000
Stroke: 9 21,060 16.0 169 166
1,880
L2
2,022 mm
1,600 L4

105 123 r/min

Lmin: 5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl.


Mark 8 mm 7,122 8,142 9,162 10,182 11,202
Dry mass:
MC-C8 t 304 347 397 453 510

Dimensions: A B C H1 H2 H3
MC-C8 mm 1,020 3,228 1,134 9,675 9,125 8,925
H1

H3
H2

A B
C

L min

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 42-6.0
MAN B&W 1.04
Page 1 of 1

Engine Power Range and Fuel Oil Consumption


Engine Power

The following tables contain data regarding the Specific Fuel Oil Consumption (SFOC)
power, speed and specific fuel oil consumption of
the engine. The figures given in this folder represent the val-
ues obtained when the engine and turbocharger
Engine power is specified in kW for each cylinder are matched with a view to obtaining the lowest
number and layout points L1, L2, L3 and L4. possible SFOC values while also fulfilling the IMO
NOX Tier II emission limitations.
Discrepancies between kW and metric horsepow-
er (1 BHP = 75 kpm/s = 0.7355 kW) are a conse- Stricter emission limits can be met on request, us-
quence of the rounding off of the BHP values. ing proven technologies.

L1 designates nominal maximum continuous rating The SFOC figures are given in g/kWh with a toler-
(nominal MCR), at 100% engine power and 100% ance of 5% and are based on the use of fuel with
engine speed. a lower calorific value of 42,700 kJ/kg (~10,200
kcal/kg) at ISO conditions:
L2, L3 and L4 designate layout points at the other
three corners of the layout area, chosen for easy Ambient air pressure..............................1,000 mbar
reference. Ambient air temperature................................. 25 C
Cooling water temperature............................. 25 C
Power L1
Although the engine will develop the power speci-
fied up to tropical ambient conditions, specific
L3
fuel oil consumption varies with ambient condi-
L2 tions and fuel oil lower calorific value. For calcula-
tion of these changes, see Chapter 2.

L4
Speed Lubricating oil data
178 51 489.0
The cylinder oil consumption figures stated in the
tables are valid under normal conditions.
Fig. 1.04.01: Layout diagram for engine power and speed
During runningin periods and under special con-
Overload corresponds to 110% of the power at ditions, feed rates of up to 1.5 times the stated
MCR, and may be permitted for a limited period of values should be used.
one hour every 12 hours.

The engine power figures given in the tables re-


main valid up to tropical conditions at sea level as
stated in IACS M28 (1978), i.e.:

Blower inlet temperature................................. 45 C


Blower inlet pressure..............................1000 mbar
Seawater temperature..................................... 32 C
Relative humidity...............................................60%

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 55 56-9.1
MAN B&W 1.05
Page 1 of 1

Performance Curves

Updated engine and capacities data is


available from the CEAS program on
www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
CEAS - Engine Room Dimensioning.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/MEB/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 53 31-6.2
MAN B&W 1.06
Page 1 of 6

MC Engine Description

Please note that engines built by our licensees Frame Box


are in accordance with MAN Diesel drawings and
standards but, in certain cases, some local stand The frame box is of triangular plate welded or rib
ards may be applied; however, all spare parts are design. On the exhaust side, it is provided with
interchangeable with MAN Diesel designed parts. relief valves for each cylinder while, on the ma
noeuvring side, it is provided with a large hinged
Some components may differ from MAN Diesels door for each cylinder. The crosshead guides are
design because of local production facilities or the welded onto the frame box.
application of local standard components.
The frame box is bolted to the bedplate. The bed
In the following, reference is made to the item plate, frame box and cylinder frame are tightened
numbers specified in the Extent of Delivery (EoD) together by stay bolts.
forms, both for the Basic delivery extent and for
some Options.
Cylinder Frame and Stuffing Box

Bedplate and Main Bearing The cylinder frame is either welded or cast and
is provided with access covers for cleaning the
The bedplate is made with the thrust bearing in scavenge air space, if required, and for inspec
the aft end of the engine. The bedplate consists tion of scavenge ports and piston rings from the
of high, welded, longitudinal girders and welded manoeuvring side. Together with the cylinder
cross girders with cast steel bearing supports. liner, it forms the scavenge air space.

For fitting to the engine seating in the ship, long, The cylinder frame is fitted with pipes for the
elastic holdingdown bolts, and hydraulic tighten piston cooling oil inlet. The scavenge air receiver,
ing tools are used. turbocharger, air cooler box, lubricators and gal
lery brackets are located on the cylinder frame. At
The bedplate is made without taper for engines the bottom of the cylinder frame there is a piston
mounted on epoxy chocks. rod stuffing box, provided with sealing rings for
scavenge air. Oil scraper rings in the stuffing box
The oil pan, which is made of steel plate and is prevent crankcase oil from coming up into the
welded to the bedplate, collects the return oil from scavenge air space and polluting the crankcase
the forced lubricating and cooling oil system. The oil with combustion waste products.
oil outlets from the oil pan are normally vertical
and are provided with gratings. Drains from the scavenge air space and the pis
ton rod stuffing box are located at the bottom of
Horizontal outlets at both ends can be arranged the cylinder frame.
for some cylinder numbers, however, this must be
confirmed by the engine builder. Cylinder Liner

The main bearings consist of thin walled steel The cylinder liner is made of alloyed cast iron
shells lined with bearing metal. The main bearing and is suspended in the cylinder frame with a
bottom shell can be rotated out and in by means lowsituated flange. The top of the cylinder liner is
of special tools in combination with hydraulic tools fitted with a cooling jacket.
for lifting the crankshaft. The shells are kept in po
sition by a bearing cap. The cylinder liner has scavenge ports, drilled
holes for cylinder lubrication and is prepared for
installation of temperature sensors, if required.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC/MC-C-TII,
L70MC-C-TII, S60MC/MC-C-TII, L60MC-C-TII,
MAN Diesel 198 74 71-6.1

S50MC/MC-C-TII
MAN B&W 1.06
Page 2 of 6

Cylinder Cover Engines type 60 and larger with 9 cylinders or


more will be specified with the 360 degree type
The cylinder cover is of forged steel, made in one thrust bearing, while the 240 degree type is used
piece, and has bores for cooling water. It has a in all other engines. MAN Diesels flexible thrust
central bore for the exhaust valve, and bores for cam design is used for the thrust collar on a range
the fuel valves, a starting valve and an indicator of engine types. The thrust shaft is an integrated
valve. part of the crankshaft and lubricated by the en
gines lubricating oil system.
The cylinder cover is attached to the cylinder
frame with studs and nuts tightened with hydraulic
jacks. Turning Gear and Turning Wheel

The turning wheel is fitted to the thrust shaft and


Crankshaft driven by a pinion on the terminal shaft of the
turning gear, which is mounted on the bedplate.
The crankshaft is mainly of the semibuilt type, The turning gear is driven by an electric motor
made from forged or cast steel throws. In engines with builtin gear with brake.
with 9 cylinders or more the crankshaft is supplied
in two parts. A blocking device prevents the main engine from
starting when the turning gear is engaged. Engage
At the aft end, the crankshaft is provided with the ment and disengagement of the turning gear is ef
collar for the thrust bearing, and the flange for the fected manually by an axial movement of the pinion.
turning wheel and for the coupling bolts to an in
termediate shaft. The control device for the turning gear, consisting
of starter and manual control box, can be ordered
At the front end, the crankshaft is fitted with the as an option.
collar for the axial vibration damper and a flange
for the fitting of a tuning wheel. The flange can
also be used for a Power Take Off, if so desired. Axial Vibration Damper

Coupling bolts and nuts for joining the crankshaft The engine is fitted with an axial vibration damper,
together with the intermediate shaft are not nor mounted on the fore end of the crankshaft. The
mally supplied. damper consists of a piston and a splittype hous
ing located forward of the foremost main bearing.

Thrust Bearing The piston is made as an integrated collar on the


main crank journal, and the housing is fixed to
The propeller thrust is transferred through the the main bearing support. For functional check of
thrust collar, the segments, and the bedplate, to the vibration damper a mechanical guide is fitted,
the end chocks and engine seating, and thus to while an electronic vibration monitor can be sup
the ships hull. plied as an option.

The thrust bearing is located in the aft end of the


engine. The thrust bearing is of the B&WMichell Tuning Wheel/
type, and consists primarily of a thrust collar on Torsional Vibration Damper
the crankshaft, a bearing support, and segments
of steel lined with white metal. A tuning wheel or torsional vibration damper may
have to be ordered separately, depending on the
final torsional vibration calculations.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC/MC-C-TII,
L70MC-C-TII, S60MC/MC-C-TII, L60MC-C-TII,
MAN Diesel 198 74 71-6.1

S50MC/MC-C-TII
MAN B&W 1.06
Page 3 of 6

Connecting Rod Crosshead

The connecting rod is made of forged steel and The crosshead is of forged steel and is provided
provided with bearing caps for the crosshead and with cast steel guide shoes of low-friction design
crankpin bearings. with white metal on the running surface.

The crosshead and crankpin bearing caps are The telescopic pipe for oil inlet and the pipe for oil
secured to the connecting rod with studs and nuts outlet are mounted on the guide shoes.
tightened by means of hydraulic jacks.

The crosshead bearing consists of a set of Scavenge Air System


thinwalled steel shells, lined with bearing metal.
The crosshead bearing cap is in one piece, with The air intake to the turbocharger takes place
an angular cutout for the piston rod. directly from the engine room through the turbo
charger intake silencer. From the turbocharger,
The crankpin bearing is provided with thinwalled the air is led via the charging air pipe, air cooler
steel shells, lined with bearing metal. Lube oil is and scavenge air receiver to the scavenge ports
supplied through ducts in the crosshead and con of the cylinder liners, see Chapter 14.
necting rod.

Scavenge Air Cooler


Piston
For each turbocharger a scavenge air cooler of
The piston consists of a piston crown and piston the monoblock type is fitted. The cooler is de
skirt. The piston crown is made of heatresistant signed as a central cooling system cooled by
steel. A piston cleaning ring located in the very freshwater of maximum 4.5 bar working pressure.
top of the cylinder liner scrapes off excessive ash Alternatively, a seawater cooling system with up to
and carbon formations on the piston topland. 2.0 2.5 bar working pressure can be chosen.

The piston has four ring grooves which are The scavenge air cooler is so designed that the
hardchrome plated on both the upper and lower difference between the scavenge air temperature
surfaces of the grooves. The uppermost piston and the water inlet temperature at specified MCR
ring is of the Controlled Pressure Relief type (CPR), can be kept at about 12 C.
whereas the other three piston rings all have an
oblique cut. All four rings are alu-coated on the
outer surface for running-in. Auxiliary Blower

The piston skirt is made of cast iron with a bronze The engine is provided with electricallydriven
band. scavenge air blowers. The suction side of the
blowers is connected to the scavenge air space
after the air cooler.
Piston Rod
Between the air cooler and the scavenge air receiv
The piston rod is of forged steel and is surface- er, nonreturn valves are fitted which automatically
hardened on the running surface for the stuffing close when the auxiliary blowers supply the air.
box. The piston rod is connected to the crosshead
with four bolts. The piston rod has a central bore The auxiliary blowers will start operating con
which, in conjunction with a cooling oil pipe, forms secutively before the engine is started in order to
the inlet and outlet for cooling oil. ensure sufficient scavenge air pressure to obtain a
safe start.

Further information is given in Chapter 14.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC/MC-C-TII,
L70MC-C-TII, S60MC/MC-C-TII, L60MC-C-TII,
MAN Diesel 198 74 71-6.1

S50MC/MC-C-TII
MAN B&W 1.06
Page 4 of 6

Exhaust Gas System Chain Drive

From the exhaust valves, exhaust gas is led to the The camshaft is driven from the crankshaft by a
exhaust gas receiver where the fluctuating pres chain drive, which is kept running tight by a manu
sure from the individual cylinders is equalised, ally adjusted chain tightener. The long free lengths
and the total volume of gas is led further on to the of chain are supported by rubber-clad guidebars
turbocharger(s). After the turbocharger(s), the gas and the chain is lubricated through oil spray pipes
is led to the external exhaust pipe system. fitted at the chain wheels and guidebars.

Compensators are fitted between the exhaust The mechanical cylinder lubricators, if fitted, are
valves and the receiver, and between the receiver driven from the camshaft by a separate chain.
and the turbocharger(s).

The exhaust gas receiver and exhaust pipes are Indicator Drive
provided with insulation, covered by galvanised
steel plating. As separate options, the engine can be supplied
with either an indicator drive, a mechanical indica
A protective grating is installed between the ex tor system, or the so-called PMI system, a pres
haust gas receiver and the turbocharger. sure analyser system, described in section 18.02.

The indicator drive consists of a cam fitted on the


Exhaust Turbocharger camshaft and a springloaded spindle with a roller
which moves up and down in accordance with the
The engines can be fitted with either MAN, ABB or movement of the piston within the engine cylinder.
Mitsubishi (MHI) turbochargers. At the top, the spindle has an eye to which the
indicator cord is fastened after the indicator has
The turbocharger choice is described in Chapter been installed on the indicator valve.
3, and the exhaust gas system in Chapter 15.

Governor
Camshaft and Cams
The engine is to be provided with a governor of
The camshaft consists of a number of sections a make approved by MAN Diesel, controlling the
each having a shaft piece with exhaust cams, fuel fuel pump through an actuator. The governor must
cams, coupling parts and indicator drive cams. meet the ISO 3046 standard, part IV, 1997.

The exhaust cams and fuel cams are made of The speed setting of the actuator is determined by
steel, with a hardened roller race, and are shrunk an electronic signal from the electronic governor
onto the shaft. They can be adjusted and disman based on the position of the main engine regulat
tled hydraulically. ing handle. The actuator is connected to the fuel
regulating shaft by means of a mechanical linkage.
The cam for the indicator drive can be adjusted
mechanically. The coupling parts are shrunk onto
the shaft and can be adjusted and dismantled hy
draulically.

The camshaft bearings consist of one lower half-


shell fitted in a bearing support, whereas the
S50MC bearings have an upper half shell, too.
The camshaft is lubricated by the main lubricating
oil system.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC/MC-C-TII,
L70MC-C-TII, S60MC/MC-C-TII, L60MC-C-TII,
MAN Diesel 198 74 71-6.1

S50MC/MC-C-TII
MAN B&W 1.06
Page 5 of 6

Fuel Oil Pump and An automatic vent slide allows circulation of fuel
Fuel Oil High Pressure Pipes oil through the valve and high pressure pipes
when the engine is stopped. The vent slide also
The engine is provided with one fuel pump for prevents the compression chamber from being
each cylinder. The fuel pump consists of a pump filled up with fuel oil in the event that the valve
housing of nodular cast iron, a centrally placed spindle sticks. Oil from the vent slide and other
pump barrel, and a plunger of nitrated steel. In drains is led away in a closed system.
order to prevent fuel oil from mixing with the lu
bricating oil, the pump actuator is provided with a The starting air valve is opened by control air
sealing arrangement. from the starting air distributor and is closed by a
spring. The control air supply is regulated so that
The pump is placed on the roller guide hous the starting valves deliver starting air to the cylin
ing and activated by the fuel cam. The volume ders in the correct firing order.
injected is controlled by turning the plunger by
means of a toothed rack connected to the regulat
ing shaft. Starting Air System

For optimal combination of NOx and SFOC, the The starting air system comprises a main starting
fuel pumps incorporate Variable Injection Timing valve, one or two starting air distributors and a non-
(VIT). The VIT uses the governor fuel setting as the return valve, a bursting disc for the branch pipe and
controlling parameter. a starting valve on each cylinder. The main starting
valve is connected with the manoeuvring system,
The fuel oil pump is provided with a puncture which controls the start of the engine.
valve, which prevents high pressure from building
up during normal stopping and shut down. A slow turning valve can be ordered as an option.
The slowturning function is actuated manually
The roller guide housing is provided with a semi- from the manoeuvring console.
automatic (optional on engines type 70, 60 and
50) lifting device which, during rotation of the en The starting air system is described in detail in
gine, can lift the roller guide free of the cam. Section 13.01.

The fuel oil highpressure pipes are either double-


walled or of the hose type. Exhaust Valve

Further information is given in Section 7.01. The exhaust valve consists of the valve housing
and the valve spindle. The valve housing is made
of cast iron and is arranged for water cooling. The
Fuel Valves and Starting Air Valve housing is provided with a water cooled bottom
piece of steel with a flame-hardened seat of the
Each cylinder cover is equipped with two or three W-seat design. The exhaust valve spindle is a
fuel valves, starting air valve (SAV), and indicator Dura Spindle or made of Nimonic. The housing is
valve. provided with a spindle guide.

The opening of the fuel valves is controlled by the The exhaust valve is tightened to the cylinder cov
high fuel oil pressure created by the fuel oil pump, er with studs and nuts. It is opened hydraulically
and the valves are closed by a spring. The fuel and closed by means of air pressure. The hydrau
valves are cooled by the fuel. lic system consists of a piston actuator placed
on the roller guide housing, a highpressure pipe,
and a working cylinder on the exhaust valve. The
piston actuator is activated by a cam on the cam
shaft.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC/MC-C-TII,
L70MC-C-TII, S60MC/MC-C-TII, L60MC-C-TII,
MAN Diesel 198 74 71-6.1

S50MC/MC-C-TII
MAN B&W 1.06
Page 6 of 6

In operation, the valve spindle slowly rotates, driv by means of an angular displaceable roller in the
en by the exhaust gas acting on small vanes fixed driving mechanism for the fuel pump of each
to the spindle. engine cylinder. The reversing mechanism is acti
vated and controlled by compressed air supplied
Sealing of the exhaust valve spindle guide is pro to the engine.
vided by means of Controlled Oil Level (COL), an
oil bath in the bottom of the air cylinder, above the The exhaust valve gear is not to be reversed.
sealing ring. This oil bath lubricates the exhaust
valve spindle guide and sealing ring as well.
Gallery Arrangement

Cylinder Lubrication The engine is provided with gallery brackets, stan


chions, railings, platforms, and ladders between
The cylinder lubrication system can be of either platforms. The brackets are placed at such a
the electronic MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubrica height as to provide the best possible overhauling
tion system or a mechanical type. and inspection conditions.

The cylinder lubrication systems are described in The engine is prepared for top bracings on the ex
detail in Chapter 9. haust side, or on the manoeuvring side.

Manoeuvring System Piping Arrangements

The engine is provided with a pneumatic/electric The engine is delivered with piping arrangements
manoeuvring and fuel oil regulating system. The for:
system transmits orders from the separate ma
noeuvring consoles to the engine. Fuel oil
Heating of fuel oil pipes
The regulating system makes it possible to start, Lubricating oil, piston cooling oil and
stop, reverse the engine and control the engine camshaft lubrication
speed. The speed control on the manoeuvring Cylinder lubricating oil
console gives a speedsetting signal to the gover Cooling water to scavenge air cooler
nor, dependent on the desired number of revolu Jacket and turbocharger cooling water
tions. Cleaning of scavenge air cooler
Cleaning of turbocharger
At shut-down, the fuel injection is stopped by the Fire extinguishing in scavenge air space
puncture valves in the fuel pumps being activated, Starting air
independently of the speed control. At reversing, Control air
the displaceable rollers in the driving mechanism Safety air
for the fuel pumps are moved to the Astern posi Oil mist detector
tion by air cylinders controlled by the starting air Various drain pipes.
distributor.
All piping arrangements are made of steel piping,
The engine is provided with an engine side mount except the control air, safety air and steam heat
ed console and instrument panel. ing of fuel pipes, which are made of copper.

The pipes are provided with sockets for local


Reversing instruments, alarm and safety equipment and,
furthermore, with a number of sockets for supple
On reversible engines (with Fixed Pitch Propel mentary signal equipment. Chapter 18 deals with
lers mainly), reversing of the engine is performed the instrumentation.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC/MC-C-TII,
L70MC-C-TII, S60MC/MC-C-TII, L60MC-C-TII,
MAN Diesel 198 74 71-6.1

S50MC/MC-C-TII
MAN B&W 1.07
Page  of 1

Engine Cross Section

Please see the specific engine Project Guide

MAN Diesel 198 58 86-4.0


MAN B&W

Engine Layout and Load


Diagrams, SFOC

2
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 2.01
Page 1 of 2

Engine Layout and Load Diagrams


y=log(P)
Introduction i
P=n xc
i=0
The effective power P of a diesel engine is pro- log (P) = i x log (n) + log (c)
portional to the mean effective pressure pe and
engine speed n, i.e. when using c as a constant: i=1

P = c x pe x n
i=2
so, for constant mep, the power is proportional to
the speed:

P = c x n1 (for constant mep) i=3


x = log (n)
178 05 403.1
When running with a Fixed Pitch Propeller (FPP),
the power may be expressed according to the Fig. 2.01.02: Power function curves in logarithmic scales
propeller law as:
Thus, propeller curves will be parallel to lines hav-
P = c x n3 (propeller law) ing the inclination i = 3, and lines with constant
mep will be parallel to lines with the inclination i = 1.
Thus, for the above examples, the power P may
be expressed as a power function of the speed n Therefore, in the Layout Diagrams and Load Dia-
to the power of i, i.e.: grams for diesel engines, logarithmic scales are
used, giving simple diagrams with straight lines.
P = c x ni

Fig. 2.01.01 shows the relationship for the linear Propulsion and Engine Running Points
functions, y = ax + b, using linear scales.
Propeller curve
The power functions P = c x ni will be linear func-
tions when using logarithmic scales: The relation between power and propeller speed
for a fixed pitch propeller is as mentioned above
log (P) = i x log (n) + log (c) described by means of the propeller law, i.e. the
y third power curve:

P = c x n3, in which:

y=ax+b P = engine power for propulsion


2
n = propeller speed
c = constant

a
Propeller design point
1

Normally, estimates of the necessary propeller


b power and speed are based on theoretical cal-
culations for loaded ship, and often experimental
0 x tank tests, both assuming optimum operating
0 1 2
conditions, i.e. a clean hull and good weather. The
178 05 403.0 combination of speed and power obtained may
Fig. 2.01.01: Straight lines in linear scales be called the ships propeller design point (PD),

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 338.4
MAN B&W 2.01
Page 2 of 2

placed on the light running propeller curve 6. See the socalled sea margin, which is traditionally
below figure. On the other hand, some shipyards, about 15% of the propeller design (PD) power.
and/or propeller manufacturers sometimes use a
propeller design point (PD) that incorporates all or Engine layout (heavy propeller)
part of the socalled sea margin described below.
When determining the necessary engine layout
Power, % af L1 speed that considers the influence of a heavy run-
100%
= 0,20
= 0,15 L1 ning propeller for operating at high extra ship resis-
= 0,25 = 0,30
tance, it is (compared to line 6) recommended to
choose a heavier propeller line 2. The propeller
L3 MP
curve for clean hull and calm weather line 6 may
Engine margin
(SP=90% of MP)
SP
PD
then be said to represent a light running (LR)
Sea margin
L2 (15% of PD) propeller.
PD

Compared to the heavy engine layout line 2, we


L4
HR
recommend using a light running of 3.07.0% for
2 6 LR
design of the propeller.
Engine speed, % of L 1

100% Engine margin


Line 2 Propulsion curve, fouled hull and heavy weather
(heavy running), recommended for engine layout
Line 6 Propulsion curve, clean hull and calm weather (light
Besides the sea margin, a socalled engine mar-
running), for propeller layout gin of some 10% or 15% is frequently added. The
MP Specified MCR for propulsion corresponding point is called the specified MCR
SP Continuous service rating for propulsion
PD Propeller design point
for propulsion (MP), and refers to the fact that the
HR Heavy running power for point SP is 10% or 15% lower than for
LR Light running
178 05 415.3
point MP.
Fig. 2.01.03: Ship propulsion running points and engine
Point MP is identical to the engines specified
layout
MCR point (M) unless a main engine driven shaft
generator is installed. In such a case, the extra
Fouled hull power demand of the shaft generator must also
be considered.
When the ship has sailed for some time, the hull
and propeller become fouled and the hulls re- Constant ship speed lines
sistance will increase. Consequently, the ships
speed will be reduced unless the engine delivers The constant ship speed lines , are shown at
more power to the propeller, i.e. the propeller will the very top of the figure. They indicate the power
be further loaded and will be heavy running (HR). required at various propeller speeds in order to
keep the same ship speed. It is assumed that, for
As modern vessels with a relatively high service each ship speed, the optimum propeller diameter
speed are prepared with very smooth propeller is used, taking into consideration the total propul-
and hull surfaces, the gradual fouling after sea sion efficiency. See definition of in Section 2.02.
trial will increase the hulls resistance and make
the propeller heavier running. Note:
Light/heavy running, fouling and sea margin are
Sea margin and heavy weather overlapping terms. Light/heavy running of the
propeller refers to hull and propeller deterioration
If, at the same time the weather is bad, with head and heavy weather, whereas sea margin i.e. extra
winds, the ships resistance may increase com- power to the propeller, refers to the influence of
pared to operating in calm weather conditions. the wind and the sea. However, the degree of light
When determining the necessary engine power, it running must be decided upon experience from
is normal practice to add an extra power margin, the actual trade and hull design of the vessel.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 338.4
MAN B&W 2.02
Page 1 of 2

Propeller diameter and pitch, influence on the optimum propeller speed

In general, the larger the propeller diameter D, Once an optimum propeller diameter of maximum
the lower is the optimum propeller speed and the 7.2 m has been chosen, the corresponding op-
kW required for a certain design draught and ship timum pitch in this point is given for the design
speed, see curve D in the figure below. speed of 14.5 knots, i.e. P/D = 0.70.

The maximum possible propeller diameter de- However, if the optimum propeller speed of 100
pends on the given design draught of the ship, r/min does not suit the preferred / selected main
and the clearance needed between the propeller engine speed, a change of pitch away from opti-
and the aft body hull and the keel. mum will only cause a relatively small extra power
demand, keeping the same maximum propeller
The example shown in the figure is an 80,000 dwt diameter:
crude oil tanker with a design draught of 12.2 m
and a design speed of 14.5 knots. going from 100 to 110 r/min (P/D = 0.62) requires
8,900 kW i.e. an extra power demand of 80 kW.
When the optimum propeller diameter D is in-
creased from 6.6 m to 7.2. m, the power demand going from 100 to 91 r/min (P/D = 0.81) requires
is reduced from about 9,290 kW to 8,820 kW, and 8,900 kW i.e. an extra power demand of 80 kW.
the optimum propeller speed is reduced from 120
r/min to 100 r/min, corresponding to the constant In both cases the extra power demand is only
ship speed coefficient = 0.28 (see definition of of 0.9%, and the corresponding equal speed
in Section 2.02, page 2). curves are =+0.1 and =0.1, respectively, so
there is a certain interval of propeller speeds in
which the power penalty is very limited.

Shaft power

kW
9.500
D = Optimum propeller diameters
9.400 P/D = Pitch/diameter ratio
D P/D
0.50
9.300 6.6m
P/D
1.00
9.200
6.8m
0.95
9.100
0.55
0.90
9.000
7.0m
0.85
8.900 0.60
0.80 7.2m
0.75 0.65
8.800 0.70

8.700 7.4m

8.600 D

Propeller
8.500
speed
70 80 90 100 110 120 130 r/min

178 47 032.0

Fig. 2.02.01: Influence of diameter and pitch on propeller design

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-GI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 782.5
MAN B&W 2.02
Page 2 of 2

Constant ship speed lines area and parallel to one of the lines, another
specified propulsion MCR point MP2 upon this
The constant ship speed lines , are shown at line can be chosen to give the ship the same
the very top of Fig. 2.02.02. These lines indicate speed for the new combination of engine power
the power required at various propeller speeds to and speed.
keep the same ship speed provided that the op-
timum propeller diameter with an optimum pitch Fig. 2.02.02 shows an example of the required
diameter ratio is used at any given speed, taking power speed point MP1, through which a constant
into consideration the total propulsion efficiency. ship speed curve = 0.25 is drawn, obtaining
point MP2 with a lower engine power and a lower
Normally, the following relation between neces- engine speed but achieving the same ship speed.
sary power and propeller speed can be assumed:
Provided the optimum pitch/diameter ratio is used
P2 = P1 x (n2 /n1) for a given propeller diameter the following data
applies when changing the propeller diameter:
where:
P = Propulsion power for general cargo, bulk carriers and tankers
n = Propeller speed, and = 0.25 0.30
= the constant ship speed coefficient.
and for reefers and container vessels
For any combination of power and speed, each = 0.15 0.25
point on lines parallel to the ship speed lines gives
the same ship speed. When changing the propeller speed by changing
the pitch diameter ratio, the constant will be dif-
When such a constant ship speed line is drawn ferent, see above.
into the layout diagram through a specified pro-
pulsion MCR point MP1, selected in the layout

Power

110%
=0,15
speed lines
=0,20
=0,25 Constant ship 100%
=0,30 1

90%

MP1
=0,25 80%
MP2
3
me p
% 70%
100
95%
90%
2
85% 60%

80%
75%

70% 50%

4 Nominal propeller curve

40%

75% 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105%


Engine speed

178 05 667.0

Fig. 2.02.02: Layout diagram and constant ship speed lines

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-GI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 782.5
MAN B&W 2.03
Page 1 of 1

Layout Diagram Sizes

Power Power 100 80% power and Power Power 100 80% power and
L1 100 84%L
1 speed range L1 L1 100 90% speed range
valid for the types: L3 L3 valid for the types:
L3 L3
L2 L70MC-C/ME-C8,
L
2 L2 L2 K90ME/ME-C9,
L4 L4 K80ME-C9
L4 L4

Speed Speed Speed Speed

Power Power 100 80% power and Power Power 100 80% power and
L1 100 85%L
1
speed range L1 L1 100 93% speed range
L3 L3
L3
valid for the types: valid for the types:
L3
L2 K90MC-C/6L
2
L2 L2 K98MC/MC-C7,
K80MC-C/ME-C6, L4 L4 K98ME/ME-C7
L4 L4
L60MC-C/ME-C8, S46MC-C8,
S46ME-B8, S42MC7, S40ME-
B9, S35MC7, S35ME-B9,
Speed L35MC6,
Speed S26MC6, Speed Speed
S90MC-C/ME-C8,
S80MC-C8, S80ME-C8/9,
S70MC-C/ME-C8/-GI, S65ME-
C8/-GI, S60MC-C/ME-C8/-GI,
S60ME-B8, S50MC-C/ME-C8, Power Power 100 90% power and
S50ME-B8/9 L1 L1 100 91.5% speed range
L3
L3
L2 L2 valid for the types:
L4 L4 S40MC-C9,
S35MC-C9,

Speed Speed

178 60 45-2.0

See also Section 2.05 for actual project.

Fig. 2.03.01 Layout diagram sizes

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/ME-B/-GI-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 11-0.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 1 of 10

Engine Layout and Load Diagram

Engine Layout Diagram Optimising point (O)

An engines layout diagram is limited by two con- The optimising point O is the rating at which the
stant mean effective pressure (mep) lines L1 L3 turbocharger is matched, and at which the engine
and L2 L4, and by two constant engine speed timing and compression ratio are adjusted. Point
lines L1 L2 and L3 L4. The L1 point refers to the M normally coincides with point O.
engines nominal maximum continuous rating, see
Fig. 2.04.01. The optimising point O is placed on line 1 of the
load diagram, see Fig. 2.04.02, and for technical
In the layout area, the engines specified SMCR reasons the optimised power always has to be
point M can be set freely to suit the ships de- equal to 100% of point Ms power.
mand for propeller power and speed.

On the horizontal axis and on the vertical axis the Power


L1
engine speed and the engine power are shown,
respectively, on percentage scales. The scales
O=M
are logarithmic, which means that, in this diagram,
power function curves like propeller curves (3rd L3
S
power), constant mean effective pressure curves
(1st power) and constant ship speed curves (0.15
1 L2
to 0.30 power) are straight lines.

L4
Specified maximum continuous rating (M)
Speed
Based on the propulsion and engine running
points, found previously, the layout diagram of a 178 60 85-8.0

relevant main engine can be drawnin. The SMCR Fig. 2.04.01: Engine layout diagram
point (M) must be inside the limitation lines of the
layout diagram; if it is not, the propeller speed
must be changed or another main engine type
chosen.

Continuous service rating (S)

The continuous service rating is the power need-


ed in service - including the specified sea margin
and heavy/light running factor of the propeller
- at which the engine is to operate, and point S
is identical to the service propulsion point (SP)
unless a main engine driven shaft generator is
installed.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 2 of 10

Engine Load Diagram Engine shaft power, % of A

110
Definitions 105 7
O=A=M
100 7
5 5
95
The engines load diagram, see Fig. 2.04.02, de- 90 4
1 2 6
fines the power and speed limits for continuous as 85
80
well as overload operation of an installed engine 75
having an optimising point O and a specified MCR 70
point M that confirms the specification of the ship. 65

60
Point A is a 100% speed and power reference
55
point of the load diagram, and is defined as the 8 4 1 6 3
50
point on the propeller curve (line 1), through the
2 9
optimising point O, having the specified MCR 45
power. Normally, point M is equal to point A, but
40
in special cases, for example if a shaft generator 60 65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110
is installed, point M may be placed to the right of Engine speed, % of A

point A on line 7.
Regarding i in the power function P = c x n1, see page 2.01.
The service points of the installed engine incorpo- A 100% reference point
rate the engine power required for ship propulsion M Specified MCR point
and shaft generator, if installed. O Optimising point

Line 1 Propeller curve through optimising point (i = 3)


(engine layout curve)
Operating curves and limits for continuous Line 2 Propeller curve, fouled hull and heavy weather
heavy running (i = 3)
operation Line 3 Speed limit
Line 4 Torque/speed limit (i = 2)
The continuous service range is limited by four Line 5 Mean effective pressure limit (i = 1)
Line 6 Propeller curve, clean hull and calm weather
lines: 4, 5, 7 and 3 (9), see Fig. 2.04.02. The pro- light running (i = 3), for propeller layout
peller curves, line 1, 2 and 6 in the load diagram Line 7 Power limit for continuous running (i = 0)
are also described below. Line 8 Overload limit
Line 9 Speed limit at sea trial

Line 1: Point M to be located on line 7 (normally in point A)


178 39 18-4.1
Propeller curve through specified MCR (M) engine
layout curve. Fig. 2.04.02: Standard engine load diagram

Line 2:
Propeller curve, fouled hull and heavy weather
heavy running.
The overspeed set-point is 109% of the speed
Line 3 and line 9: in A, however, it may be moved to 109% of the
Line 3 represents the maximum acceptable speed nominal speed in L1, provided that the torsional
for continuous operation, i.e. 105% of A. vibration conditions permit.

During trial conditions, the maximum speed may Running at low load above 100% of the nominal L1
be extended to 107% of A, see line 9. speed of the engine, is, however, to be avoided for
extended periods. Only plants with controllable
The above limits may in general be extended to pitch propellers can reach this light running area.
105%, and during trial conditions to 107% of the
nominal L1 speed of the engine, provided that the
torsional vibration conditions permit.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 3 of 10

Line 4: Recommendation
Represents the limit at which an ample air supply
is available for combustion and imposes a limita- Continuous operation without limitations is al-
tion on the maximum combination of torque and lowed only within the area limited by lines 4, 5, 7
speed. and 3 of the Load diagram, except for CP propel-
ler plants mentioned in the previous section.
Line 5:
Represents the maximum mean effective pres- The area between lines 4 and 1 is available for
sure level (mep), which can be accepted for con- operation in shallow waters, heavy weather and
tinuous operation. during acceleration, i.e. for nonsteady operation
without any strict time limitation.
Line 6:
Propeller curve, clean hull and calm weather After some time in operation, the ships hull and
light running, used for propeller layout/design. propeller will be fouled, resulting in heavier run-
ning of the propeller, i.e. the propeller curve will
Line 7: move to the left of line 6 towards line 2, and extra
Represents the maximum power for continuous power is required for propulsion in order to keep
operation. the speed of the ship.

In calm weather conditions, the extent of heavy


Limits for overload operation running of the propeller will indicate the need for
cleaning the hull and possibly polishing the pro-
The overload service range is limited as follows: peller.

Line 8: Once the specified MCR (and the optimising point)


Represents the overload operation limitations. have been chosen, the capacities of the auxiliary
equipment will be adapted to the specified MCR,
The area between lines 4, 5, 7 and the heavy and the turbocharger specification and the com-
dashed line 8 is available for overload running for pression ratio will be selected.
limited periods only (1 hour per 12 hours).
If the specified MCR (and the optimising point) is
Line 9: to be increased later on, this may involve a change
Speed limit at sea trial. of the pump and cooler capacities, retiming of the
engine, change of the fuel valve nozzles, adjusting
the cylinder liner cooling, as well as rematching of
Limits for low load operation the turbocharger or even a change to a larger size
of turbocharger. In some cases, it can also require
The engine is able to operate down to around larger dimensions of the piping systems.
25% of nominal L1 speed.
It is therefore of the utmost importance to consid-
er, already at the project stage, if the specification
should be prepared for a later power increase.
This is to be indicated in item 4 02 010 of the Ex-
tent of Delivery.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 4 of 10

Extended load diagram for ships operating in extreme heavy running conditions

When a ship with fixed pitch propeller is operat- Extended load diagram for speed derated en-
ing in normal sea service, it will in general be gines with increased light running
operating in the hatched area around the design
propeller curve 6, as shown on the standard load The maximum speed limit (line 3) of the engines is
diagram in Fig. 2.04.02. 105% of the SMCR (Specified Maximum Continu-
ous Rating) speed, as shown in Fig. 2.04.02.
Sometimes, when operating in heavy weather, the
fixed pitch propeller performance will be more However, for speed and, thereby, power derated
heavy running, i.e. for equal power absorption of engines it is possible to extend the maximum
the propeller, the propeller speed will be lower speed limit to 105% of the engines nominal MCR
and the propeller curve will move to the left. speed, line 3, but only provided that the torsional
vibration conditions permit this. Thus, the shaft-
As the low speed main engines are directly cou- ing, with regard to torsional vibrations, has to be
pled to the propeller, the engine has to follow the approved by the classification society in question,
propeller performance, i.e. also in heavy running based on the extended maximum speed limit.
propeller situations. For this type of operation,
there is normally enough margin in the load area When choosing an increased light running to be
between line 6 and the normal torque/speed limi- used for the design of the propeller, the load dia-
tation line 4, see Fig. 2.04.02. To the left of line 4 gram area may be extended from line 3 to line 3,
in torquerich operation, the engine will lack air as shown in Fig. 2.04.03, and the propeller/main
from the turbocharger to the combustion process, engine operating curve 6 may have a correspond-
i.e. the heat load limits may be exceeded and ingly increased heavy running margin before ex-
bearing loads might also become too high. ceeding the torque/speed limit, line 4.

For some special ships and operating conditions, A corresponding slight reduction of the propel-
it would be an advantage when occasionally ler efficiency may be the result, due to the higher
needed to be able to operate the propeller/main propeller design speed used.
engine as much as possible to the left of line 6,
but inside the torque/speed limit, line 4.

Such cases could be for:

ships sailing in areas with very heavy weather


ships operating in ice
ships with two fixed pitch propellers/two main
engines, where one propeller/one engine is de-
clutched for one or the other reason.

The increase of the operating speed range be-


tween line 6 and line 4 of the standard load dia-
gram, see Fig. 2.04.02, may be carried out as
shown for the following engine Example with an
extended load diagram for speed derated engine
with increased light running:

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 5 of 10
Engine shaft power, % A L1
110 A 100% reference point Examples of the use of the Load Diagram
M Specified engine MCR A=O=M 5%
100 O Optimising point 5 7
90
L2
In the following, some examples are illustrating
L3
Heavy
the flexibility of the layout and load diagrams.
80
running Normal
operation L4 operation
70 Example 1 shows how to place the load dia-
gram for an engine without a shaft generator
60
4 coupled to a fixed pitch propeller.
1 6 3 3
50
2 Example 2 comprises diagrams for the same
configuration, here with the optimising point on
40 the left of the heavy running propeller curve (2),
55 60 65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 120
Engine speed, % A
providing an extra engine margin for heavy run-
Normal load Extended light ning, similar to the case in Fig. 2.04.03.
diagram area running area

Example 3 shows the same layout for an engine


Line 1: Propeller curve through optimising point (O) with a fixed pitch propeller (Example 1), but with
layout curve for engine a shaft generator.
Line 2: Heavy propeller curve
fouled hull and heavy seas
Line 3: Speed limit Example 4 is a special case of example 3, where
Line 3: Extended speed limit, provided torsional vibration the specified MCR is placed near the top of the
conditions permit
Line 4: Torque/speed limit layout diagram.
Line 5: Mean effective pressure limit
Line 6: Increased light running propeller curve In this case, the shaft generator is cut off, and
clean hull and calm weather
layout curve for propeller the gensets used when the engine runs at spec-
Line 7: Power limit for continuous running ified MCR. This makes it possible to choose a
178 60 94-2.0 smaller engine with a lower power output.

Fig. 2.04.03: Extended load diagram for speed derated Example 5 shows diagrams for an engine cou-
engine with increased light running pled to a controllable pitch propeller, with or
without a shaft generator, (constant speed or
combinator curve operation).

For a specific project, the layout diagram for the


actual project shown later in this chapter may be
used for drawing of the actual load diagram.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 6 of 10
Example 1: Normal running conditions.
Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and without a shaft generator

Layout diagram Load diagram

Power, % of%
Power, L1 of L Power, % of%
Power, L1 of L 3.3%A 5%A5%A
1 1 3.3%A
100%
100% 7 7
L 1L 1 100%
100%
L 1L 1
5 5
4 4
1 21 62 6

L 3L 3 A=O=M=MP
A=O=M=MP 7 7
L 3L 3 A=O=M
A=O=M
5
7 7
5
S=SP 5%L5%L
1
S=SP 1
S S

1 6
1 6 L 2L 2 4 4 1 61 6 L 2L 2
2 2 2 2

3 3 3 3

L 4L 4 Propulsion and engine


Propulsion and engine
L 4L 4 Propulsion and engine
Propulsion and engine
service curvecurve
service for fouled
for fouled service curvecurve
service for fouled
for fouled
hull and heavy weather
hull and heavy weather hull and heavy weather
hull and heavy weather

Engine speed,
Engine % of%
speed, L1of L 100%
100% Engine speed,
Engine % of%
speed, L1of L 100%
100%
1 1

M Specified MCR of engine Point A of the load diagram is found:


S Continuous service rating of engine Line 1 Propeller curve through optimising point (O)
O Optimising point of engine is equal to line 2
A Reference point of load diagram Line 7 Constant power line through specified MCR (M)
MP Specified MCR for propulsion Point A Intersection between line 1 and 7
SP Continuous service rating of propulsion

The specified MCR (M) and optimising point O and its propel- Once point A has been found in the layout diagram, the load
ler curve 1 will normally be selected on the engine service diagram can be drawn, as shown in the above figure, and
curve 2 (for fouled hull and heavy weather), as shown in the hence the actual load limitation lines of the diesel engine may
layout diagram. be found by using the inclinations from the construction lines
and the %figures stated.
Point A is then found at the intersection between propeller
curve 1 (2) and the constant power curve through M, line 7. In
178 39 20-6.0
this case, point A is equal to point M and point O.

Fig. 2.04.04: Normal running conditions. Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and without a shaft generator

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 7 of 10

Example 2: Special running conditions.


Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and without a shaft generator

Layout diagram Load diagram

Power,
Power,%
%of
ofLL11 Power,
Power,%%of
ofLL11 3.3%A 5%A
3.3%A 5%A
100%
100% 77
LL11
100%
100%
LL11
55

44

11 22 66

LL33 A=O
A=O
77
LL33 A=O
A=O
77
M=MP
M=MP 55 M
M
5%L
5%L11
S=SP
S=SP SS

11 22 66
LL22 44 11 22 66
LL22
33 33

LL44 Propulsion
Propulsionand
andengine
engine
LL44 Propulsion
Propulsionand
andengine
engine
service
servicecurve
curvefor
forfouled
fouled service
servicecurve
curvefor
forfouled
fouled
hull
hulland
andheavy
heavyweather
weather hull
hulland
andheavy
heavyweather
weather

Engine
Enginespeed,
speed,%
%of
ofLL11 100%
100% Engine
Enginespeed,
speed,%
%of
ofLL11 100%
100%

M Specified MCR of engine Point A of the load diagram is found:


S Continuous service rating of engine Line 1 Propeller curve through optimising point (O)
O Optimising point of engine placed to the left of line 2
A Reference point of load diagram Line 7 Constant power line through specified MCR (M)
MP Specified MCR for propulsion Point A Intersection between line 1 and 7
SP Continuous service rating of propulsion

In this example, the optimising point O has been selected


more to the left than in Example 1, providing an extra en-
gine margin for heavy running operation in heavy weather
conditions. In principle, the light running margin has been
increased for this case.
178 39 23-1.1

Fig. 2.04.05: Special running conditions. Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and without a shaft generator

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 8 of 10
Example 3: Normal running conditions.
Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and with a shaft generator

Layout diagram Load diagram

Power, % of L1 Power, % of L1 3.3%A 5%A


Power, % of L1 Power, % of L1 3.3%A 5%A
100% 100%
100% 7
7 L 1L 1 100%
LL1 1
5
5 Engine service curve for
Engine service curve for
4 4 A=O=M fouled hullhull
andandheavy
A=O=M
7 7 fouled heavy A=O=M
weather incl.incl.
shaft A=O=M7
1 2 16 2 6 weather shaft 5 5 7
generator
generator
S SG SG
L 3L 3 S
L 3L 3 S S
5%L11
5%L
SG SGMP MP MPMP
Engine
Engine
service
service
SP SP 4 4
curvecurve SPSP

1 2 62
L 2L 2 LL2 2
1 6 1 1 2 26 6
33 33

L 4L 4 L 4L 4
Propulsion curvecurve
Propulsion for fouled
for fouled Propulsion
Propulsion curve forfor
curve fouled
fouled
hull and
hull heavy weather
and heavy weather hullhull
and heavy
and weather
heavy weather

Engine
Engine speed,
speed, % of%
L1of L1 100%
100% Engine
Engine speed,
speed, %%of of
L1 L1 100%
100%

M Specified MCR of engine Point A of the load diagram is found:


S Continuous service rating of engine Line 1 Propeller curve through optimising point (O)
O Optimising point of engine Line 7 Constant power line through specified MCR (M)
A Reference point of load diagram Point A Intersection between line 1 and 7
MP Specified MCR for propulsion
SP Continuous service rating of propulsion
SG Shaft generator power

In Example 3, a shaft generator (SG) is installed, and therefore The optimising point O=A=M will be chosen on the engine
the service power of the engine also has to incorporate the service curve as shown.
extra shaft power required for the shaft generators electrical
power production. Point A is then found in the same way as in Example 1, and
the load diagram can be drawn as shown in the above figure.
In the Layout diagram, the engine service curve shown for
heavy running incorporates this extra power.

178 39 25-5.1

Fig. 2.04.06: Normal running conditions. Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and with a shaft generator

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 9 of 10

Example 4: Special running conditions.


Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and with a shaft generator

Layout diagram Load diagram


3.3%A 5%A

Power, % of L1 L1 Power, % of L1 L1
M M
100% 7 100%
O=A O=A
7 Engine service curve for fouled 7
5
S M hull and heavy weather
S
M
4 incl. shaft generator
SG MP SG MP
1 2 6
5% L1
L3 SP
L3 4
SP

Engine
service
curve
1 2 6 1 2 6 L2
L2
3 3

L4 Propulsion curve L4 Propulsion curve


for fouled hull for fouled hull
and heavy weather and heavy weather

Engine speed, % of L1 100% Engine speed, % of L1 100%

M Specified MCR of engine Point A and M of the load diagram are found:
S Continuous service rating of engine Line 1 Propeller curve through point S
O Optimising point of engine Point A Intersection between line 1 and line L1 L3
A Reference point of load diagram Point M Located on constant power line 7
MP Specified MCR for propulsion through point A and with MPs speed
SP Continuous service rating of propulsion Point O Equal to point A
SG Shaft generator

Also in this special case, a shaft generator is installed but, propulsion power range, a diesel generator has to take over
compared to Example 3, this case has a specified MCR for all or part of the electrical power production.
propulsion, MP, placed at the top of the layout diagram.
However, such a situation will seldom occur, as ships are
This involves that the intended specified MCR of the engine rather infrequently running in the upper propulsion power
M will be placed outside the top of the layout diagram. range.

One solution could be to choose a larger diesel engine with Point A, having the highest possible power, is then found at
an extra cylinder, but another and cheaper solution is to re- the intersection of line L1 L3 with line 1. see the Layout dia-
duce the electrical power production of the shaft generator gram, and the corresponding load diagram is drawn. Point M
when running in the upper propulsion power range. is found on line 7 at MPs speed, and point O= A.

In choosing the latter solution, the required specified MCR


power can be reduced from point M to point M as shown in
the Layout diagram. Therefore, when running in the upper
178 39 28-0.0

Fig. 2.04.07: Special running conditions. Engine coupled to a fixed pitch propeller (FPP) and with a shaft generator

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.04
Page 10 of 10

Example 5: Engine coupled to a controllable pitch propeller (CPP) with or without a shaft generator

Power
7
Layout diagram with shaft generator
5
3.3%A 5%A The hatched area shows the recommended speed
4 L1 range between 100% and 96.7% of the specified
1 2 6 MCR speed for an engine with a shaft generator
running at constant speed.

L3 A=O=M
5
7 The service point S can be located at any point
5%L1 within the hatched area.
S

4 1
L2 The procedure shown in examples 3 and 4 for
engines with FPP can also be applied here for en-
3
gines with CPP running with a combinator curve.

L4 The optimising point O


O may, as earlier discribed, be chosen equal to
Min. speed Max. speed
point M, see below.
Combinator curve for Recommended range for
loaded ship and incl. shaft generator operation
sea margin with constant speed Load diagram
Therefore, when the engines specified MCR point
Engine speed (M) has been chosen, including engine margin,
M Specified MCR of engine
sea margin and the power for a shaft generator,
S Continous service rating of engine if installed, point M can be used as point A of the
O Optimising point of engine load diagram, which can then be drawn.
A Reference point of load diagram

178 39 31-4.4 The position of the combinator curve ensures the


maximum load range within the permitted speed
Fig. 2.04.08: Engine with Controllable Pitch Propeller range for engine operation, and it still leaves a
(CPP), with or without a shaft generator reasonable margin to the limit indicated by curves
4 and 5.

Layout diagram without shaft generator


If a controllable pitch propeller (CPP) is applied,
the combinator curve (of the propeller) will nor-
mally be selected for loaded ship, including a sea
margin.

For a given propeller speed the combinator curve


may have a given propeller pitch, and this may
be heavy running in heavy weather like for a fixed
pitch propeller.

Therefore, it is recommended to use a light run-


ning combinator curve (the dotted curve which
includes the sea power margin) as shown in the
figure to obtain an increased operation margin of
the diesel engine in heavy weather to the limit, indi-
cated by lines 4 and 5.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 69 94-7.1
MAN B&W 2.05
Page 1 of 1

Diagram for actual project

This figure contains a layout diagram that can


be used for constructing the load diagram for an
actual project, using the %figures stated and the
inclinations of the lines. 3.3%A 5%A

A
7
7 5

5
4
4

1 2 6

Power, % of L 1

110%

100%
L1
L 3L 3
L3
90% L2
L3 5%L1
L3 L4
80%
L2
L4
70% L4

L4 L4

60%

50%

40%
70% 75% 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105% 110%

Engine speed, % of L 1

L70MCC/MEC8

K90MCC6, K80MCC/MEC6, L60MCC/MEC8, S46MCC8, S46MEB8, S42MC7, S40MEB9, S35MC7, S35MEB9, L35MC6,
S26MC6, S90MCC/MEC8, S80MCC8, S80MEC8/9, S70MCC/MEC8/GI, S65MEC8/GI, S60MCC/MEC8/GI,
S60MEB8, S50MCC/MEC8, S50MEB8/9

K90ME/MEC9, K80MEC9

S40MCC9, S35MCC9

K98MC/MCC7, K98ME/MEC7
178 60 36-8.1

Fig. 2.05.01: Construction of layout diagram

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide-TII


MAN Diesel 198 69 08-7.1
MAN B&W 2.06
Page  of 1

Specific Fuel Oil Consumption, ME versus MC engines

This section is not applicable

MAN Diesel 198 53 10-1.0


MAN B&W 2.07
Page 1 of 1

SFOC for High Efficiency Turbochargers

All engine types 50 and larger are as standard Consumption (SFOC) values, see example in
fitted with high efficiency turbochargers, option: Fig. 2.07.01.
4 59 104.
At part load running the lowest SFOC may be
The high efficiency turbocharger is applied to obtained at 80% of the optimised power = 80%
the engine in the basic design with the view to of the specified MCR.
obtaining the lowest possible Specific Fuel Oil

SFOC
g/kWh
+2

High efficiency turbocharger


0

4
50% 60% 70% 80% 90% 100%

Engine power, % of optimising point O

178 60 99-1.0

Fig. 2.07.01: Example of part load SFOC curves for high efficiency turbochargers

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C6/7-TII, S90MC-C7/8-TII, K90MC-C6-TII,


S80MC6-TII, S80MC-C7/8-TII, K80MC-C6-TII S70MC6-TII,
S70MC-C7/8-TII, L70MC-C7/8-TII, S60MC6-TII, S60MC-C7/8-TII,
MAN Diesel 198 70 12-8.0

L60MC-C7/8-TII, S50MC6-TII, S50MC-C7/8-TII


MAN B&W 2.08
Page 1 of 2

SFOC reference conditions and guarantee

SFOC at reference conditions SFOC guarantee

The SFOC is given in g/kWh based on The SFOC guarantee refers to the above ISO ref-
the reference ambient conditions stated in erence conditions and lower calorific value and is
ISO 3046-1:2002(E) and ISO 15550:2002(E): valid for one running point only. The guaranteed
running point is equal to the powerspeed combi-
1,000 mbar ambient air pressure nation in the optimising point (O) = 100% SMCR
25 C ambient air temperature but, if requested, a running point between 85%
25 C scavenge air coolant temperature and 100% SMCR can be selected.

and is related to a fuel oil with a lower calorific The SFOC guarantee is given with a tolerance
value of 42,700 kJ/kg (~10,200 kcal/kg). of 5%.

Any discrepancies between g/kWh and g/BHPh


are due to the rounding of numbers for the latter. Recommended cooling water temperature
during normal operation
For lower calorific values and for ambient condi-
tions that are different from the ISO reference In general, it is recommended to operate the main
conditions, the SFOC will be adjusted according engine with the lowest possible cooling water
to the conversion factors in the table below. temperature to the air coolers, as this will reduce
the fuel consumption of the engine, i.e. the engine
With Without performance will be improved.
pmax pmax
adjusted adjusted
Condition SFOC SFOC
However, shipyards often specify a constant
Parameter change change change (maximum) central cooling water temperature
Scav. air coolant of 36 C, not only for tropical ambient tempera-
per 10 C rise + 0.60% + 0.41%
temperature ture conditions, but also for lower ambient tem-
Blower inlet tem-
per 10 C rise + 0.20% + 0.71%
perature conditions. The purpose is probably to
perature reduce the electric power consumption of the
Blower inlet per 10 mbar cooling water pumps and/or to reduce water con-
0.02% 0.05%
pressure rise densation in the air coolers.
Fuel oil lower rise 1%
1.00% 1.00%
calorific value (42,700 kJ/kg) Thus, when operating with 36 C cooling water
instead of for example 10 C (to the air coolers),
With for instance 1 C increase of the scavenge the specific fuel oil consumption will increase by
air coolant temperature, a corresponding 1 C in- approx. 2 g/kWh.
crease of the scavenge air temperature will occur
and involves an SFOC increase of 0.06% if pmax is
adjusted to the same value.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C TII-engines


MAN Diesel 198 74 64-5.0
MAN B&W 2.08
Page 2 of 2

Examples of Graphic Calculation of SFOC

The following diagrams a, b and c, valid for fixed


pitch propeller (b) and constant speed (c), respec-
tively, show the reduction of SFOC in g/kWh, rela-
tive to the SFOC for the nominal MCR L1 rating.

The solid lines are valid at 100%, 80% and 50% of


the optimising point (O).

Point O is drawn into the abovementioned Dia-


grams b or c. A straight line along the constant
mep curves (parallel to L1L3) is drawn through
point O. The intersections of this line and the
curves indicate the reduction in specific fuel oil
consumption at 100, 80 and 50% of the optimis-
ing point, related to the SFOC stated for the nomi-
nal MCR L1 rating.

An example of the calculated SFOC curves are


shown in Diagram a, and is valid for an engine
with fixed pitch propeller, see Fig. 2.10.01.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 70 18-9.0
MAN B&W 2.09
Page 1 of 6

SFOC Calculations for K98MC/MC-C7

Data at nominel MCR (L1) SFOC at nominal MCR (L1)


High efficiency TC
Engine kW r/min g/kWh
6-12 and 14K98MC7 6,230 97 177
6-12 and 14K98MC-C7 6,020 104 177

Data matching point (O=M): Diagram a


SFOC
cyl. No. g/kWh Part Load SFOC curve
+4
Power: 100% of (O) kW
+3
Speed: 100% of (O) r/min
+2
SFOC found: g/kWh
+1

0 Nominal SFOC

10

11

12

13

14

15

16
40% 50% 60% 70% 80% 90% 100% 110%

% of optimising point

178 60 92-9.0

Fig. 2.09.01

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 55-8.0
MAN B&W 2.09
Page 2 of 6

SFOC for K98MC/MC-C7 with fixed pitch propeller

Power, % of L1

=0.15 lines
ship speed
=0.20 Constant 100%
=0.25 =0.30

90%

Diagram b 80%
in L1
ina l er
nom p ow mep
to the ptim
ise d
6 10 0% 70%
t i ve 5
% o
10 0
h r ela 3
4 95%
g / kW
er 1 2
p ow 0 9 0%
FO C in ptim
ise d
9
of S
o 8 85% 60%
80% 7
u c tion po we r 5
6
80%
Re d ise d 3
4
optim 4
50% 3
2
1
0 50%
Nominal propeller curve

40%
75% 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105%
Speed, % of L1

178 60 27-3.0

Fig. 2.09.02

SFOC for K98MC/MC-C7 with constant speed

Power, % of L1

=0.15 lines
ship speed
=0.20 Constant 100%
=0.25 =0.30

90%

Diagram c 80%
in L1
ina l er
nom p ow mep
to the ptim
ise d
6 10 0% 70%
t i ve % o 5
10 0
r ela 2
3
4 95%
/ kWh p ow
er 1
in g ise d
0 9 0%

SF OC o ptim 9 85% 60%


n of
8
80% 7
6
u c tio owe
r
5 80%
Re d
p 4
ise d 3
optim 3
50%
1 2
0
+1 50%
Nominal propeller curve

40%
75% 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105%
Speed, % of L1
178 60 28-5.0

Fig. 2.09.03

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 55-8.0
MAN B&W 2.09
Page 3 of 6

SFOC Calculations for S90MC-C8, K90MC-C6, S80MC-C8, K80MC-C6, S70MC-C8,


S60MC-C8, L60MC-C8 and S50MC-C8

Data at nominel MCR (L1) SFOC at nominal MCR (L1)


High efficiency TC
Engine kW r/min g/kWh
6-9S90MC-C8 5,270 78 173
6-12K90MC-C6 4,570 104 177
6-8S80MC-C8 4,180 78 173
6-12K80MC-C6 3,610 104 177
5-8S70MC-C8 3,270 91 174
5-8S60MC-C8 2,380 105 174
5-9L60MC-C8 2,340 123 175
5-9S50MC-C8 1,660 127 175

Data matching point (O=M): Diagram a


SFOC
cyl. No. g/kWh Part Load SFOC curve
+4
Power: 100% of (O) kW
+3
Speed: 100% of (O) r/min
+2
SFOC found: g/kWh
+1

0 Nominal SFOC

10

11

12

13

14

15

16
40% 50% 60% 70% 80% 90% 100% 110%

% of optimising point

178 60 92-9.0

Fig. 2.09.01

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 55-8.0
MAN B&W 2.09
Page 4 of 6

SFOC for S90MC-C8, K90MC-C6, S80MC-C8, K80MC-C6, S70MC-C8, S60MC-C8,


L60MC-C8 and S50MC-C8 with fixed pitch propeller
Power, % of L1

=0.15 lines
ship speed
=0.20 Constant 100%
=0.25 =0.30

90%

Diagram b 80%
in L1
ina l er
nom p ow mep
to the ptim
ise d
6 10 0% 70%
t i ve 5
% o
10 0
h r ela 3
4 95%
g / kW
er 1 2
p ow 0 9 0%
FO C in ptim
ise d
9
of S
o 8 85% 60%
80% 7
u c tion po we r 5
6
80%
Re d ise d 3
4
optim 4
50% 3
2
1
0 50%
Nominal propeller curve

40%
75% 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105%
Speed, % of L1

178 60 22-4.0

Fig. 2.09.02

SFOC for S90MC-C8, K90MC-C6, S80MC-C8, K80MC-C6, S70MC-C8, S60MC-C8,


L60MC-C8 and S50MC-C8 with constant speed
Power, % of L1

=0.15 lines
ship speed
=0.20 Constant 100%
=0.25 =0.30

90%

Diagram c 80%
in L1
ina l er
nom p ow mep
to the ptim
ise d
6 10 0% 70%
t i ve % o 5
10 0
r ela 2
3
4 95%
/ kWh p ow
er 1
in g ise d
0 9 0%

SF OC o ptim 9 85% 60%


n of
8
80% 7
6
u c tio owe
r
5 80%
Re d
p 4
ise d 3
optim 3
50%
1 2
0
+1 50%
Nominal propeller curve

40%
75% 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105%
Speed, % of L1
178 60 23-6.0

Fig. 2.09.03

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 55-8.0
MAN B&W 2.09
Page 5 of 6

SFOC Calculations for L70MC-C8

Data at nominel MCR (L1) SFOC at nominal MCR (L1)


High efficiency TC
Engine kW r/min g/kWh
5-8L70MC-C8 3,270 108 175

Data matching point (O=M): Diagram a


SFOC
cyl. No. g/kWh Part Load SFOC curve
+4
Power: 100% of (O) kW
+3
Speed: 100% of (O) r/min
+2
SFOC found: g/kWh
+1

0 Nominal SFOC

10

11

12

13

14

15

16
40% 50% 60% 70% 80% 90% 100% 110%

% of optimising point

178 60 92-9.0

Fig. 2.09.01

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 55-8.0
MAN B&W 2.09
Page 6 of 6

SFOC for L70MC-C8 with fixed pitch propeller

Power, % of L1

=0.15 lines
ship speed
=0.20 Constant 100%
=0.25 =0.30

90%

Diagram b 80%
in L1
ina l er
nom p ow mep
to the ptim
ise d
6 10 0% 70%
t i ve 5
% o
10 0
h r ela 3
4 95%
g / kW
er 1 2
p ow 0 9 0%
FO C in ptim
ise d
9
of S
o 8 85% 60%
80% 7
u c tion po we r 5
6
80%
Re d ise d 3
4
optim 4
50% 3
2
1
0 50%
Nominal propeller curve

40%
75% 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105%
Speed, % of L1

178 60 20-0.0

Fig. 2.09.02

SFOC for L70MC-C8 with constant speed

Power, % of L1

=0.15 lines
ship speed
=0.20 Constant 100%
=0.25 =0.30

90%

Diagram c 80%
in L1
ina l er
nom p ow mep
to the ptim
ise d
6 10 0% 70%
t i ve % o 5
10 0
r ela 2
3
4 95%
/ kWh p ow
er 1
in g ise d
0 9 0%

SF OC o ptim 9 85% 60%


n of
8
80% 7
6
u c tio owe
r
5 80%
Re d
p 4
ise d 3
optim 3
50%
1 2
0
+1 50%
Nominal propeller curve

40%
75% 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105%
Speed, % of L1
178 60 21-2.0

Fig. 2.09.03

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 55-8.0
MAN B&W 2.10
Page  of 2

SFOC calculations, example

Data at nominel MCR (L1): 12K90MC-C6


Power 100% 54,840 kW
Speed 100% 104 r/min
Nominal SFOC:
High efficiency turbocharger 177 g/kWh

Example of specified MCR = M


Power 46,614 kW (85% L1)
Speed 93.6 r/min (90% L1)
Turbocharger type High efficiency
SFOC found in O = M 175.3 g/kWh

The optimising point O used in the above example for


the SFOC calculations:

O = 100% M = 85% L1 power and 90% L1 speed

MAN B&W K90MC-C6-TII


MAN Diesel 198 69 79-3.0
MAN B&W 2.10
Page  of 2

0OWER OF,

 LINES
HIPSPEED
 #ONSTANTS 
 



Diagram b 
IN, 
INA L ER
NOM POW
THE
MEP
ISE D 
TO PTIM   
T I VE  
 O 
7H RELA ER 

 

G  K 
POW   
&/ #IN PTIM
ISE D


OF3
O  
 
U C TION WE R 


PO
2E D IM ISE D 

OPT 
 
 
 
.OMINALPROPELLERCURVE


      
 3PEED OF,

178 60 66-7.0

The reductions, see diagram b, in g/kWh compared to $IAGRAMA


3&/# 3&/#
SFOC in L1: GK7H 0ART,OAD3&/#CURVE GK7H


SFOC SFOC
Power in Part load points g/kWh g/kWh 

100% O 1 100% M -1.7 175.3
 
80% O 2 80% M -4.7 172.3

50% O 3 50% M -1.1 175.9 

 .OMINAL3&/# 


 






 







        
OFSPECIFIED-#2

178 60 80-9.0

Fig. 2.10.01: Example of SFOC for derated 12K90MC-C6 with fixed pitch propeller and high efficiency turbocharger

MAN B&W K90MC-C6-TII


MAN Diesel 198 69 79-3.0
MAN B&W 2.11
Page  of 1

Fuel Consumption at an Arbitrary Load

Once the optimising point (O) of the engine has The SFOC curve through points S2, on the left
been chosen, the specific fuel oil consumption at of point 1, is symmetrical about point 1, i.e. at
an arbitrary point S1, S2 or S3 can be estimated speeds lower than that of point 1, the SFOC will
based on the SFOC at point 1 and 2. also increase.

These SFOC values can be calculated by using The abovementioned method provides only an
the graphs for the relevant engine type for the approximate value. A more precise indication of
propeller curve I and for the constant speed curve the expected SFOC at any load can be calculated
II, giving the SFOC at points 1 and 2, respectively. by using our computer program. This is a service
which is available to our customers on request.
Next the SFOC for point S1 can be calculated as
an interpolation between the SFOC in points 1
and 2, and for point S3 as an extrapolation.

0OWER OF!-



!-
 


 

3 3 3

 


) ))



   


3PEED OF!

198 95 962.2

Fig. 2.11.01: SFOC at an arbitrary load

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 66 31-7.0
MAN B&W 2.12
Page 1 of 1

Emission Control

IMO NOx Emission Limits 3050% NOx Reduction

All MC and MC-C engines are, as standard, deliv- Water emulsification of the heavy fuel oil is a well
ered in compliance with the IMO speed depend- proven primary method. The type of homogeni-
ent NOx limit, measured according to ISO 8178 zer is either ultrasonic or mechanical, using water
Test Cycles E2/E3 for Heavy Duty Diesel Engines. from the freshwater generator and the water mist
catcher.

NOx Reduction Methods The pressure of the homogenised fuel has to be


increased to prevent the formation of steam and
The NOx content in the exhaust gas can be re- cavitation. It may be necessary to modify some of
duced with primary and/or secondary reduction the engine components such as the fuel oil pres-
methods. sure booster, fuel injection valves and the engine
control system.
The primary methods affect the combustion pro-
cess directly by reducing the maximum combus-
tion temperature, whereas the secondary me- Up to 9598% NOx Reduction
thods are means of reducing the emission level
without changing the engine performance, using When operating at full load, this reduction can be
external equipment. achieved by means of secondary methods, such
as the SCR (Selective Catalytic Reduction), which
involves an aftertreatment of the exhaust gas, see
030% NOx Reduction Section 3.02. At lower load a 80-90% NOx reduc-
tion can be obtained, measured according to the
The MC and MC-C engines are as standard de- ISO 8178 E2/E3 Test Cycles.
livered to comply with IMO NOx emission limita-
tions, EoD: 4 06 060 Economy mode. Engine test Plants designed according to this method have
cycles E2 and E3 has to be ordered as an option: been in service since 1990 on five vessels, using
4 06 060a and 060b, and various conditions can Haldor Topse catalysts and ammonia as the re-
be specified, options: 4 06 060f, 060g and 060h. ducing agent, urea can also be used.
Compliance with other emission limits can be
specified as an option: 4 06 065. The SCR unit can be located separately in the
engine room or horizontally on top of the engine.
Regardless of the emission limit specified, the en- The compact SCR reactor is mounted before
gines are matched for best economy in service. the turbocharger(s) in order to have the optimum
working temperature for the catalyst. However at-
For further information on engine operation op- tention have to be given to the type of HFO to be
tions, see Extent of Delivery. used.

For further information about emission control,


please refer to our publication:

Exhaust Gas Emission Control Today and Tomorrow

The publication is available at


www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
Technical Papers.

MAN B&W MC/MCC engines


MAN Diesel 198 66 366.2
MAN B&W

Turbocharger Selection &


Exhaust Gas By-pass

3
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 3.01
Page 1 of 1

Turbocharger Selection

Updated turbocharger data based on the latest


information from the turbocharger makers are
available from the Turbocharger Selection pro-
gram on www.mandieselturbo.com under Prod-
ucts Marine Engines & Systems Low
Speed Turbocharger Selection.

The MAN B&W engines are designed for the ap-


plication of either MAN, ABB or Mitsubishi (MHI)
turbochargers.

The turbocharger choice is made with a view to


obtaining the lowest possible Specific Fuel Oil
Consumption (SFOC) values at the nominal MCR
by applying the best possible turbochargers.

The engines are, as standard, equipped with as


few turbochargers as possible, please refer to the
below mentioned Turbocharger Selection pro-
gramme.

In most cases one more turbocharger can be ap-


plied, than the number stated, if this is desirable
due to space requirements, or for other reasons.
Additional costs are to be expected.

However, we recommend the Turbocharger se-


lection programme on the Internet, which can be
used to identify a list of applicable turbochargers
for a specific engine layout.

For information about turbocharger arrangement


and cleaning systems, see Section 15.01.

Conventional High efficiency


Engines turbocharger turbocharger
Bore 50 Standard design
Bore 46 Standard design

Table 3.01.01: Turbocharger optional designs, MAN


B&W engines

MAN B&W MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 76 18-1.1
MAN B&W 3.02
Page  of 1

Exhaust Gas By-pass

This section is not applicable

MAN Diesel 198 58 95-9.0


MAN B&W 3.03
Page 1 of 2

NOx Reduction by SCR

The NOx in the exhaust gas can be reduced with


primary or secondary reduction methods. Primary
methods affect the engine combustion process
directly, whereas secondary methods reduce the
emission level without changing the engine per-
formance using equipment that does not form
part of the engine itself.

For further information about emission control we


refer to our publication:

Exhaust Gas Emission Control Today and Tomorrow

The publication is available at www.mandiesel-


turbo.com under Products Marine Engines &
Systems Low Speed Technical Papers.

Engine with Selective Catalytic Reduction System


Option: 4 60 135

If a reduction between 50 and 98% of NOx is re-


quired, the Selective Catalytic Reduction (SCR)
system has to be applied by adding ammonia or
urea to the exhaust gas before it enters a catalytic
converter.

The exhaust gas must be mixed with ammonia be-


fore passing through the catalyst, and in order to
encourage the chemical reaction the temperature
level has to be between 300 and 400 C. During
this process the NOx is reduced to N2 and water.

This means that the SCR unit has to be located


before the turbocharger on twostroke engines
because of their high thermal efficiency and there-
by a relatively low exhaust gas temperature.

The amount of ammonia injected into the ex-


haust gas is controlled by a process computer
and is based on the NOx production at different
loads measured during the testbed running. Fig.
3.03.01.

As the ammonia is a combustible gas, it is sup-


plied through a doublewalled pipe system, with
appropriate venting and fitted with an ammonia
leak detector (Fig. 3.03.01) which shows a simpli-
fied system layout of the SCR installation.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B Engines


MAN Diesel 198 58 94-7.2
MAN B&W 3.03
Page 2 of 2

Air

Process
computer

Evaporator Ammonia
tank

SCR reactor

Air intake
Air outlet
Exhaust gas outlet

Deck

Support

Static mixer

NOx and O2 analysers

Air

Orifice
High efficiency turbocharger

Preheating and sealing oil

Engine

198 99 271.0

Fig. 3.03.01: Layout of SCR system

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B Engines


MAN Diesel 198 58 94-7.2
MAN B&W

Electricity Production

4
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 4.01
Page 1 of 6

Electricity Production

Introduction

Next to power for propulsion, electricity produc- PTO/GCR (Engines <70)


tion is the largest fuel consumer on board. The (Power Take Off/Gear Constant Ratio):
electricity is produced by using one or more of the Generator coupled to a constant ratio stepup
following types of machinery, either running alone gear, used only for engines running at constant
or in parallel: speed.

Auxiliary diesel generating sets The DMG/CFE (Direct Mounted Generator/Con-


Main engine driven generators stant Frequency Electrical) and the SMG/CFE
Exhaust gas- or steam driven turbo generator (Shaft Mounted Generator/Constant Frequency
utilising exhaust gas waste heat (Thermo Effi- Electrical) are special designs within the PTO/CFE
ciency System) group in which the generator is coupled directly to
Emergency diesel generating sets. the main engine crankshaft and the intermediate
shaft, respectively, without a gear. The electrical
The machinery installed should be selected on the output of the generator is controlled by electrical
basis of an economic evaluation of first cost, ope- frequency control.
rating costs, and the demand for manhours for
maintenance. Within each PTO system, several designs are
available, depending on the positioning of the
In the following, technical information is given re- gear:
garding main engine driven generators (PTO) and
the auxiliary diesel generating sets produced by BW I: (Engines >46)
MAN Diesel. Gear with a vertical generator mounted onto the
fore end of the diesel engine, without any con-
The possibility of using a turbogenerator driven by nections to the ship structure.
the steam produced by an exhaust gas boiler can
be evaluated based on the exhaust gas data. BW II:
A freestanding gear mounted on the tank top
and connected to the fore end of the diesel en-
Power Take Off (PTO) gine, with a vertical or horizontal generator.

With a generator coupled to a Power Take Off BW III: (Engines >46)


(PTO) from the main engine, electrical power A crankshaft gear mounted onto the fore end
can be produced based on the main engines of the diesel engine, with a sidemounted
low SFOC and the use of heavy fuel oil. Several generator without any connections to the ship
standardised PTO systems are available, see Fig. structure.
4.01.01 and the designations in Fig. 4.01.02:
BW IV:
PTO/RCF A freestanding stepup gear connected to the
(Power Take Off/Renk Constant Frequency): intermediate shaft, with a horizontal generator.
Generator giving constant frequency, based on
mechanicalhydraulical speed control. The most popular of the gear based alternatives
are the BW III/RCF types for plants with a fixed
PTO/CFE pitch propeller (FPP) and the BW IV/GCR for
(Power Take Off/Constant Frequency Electrical): plants with a controllable pitch propeller (CPP).
Generator giving constant frequency, based on The BW III/RCF requires no separate seating in
electrical frequency control. the ship and only little attention from the shipyard
with respect to alignment.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 11-6.1
MAN B&W 4.01
Page 2 of 6

Total
Alternative types and layouts of shaft generators Design Seating efficiency (%)

1a 1b BW I/RCF On engine 8891


(vertical generator)

2a 2b BW II/RCF On tank top 8891


PTO/RCF

3a 3b BW III/RCF On engine 8891

4a 4b BW IV/RCF On tank top 8891

5a 5b DMG/CFE On engine 8488


PTO/CFE

6a 6b SMG/CFE On tank top 8488

7 BW I/GCR On engine 92
(vertical generator)

8 BW II/GCR On tank top 92


PTO/GCR

9 BW III/GCR On engine 92

10 BW IV/GCR On tank top 92

178 19 663.1

Fig. 4.01.01: Types of PTO

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 11-6.1
MAN B&W 4.01
Page 3 of 6

Designation of PTO

For further information, please refer to our publi-


cation titled:

Shaft Generators for MC and ME engines

The publication is available at www.mandiesel-


turbo.com under Products Marine Engines &
Systems Low Speed Technical Papers.

178 06 490.0

Power take off:

BW III S90MCC7/RCF 70060

50: 50 Hz
60: 60 Hz

kW on generator terminals

RCF: Renk constant frequency unit


CFE: Electrically frequency controlled unit

Mark version

Engine type on which it is applied

Layout of PTO: See Fig. 4.01.01

Make: MAN Diesel

178 39 556.0

Fig. 4.01.02: Example of designation of PTO

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C6/7, S90MC-C7/8, K90MC-C6, S80MC6,


S80MC-C7/8, K80MC-C6 MAN Diesel 198 66 33-0.1
MAN B&W 4.01
Page 3 of 6

Designation of PTO
For further information, please refer to our publi-
cation titled:

Shaft Generators for MC and ME engines

The publications are available at www.mandiesel-


turbo.com under Products Marine Engines &
Systems Low Speed Technical Papers.

178 06 490.0

Power take off:


BW III S60MCC7/RCF 70060

50: 50 Hz
60: 60 Hz

kW on generator terminals

RCF: Renk constant frequency unit


CFE: Electrically frequency controlled unit
GCR: Stepup gear with constant ratio

Mark version

Engine type on which it is applied

Layout of PTO: See Fig. 4.01.01

Make: MAN Diesel

178 39 556.0

Fig. 4.01.02: Example of designation of PTO

MAN B&W L/S70MCC7/8, S60MC-C7/8,


L60MC-C7/8, S50MC-C7/8, S50MC6 MAN Diesel 198 66 34-2.1
MAN B&W 4.01
Page 4 of 6

PTO/RCF

Side mounted generator, BWIII/RCF is bolted directly to the frame box of the main
(Fig. 4.01.01, Alternative 3) engine. The bearings of the three gear wheels
are mounted in the gear box so that the weight of
The PTO/RCF generator systems have been de- the wheels is not carried by the crankshaft. In the
veloped in close cooperation with the German frame box, between the crankcase and the gear
gear manufacturer RENK. A complete package drive, space is available for tuning wheel, counter-
solution is offered, comprising a flexible coupling, weights, axial vibration damper, etc.
a stepup gear, an epicyclic, variableratio gear
with builtin clutch, hydraulic pump and motor, The first gear wheel is connected to the crank-
and a standard generator, see Fig. 4.01.03. shaft via a special flexible coupling made in one
piece with a tooth coupling driving the crankshaft
For marine engines with controllable pitch pro- gear, thus isolating it against torsional and axial
pellers running at constant engine speed, the vibrations.
hydraulic system can be dispensed with, i.e. a
PTO/GCR design is normally used. By means of a simple arrangement, the shaft in
the crankshaft gear carrying the first gear wheel
Fig. 4.01.03 shows the principles of the PTO/RCF and the female part of the toothed coupling can
arrangement. As can be seen, a stepup gear box be moved forward, thus disconnecting the two
(called crankshaft gear) with three gear wheels parts of the toothed coupling.
Operating panel
in switchboard
Servo valve

Hydrostatic motor

Toothed
coupling Generator

RCFController

Hydrostatic pump
Annulus ring

Multidisc clutch Sun wheel

Planetary gear wheel

Toothed coupling

Crankshaft

Elastic damping coupling

Crankshaft gear
Toothed coupling

178 23 222.1

Fig. 4.01.03: Power take off with RENK constant frequency gear: BW III/RCF, option: 4 85 253

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 000.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.01
Page 5 of 6

The power from the crankshaft gear is trans- Extent of delivery for BWIII/RCF units
ferred, via a multidisc clutch, to an epicyclic
variableratio gear and the generator. These are The delivery comprises a complete unit ready to
mounted on a common bedplate, bolted to brack- be builton to the main engine. Fig. 4.02.01 shows
ets integrated with the engine bedplate. the required space and the standard electrical
output range on the generator terminals.
The BWIII/RCF unit is an epicyclic gear with a
hydrostatic superposition drive. The hydrostatic Standard sizes of the crankshaft gears and the
input drives the annulus of the epicyclic gear in RCF units are designed for:
either direction of rotation, hence continuously 700, 1200, 1800 and 2600 kW, while the generator
varying the gearing ratio to keep the genera- sizes of make A. van Kaick are:
tor speed constant throughout an engine speed
variation of 30%. In the standard layout, this is 440 V 60 Hz 380 V 50 Hz
between 100% and 70% of the engine speed at Type
1800 r/min 1500 r/min
DSG
specified MCR, but it can be placed in a lower kVA kW kVA kW
range if required. 62 M24 707 566 627 501
62 L14 855 684 761 609
The input power to the gear is divided into two
62 L24 1,056 845 940 752
paths one mechanical and the other hydrostatic
74 M14 1,271 1,017 1,137 909
and the epicyclic differential combines the
power of the two paths and transmits the com- 74 M24 1,432 1,146 1,280 1,024
bined power to the output shaft, connected to the 74 L14 1,651 1,321 1,468 1,174
generator. The gear is equipped with a hydrostatic 74 L24 1,924 1,539 1,709 1,368
motor driven by a pump, and controlled by an 86 K14 1,942 1,554 1,844 1,475
electronic control unit. This keeps the generator 86 M14 2,345 1,876 2,148 1,718
speed constant during single running as well as 86 L24 2,792 2,234 2,542 2,033
when running in parallel with other generators. 99 K14 3,222 2,578 2,989 2,391
178 34 893.1
The multidisc clutch, integrated into the gear in-
put shaft, permits the engaging and disengaging In the event that a larger generator is required,
of the epicyclic gear, and thus the generator, from please contact MAN Diesel.
the main engine during operation.
If a main engine speed other than the nominal is
An electronic control system with a RENK control- required as a basis for the PTO operation, it must
ler ensures that the control signals to the main be taken into consideration when determining the
electrical switchboard are identical to those for ratio of the crankshaft gear. However, it has no
the normal auxiliary generator sets. This applies influence on the space required for the gears and
to ships with automatic synchronising and load the generator.
sharing, as well as to ships with manual switch-
board operation. The PTO can be operated as a motor (PTI) as well
as a generator by making some minor modifica-
Internal control circuits and interlocking functions tions.
between the epicyclic gear and the electronic
control box provide automatic control of the func-
tions necessary for the reliable operation and
protection of the BWIII/RCF unit. If any monitored
value exceeds the normal operation limits, a warn-
ing or an alarm is given depending upon the ori-
gin, severity and the extent of deviation from the
permissible values. The cause of a warning or an
alarm is shown on a digital display.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 000.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.01
Page 6 of 6

Yard deliveries are: Additional capacities required for BWIII/RCF

1. Cooling water pipes to the builton lubricating The capacities stated in the List of capacities for
oil cooling system, including the valves. the main engine in question are to be increased
by the additional capacities for the crankshaft
2. Electrical power supply to the lubricating oil gear and the RCF gear stated in Fig. 4.03.02.
standby pump built on to the RCF unit.

3. Wiring between the generator and the operator


control panel in the switchboard.

4. An external permanent lubricating oil fillingup


connection can be established in connection
with the RCF unit. The system is shown in Fig.
4.03.03 Lubricating oil system for RCF gear.
The dosage tank and the pertaining piping
are to be delivered by the yard. The size of the
dosage tank is stated in the table for RCF gear
in Necessary capacities for PTO/RCF (Fig.
4.03.02).

The necessary preparations to be made on


the engine are specified in Figs. 4.03.01a and
4.03.01b.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 000.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 3,115 3,115 3,255 3,255
B 623 623 623 623
C 3,775 3,775 4,055 4,055
D 4,175 4,175 4,455 4,455
F 1,673 1,793 1,913 2,023
G 2,320 2,320 2,700 2,700
H 2,170 2,680 3,070 4,380
S 400 460 550 640
System mass (kg) with generator:
27,000 31,500 44,600 61,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
25,000 28,850 40,300 56,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll K98C/RCF

MAN B&W K98MC/ME6/7


MAN Diesel 198 43 03-6.1
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 3,115 3,115 3,255 3,255
B 623 623 623 623
C 3,775 3,775 4,055 4,055
D 4,175 4,175 4,455 4,455
F 1,673 1,793 1,913 2,023
G 2,320 2,320 2,700 2,700
H 2,170 2,680 3,070 4,380
S 400 460 550 640
System mass (kg) with generator:
27,000 31,500 44,600 61,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
25,000 28,850 40,300 56,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll K98C/RCF

MAN B&W K98MC-C/ME-C6/7


MAN Diesel 198 43 24-0.1
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 3,342 3,342 3,482 3,482
B 623 623 623 623
C 4,002 4,002 4,282 4,282
D 4,294 4,294 4,574 4,574
F 1,673 1,793 1,913 2,023
G 3,029 3,029 3,389 3,389
H 1,449 1,951 2,326 3,656
S 430 530 620 710
System mass (kg) with generator:
36,250 41,500 55,100 71,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
34,250 38,850 50,800 66,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll S90C/RCF

MAN B&W S90MC-C/ME-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 43 04-8.1
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 3,568 3,568 3,708 3,708
B 623 623 623 623
C 4,228 4,228 4,508 4,508
D 4,620 4,620 4,900 4,900
F 1,673 1,793 1,913 2,023
G 3,025 3,025 3,385 3,385
H 1,453 1,955 2,330 3,660
S 430 530 620 710
System mass (kg) with generator:
36,250 41,500 55,100 71,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
34,250 38,850 50,800 66,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll K90C/RCF

MAN B&W K90MC-C/ME-C6


MAN Diesel 198 43 25-2.1
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 3,396 3,396 3,536 3,536
B 747 747 747 747
C 4,056 4,056 4,336 4,336
D 4,450 4,450 4,730 4,730
F 1,797 1,917 2,037 2,147
G 2,890 2,890 3,290 3,290
H 1,603 2,110 2,445 3,770
S 390 480 520 660
System mass (kg) with generator:
31,750 36,500 49,600 66,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
29,750 33,850 45,300 61,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll S80C/RCF

MAN B&W S80MC-C/ME-C7/8, S80MC6


MAN Diesel 198 43 08-5.1
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 3,255 3,255 3,395 3,395
B 747 747 747 747
C 3,915 3,915 4,195 4,195
D 4,310 4,310 4,590 4,590
F 1,797 1,917 2,037 2,147
G 2,778 2,778 3,178 3,178
H 1,700 2,202 2,537 3,867
S 390 480 520 660
System mass (kg) with generator:
30,750 35,500 48,100 64,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
28,750 32,850 43,800 59,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll K80C/RCF

MAN B&W K80MC-C/ME-C6


MAN Diesel 198 43 09-7.1
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 3,073 3,073 3,213 3,213
B 633 633 633 633
C 3,733 3,733 4,013 4,013
D 4,130 4,130 4,410 4,410
F 1,683 1,803 1,923 2,033
G 2,620 2,620 3,000 3,000
H 1,925 2,427 2,812 4,142
S 400 460 550 640
System mass (kg) with generator:
26,250 30,500 42,600 58,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
24,250 27,850 38,300 53,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll S70C/RCF

MAN B&W S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI7/8


MAN Diesel 198 43 10-7.2
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 2,881 2,881 3,021 3,021
B 633 633 633 633
C 3,541 3,541 3,821 3,821
D 3,940 3,940 4,220 4,220
F 1,683 1,803 1,923 2,033
G 2,685 2,685 3,065 3,065
H 1,803 2,305 2,690 4,020
S 400 460 550 640
System mass (kg) with generator:
25,250 29,500 41,100 56,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
23,250 26,850 36,800 51,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll L70C/RCF

MAN B&W L70MC-C/ME-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 43 11-9.1
MAN B&W 4.02
Page 1 of 1

D H G S
A
F
B

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 2,684 2,684 2,824 2,824
B 632 632 632 632
C 3,344 3,344 3,624 3,624
D 3,740 3,740 4,020 4,020
F 1,682 1,802 1,922 2,032
G 2,364 2,364 2,724 2,724
H 2,134 2,636 3,021 4,341
S 390 450 530 620
System mass (kg) with generator:
23,750 27,500 39,100 52,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
21,750 24,850 34,800 47,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll S60C/RCF

MAN B&W S60MC-C, S60ME-C/ME-GI, S60ME-B


MAN Diesel 198 43 21-5.2
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

$ ( ' 3
!
&
"

178 36 29-6.1

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 2,647 2,647 2,787 2,787
B 632 632 632 632
C 3,307 3,307 3,587 3,587
D 3,699 3,699 3,979 3,979
F 1,682 1,802 1,922 2,032
G 2,391 2,391 2,751 2,751
H 2,067 2,569 2,954 4,284
S 390 480 570 620
System mass (kg) with generator:
22,750 26,500 38,100 51,050
System mass (kg) without generator:
20,750 23,850 33,800 45,850

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll L60C/RCF

MAN B&W L60MC-C/ME-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 43 13-2.1
MAN B&W 4.02
Page  of 1

&/2%

( ' 3
&
"

!
#
$ 178 05 117.0

kW generator
700 kW 1200 kW 1800 kW 2600 kW
A 2,455 2,455 2,595 2,595
B 776 776 776 776
C 3,115 3,115 3,395 3,395
D 3,510 3,510 3,790 3,790
F 1,826 1,946 2,066 2,176
G 2,214 2,214 2,514 2,514
H 2,289 2,791 3,196 4,526
S 380 470 500 590
System mass (kg) with generator:
22,750 26,500 37,100 48,550
System mass (kg) without generator:
20,750 23,850 32,800 43,350

The stated kW at the generator terminals is available between 70% and 100% of the engine speed at specified MCR

Space requirements have to be investigated case by case on plants with 2600 kW generator.

Dimension H: This is only valid for A. van Kaick generator type DSG, enclosure IP23,
frequency = 60 Hz, speed = 1800 r/min

Fig. 4.02.01: Space requirement for side mounted generator PTO/RCF type BWlll S50C/RCF

MAN B&W S50MC-C/ME-C7/8, S50ME-B8


MAN Diesel 198 43 14-4.1
MAN B&W 4.03
Page 1 of 6

Engine preparations for PTO

3 4 5

2
9
2
15

19

8
13
2

14 18

11
12 10 21 6
17 20

Toothed coupling

Alternator
22

Bedframe

RCFgear
(if ordered)
16

Crankshaft gear
Fig. 4.03.01a: Engine preparations for PTO 178 57 15-7.0

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 156.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.03
Page 2 of 6

Pos.
1 Special face on bedplate and frame box
2 Ribs and brackets for supporting the face and machined blocks for alignment of gear or stator housing
3 Machined washers placed on frame box part of face to ensure that it is flush with the face on the bedplate
4 Rubber gasket placed on frame box part of face
5 Shim placed on frame box part of face to ensure that it is flush with the face of the bedplate
6 Distance tubes and long bolts
7 Threaded hole size, number and size of spring pins and bolts to be made in agreement with PTO maker
8 Flange of crankshaft, normally the standard execution can be used
9 Studs and nuts for crankshaft flange
10 Free flange end at lubricating oil inlet pipe (incl. blank flange)
11 Oil outlet flange welded to bedplate (incl. blank flange)
12 Face for brackets
13 Brackets
14 Studs for mounting the brackets
15 Studs, nuts and shims for mounting of RCF/generator unit on the brackets
16 Shims, studs and nuts for connection between crankshaft gear and RCF/generator unit
17 Engine cover with connecting bolts to bedplate/frame box to be used for shop test without PTO
18 Intermediate shaft between crankshaft and PTO
19 Oil sealing for intermediate shaft
20 Engine cover with hole for intermediate shaft and connecting bolts to bedplate/frame box
21 Plug box for electronic measuring instrument for checking condition of axial vibration damper
22 Tacho encoder for ME control system or Alpha lubrication system on MC engine
23 Tacho trigger ring for ME control system or Alpha lubrication system on MC engine

Pos. no: 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
BWIII/RCF A A A A B A B A A A A A B B A A A
BWIII/CFE A A A A B A B A A A A A B B A A A
BWII/RCF A A A A A A A
BWII/CFE A A A A A A A
BWI/RCF A A A A B A B A A A
BWI/CFE A A A A B A B A A A A A
DMG/CFE A A A B C A B A A A
A: Preparations to be carried out by engine builder
B: Parts supplied by PTOmaker
C: See text of pos. no.
178 89 342.0

Fig. 4.03.01b: Engine preparations for PTO

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 156.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.03
Page 3 of 6

Crankshaft gear lubricated from the main engine lubricating oil system
The figures are to be added to the main engine capacity list:
Nominal output of generator kW 700 1,200 1,800 2,600
Lubricating oil flow m /h
3
4.1 4.1 4.9 6.2
Heat dissipation kW 12.1 20.8 31.1 45.0

RCF gear with separate lubricating oil system:


Nominal output of generator kW 700 1,200 1,800 2,600
Cooling water quantity m3/h 14.1 22.1 30.0 39.0
Heat dissipation kW 55 92 134 180
El. power for oil pump kW 11.0 15.0 18.0 21.0
Dosage tank capacity m 3
0.40 0.51 0.69 0.95
El. power for Renkcontroller 24V DC 10%, 8 amp

From main engine: Cooling water inlet temperature: 36 C


Design lube oil pressure: 2.25 bar Pressure drop across cooler: approximately 0.5 bar
Lube oil pressure at crankshaft gear: min. 1 bar Fill pipe for lube oil system store tank (~32)
Lube oil working temperature: 50 C Drain pipe to lube oil system drain tank (~40)
Lube oil type: SAE 30 Electric cable between Renk terminal at gearbox
and operator control panel in switchboard: Cable
type FMGCG 19 x 2 x 0.5
178 33 850.0

Fig. 4.03.02: Necessary capacities for PTO/RCF, BW III/RCF system

Deck

Filling pipe
The dimensions
of dosage tank
depend on actual
type of gear Engine
oil

To main engine

Main
engine DR

DS
S S The letters refer to the List of flanges,
C/D C/D which will be extended by the engine builder,
when PTO systems are built on the main engine
From purifier
To purifier
Lube oil
bottom tank
178 25 235.0

Fig. 4.03.03: Lubricating oil system for RCF gear

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 156.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.03
Page 4 of 6

DMG/CFE Generators
Option: 4 85 259

Fig. 4.01.01 alternative 5, shows the DMG/CFE For generators in the normal output range, the
(Direct Mounted Generator/Constant Frequency mass of the rotor can normally be carried by the
Electrical) which is a low speed generator with foremost main bearing without exceeding the per-
its rotor mounted directly on the crankshaft and missible bearing load (see Fig. 4.03.05), but this
its stator bolted on to the frame box as shown in must be checked by the engine manufacturer in
Figs. 4.03.04 and 4.03.05. each case.

The DMG/CFE is separated from the crankcase If the permissible load on the foremost main bear-
by a plate and a labyrinth stuffing box. ing is exceeded, e.g. because a tuning wheel
is needed, this does not preclude the use of a
The DMG/CFE system has been developed in co- DMG/CFE.
operation with the German generator manufactur-
ers Siemens and AEG, but similar types of gene-
rator can be supplied by others, e.g. Fuji, Taiyo
and Nishishiba in Japan.

Static frequency converter system

Cubicles:

Distributor
Synchronous To switchboard
condenser Converter

Excitation

Control

Cooler

Oil seal cover


Support
bearing
Rotor

Stator housing

178 06 733.1

Fig. 4.03.04: Standard engine, with direct mounted generator (DMG/CFE)

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 156.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.03
Page 5 of 6
Stator shell Stator shell

Stuffing box Stuffing box

Crankshaft Crankshaft

Air cooler Air cooler

Support
bearing

Pole wheel

Main bearing No. 1 Main bearing No. 1

Pole wheel
Tuning wheel

Standard engine, with direct Standard engine, with direct mounted


mounted generator (DMG/CFE) generator and tuning wheel

178 06 637.1

Fig. 4.03.05: Standard engine, with direct mounted generator and tuning wheel

Mains, constant frequency

Synchronous
condenser
Excitation converter

DMG
Smoothing reactor
Diesel engine Static converter

178 56 553.1

Fig. 4.03.06: Diagram of DMG/CFE with static converter

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 156.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.03
Page 6 of 6

In such a case, the problem is solved by installing Yard deliveries are:


a small, elastically supported bearing in front of
the stator housing, as shown in Fig. 4.03.05. 1. Installation, i.e. seating in the ship for the syn-
chronous condenser unit and for the static
As the DMG type is directly connected to the converter cubicles
crankshaft, it has a very low rotational speed and,
consequently, the electric output current has a 2. Cooling water pipes to the generator if water
low frequency normally of the order of 15 Hz. cooling is applied

Therefore, it is necessary to use a static fre- 3. Cabling.


quency converter between the DMG and the main
switchboard. The DMG/CFE is, as standard, laid The necessary preparations to be made on
out for operation with full output between 100% the engine are specified in Figs. 4.03.01a and
and 70% and with reduced output between 70% 4.03.01b.
and 50% of the engine speed at specified MCR.

SMG/CFE Generators
Static converter
The PTO SMG/CFE (see Fig. 4.01.01 alternative 6)
The static frequency converter system (see Fig. has the same working principle as the PTO DMG/
4.03.06) consists of a static part, i.e. thyristors and CFE, but instead of being located on the front end
control equipment, and a rotary electric machine. of the engine, the alternator is installed aft of the
engine, with the rotor integrated on the intermedi-
The DMG produces a threephase alternating ate shaft.
current with a low frequency, which varies in ac-
cordance with the main engine speed. This alter- In addition to the yard deliveries mentioned for the
nating current is rectified and led to a thyristor in- PTO DMG/CFE, the shipyard must also provide
verter producing a threephase alternating current the foundation for the stator housing in the case
with constant frequency. of the PTO SMG/CFE.

Since the frequency converter system uses a DC The engine needs no preparation for the installa-
intermediate link, no reactive power can be sup- tion of this PTO system.
plied to the electric mains. To supply this reactive
power, a synchronous condenser is used. The
synchronous condenser consists of an ordinary
synchronous generator coupled to the electric
mains.

Extent of delivery for DMG/CFE units

The delivery extent is a generator fully builton


to the main engine including the synchronous
condenser unit and the static converter cubicles
which are to be installed in the engine room.

The DMG/CFE can, with a small modification,


be operated both as a generator and as a motor
(PTI).

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MCC/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MCC/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 43 156.2

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B
MAN B&W 4.04
Page 1 of 3

PTO type: BW II/GCR PTO type: BW IV/GCR

Power Take Off/Gear Constant Ratio Power Take Off/Gear Constant Ratio

The PTO system type BWII/GCR illustrated in Fig. The shaft generator system, type PTO BW IV/
4.01.01 alternative 5 can generate electrical power GCR, installed in the shaft line (Fig. 4.01.01 al-
on board ships equipped with a controllable pitch ternative 6) can generate power on board ships
propeller, running at constant speed. equipped with a controllable pitch propeller run-
ning at constant speed.
The PTO unit is mounted on the tank top at the
fore end of the engine see Fig. 4.04.01. The PTO The PTO system can be delivered as a tunnel gear
generator is activated at sea, taking over the elec- with hollow flexible coupling or, alternatively, as
trical power production on board when the main a generator stepup gear with thrust bearing and
engine speed has stabilised at a level correspond- flexible coupling integrated in the shaft line.
ing to the generator frequency required on board.
The main engine needs no special preparation for
The installation length in front of the engine, and mounting these types of PTO systems as they are
thus the engine room length requirement, natu- connected to the intermediate shaft.
rally exceeds the length of the engine aft end
mounted shaft generator arrangements. However, The PTO system installed in the shaft line can also
there is some scope for limiting the space require- be installed on ships equipped with a fixed pitch
ment, depending on the configuration chosen. propeller or controllable pitch propeller running in

Step-up gear

Generator

Elastic coupling

Support bearing, if required

178 18 225.0

Fig. 4.04.01: Generic outline of Power Take Off (PTO) BW II/GCR

MAN B&W S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 43 168.6

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S/L35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, S26MC


MAN B&W 4.04
Page 2 of 3

combinator mode. This will, however, require an Generator stepup gear and flexible coupling
additional RENK Constant Frequency gear (Fig. integrated in the shaft line
4.01.01 alternative 2) or additional electrical equip-
ment for maintaining the constant frequency of For higher power take off loads, a generator
the generated electric power. stepup gear and flexible coupling integrated in
the shaft line may be chosen due to first costs of
gear and coupling.
Tunnel gear with hollow flexible coupling
The flexible coupling integrated in the shaft line
This PTO system is normally installed on ships will transfer the total engine load for both propul-
with a minor electrical power take off load com- sion and electrical power and must be dimen-
pared to the propulsion power, up to approxi- sioned accordingly.
mately 25% of the engine power.
The flexible coupling cannot transfer the thrust
The hollow flexible coupling is only to be dimensioned from the propeller and it is, therefore, necessary
for the maximum electrical load of the power take off to make the gearbox with an integrated thrust
system and this gives an economic advantage for minor bearing.
power take off loads compared to the system with an
ordinary flexible coupling integrated in the shaft line. This type of PTO system is typically installed on
ships with large electrical power consumption,
The hollow flexible coupling consists of flexible e.g. shuttle tankers.
segments and connecting pieces, which allow
replacement of the coupling segments without
dismounting the shaft line, see Fig. 4.04.02.

178 18 250.1

Fig. 4.04.02: Generic outline of BW IV/GCR, tunnel gear

MAN B&W S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 43 168.6

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S/L35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, S26MC


MAN B&W 4.04
Page 3 of 3

Auxiliary Propulsion System/Take Home System To obtain high propeller efficiency in the auxiliary
propulsion mode, and thus also to minimise the
From time to time an Auxiliary Propulsion System/ auxiliary power required, a twospeed tunnel gear,
Take Home System capable of driving the CP pro- which provides lower propeller speed in the auxil-
peller by using the shaft generator as an electric iary propulsion mode, is used.
motor is requested.
The twospeed tunnel gear box is made with a
MAN Diesel can offer a solution where the friction clutch which allows the propeller to be
CP propeller is driven by the alternator via a clutched in at full alternator/motor speed where
twospeed tunnel gear box. The electric power is the full torque is available. The alternator/motor is
produced by a number of GenSets. The main en- started in the declutched condition with a start
gine is disengaged by a clutch (RENK KAZ) made transformer.
as an integral part of the shafting. The clutch is in-
stalled between the tunnel gear box and the main The system can quickly establish auxiliary propul-
engine, and conical bolts are used to connect and sion from the engine control room and/or bridge,
disconnect the main engine and the shafting. even with unmanned engine room.
See Figure 4.04.03.
Reestablishment of normal operation requires
A thrust bearing, which transfers the auxiliary pro- attendance in the engine room and can be done
pulsion propeller thrust to the engine thrust bear- within a few minutes.
ing when the clutch is disengaged, is built into the
RENK KAZ clutch. When the clutch is engaged,
the thrust is transferred statically to the engine
thrust bearing through the thrust bearing built into
the clutch.

Main engine

Twospeed tunnel gearbox

Generator/motor

Renk KAZ clutch

Oil distribution ring

Hydraulic coupling

Intermediate bearing
Flexible coupling

178 57 16-9.0

Fig. 4.04.03: Auxiliary propulsion system

MAN B&W S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 43 168.6

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S/L35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, S26MC


MAN B&W 4.05
Page 1 of 12

Waste Heat Recovery Systems (WHR)

Due to the increasing fuel prices seen from 2004 The PTG system will produce power equivalent to
and onwards many shipowners have shown inter- approx. 4% of the main engine SMCR, when the
est in efficiency improvements of the power sys- engine is running at SMCR. For the STG system
tems on board their ships. A modern two-stroke this value is between 5 and 7% depending on
diesel engine has one of the highest thermal effi- the system installed. When combining the two
ciencies of todays power systems, but even this systems, a power output equivalent to 10% of the
high efficiency can be improved by combining the main engines SMCR is possible, when the engine
diesel engine with other power systems. is running at SMCR.

One of the possibilities for improving the efficien- As the electrical power produced by the system
cy is to install one or more systems utilising some needs to be used on board the ship, specifying
of the energy in the exhaust gas after the two- the correct size system for a specific project must
stroke engine, which in MAN Diesel terms is des- be considered carefully. In cases where the elec-
ignated as WHR (Waste Heat Recovery Systems). trical power consumption on board the ship is
low, a smaller system than possible for the engine
WHR can be divided into different types of sub- type may be considered. Another possibility is to
systems, depending on how the system utilises install a shaft generator/motor to absorb excess
the exhaust gas energy. Choosing the right sys- power produced by the WHR. The main engine
tem for a specific project depends on the electric- will then be unloaded, or it will be possible to in-
ity demand on board the ship and the acceptable crease the speed of the ship, without penalising
first cost for the complete installation. MAN Diesel the fuelbill.
uses the following designations for the current
systems on the market: Because the energy from WHR is taken from
the exhaust gas of the main engine, this power
PTG (Power Turbine Generator): produced can be considered as free. In reality,
An exhaust gas driven turbine connected to a the main engine SFOC will increase slightly, but
generator via a gearbox. the gain in electricity production on board the
ship will far surpass this increase in SFOC. As an
STG (Steam Turbine Generator): example, the SFOC of the combined output of
A steam driven turbine connected to a generator both the engine and the system with power and
via a gearbox. The steam is produced in a large steam turbine can be calculated to be as low as
exhaust gas driven boiler installed on the main 155 g/kWh (ref. LCV 42,700 kJ/kg).
engine exhaust gas piping system.

Combined Turbines:
A combination of the two first systems. The ar-
rangement is often that the power turbine is
connected to the steam turbine via a gearbox
and the steam turbine is further connected to a
large generator, which absorbs the power from
both turbines.

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 2 of 12

PTG

The power turbines of today are based on the facturer. In Fig. 4.05.01, a simple diagram of the
different turbocharger suppliers newest designs PTG arrangement is shown. The quick-opening
of high-efficient turbochargers, i.e. MAN Diesels and quick-closing valves are used in the event of
TCA, ABBs TPL and Mitsubishis MA turbocharg- a black out on the grid, in which case the exhaust
ers. The power turbine basically, is the turbine gas will bypass the power turbine.
side of a normal high-efficient turbocharger with
some modifications to the bearings and the tur- The newest generation of high-efficient turbo-
bine shaft, in order to be able to connect it to a chargers allows bypassing of some of the main
gearbox instead of the normal connection to the engine exhaust gas, thereby creating a new bal-
compressor side. The power turbine will be in- ance of the air flow through the engine. In this
stalled on a separate exhaust gas pipe from the way, it is possible to extract power from the power
exhaust gas receiver, which bypasses the turbo- turbine equivalent of 4% of the main engines
chargers. The performance of the PTG and the SMCR, when the engine is running at SMCR.
main engine will depend on a careful matching of
the engine turbochargers and the power turbine,
which means that the turbocharger/s and the
power turbine need to be from the same manu-

Pipe Main
switchboard
Electrical wiring To funnel
Gen.Set

Gen.Set

Quick
closing
valve

Power
turbine
Quick
opening
valve
Gearbox

Exhaust gas receiver


Butterfly Quick
valve closing
valve

Main engine

Shaft
generator/
motor

178 57 09-8.0

Fig. 4.05.01: PTG diagram

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 3 of 12

Maintenance space
A B

Reduction gear

Power turbine Generator

C
Width
D

PTG-system A B C D
size m m m m
1,000 4,0 - 4.5 2.5 - 3.0 2.5 2.0
1,500 4.5 - 5.0 2.0 - 2.5 2.5 2.0
2,000 5,0 - 5.5 2.5 - 3.0 2.5 2.0 - 2.5
3,000 5.5 - 7,0 3.0 - 4.0 3.0 - 3.5 2.2 - 3.5
4,500 6,0 - 7.5 3.0 - 4.0 3.5 - 4.0 2.3 - 3.5
178 56 95-2.0

Fig. 4.05.02: The size a 1,000 kW PTG system depending on the supplier

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 4 of 12

STG

In most cases the exhaust gas pipe system of The extra steam produced in the boiler can be
the main engine is equipped with a boiler system. utilised in a steam turbine, which can be used to
With this boiler, some of the energy in the exhaust drive a generator for power production on board
gas is utilised to produce steam for use on board the ship. An STG system could be arranged as
the ship. If the engine is WHR matched, the ex- shown in Fig. 4.05.04, where a typical system size
haust gas temperature will be between 50C and is shown with the outline dimensions. The steam
65C higher than on a conventional engine, which turbine can either be a single or dual pressure tur-
makes it possible to install a larger boiler sys- bine, depending on the size of the system. Steam
tem and, thereby, produce more steam. In short, pressures for a single pressure system is 7 to 10
MAN Diesel designates this system as STG. Fig. bara, and for the dual pressure system, the high-
4.05.03 shows an example of the arrangement of pressure cycle will be 9 to 10 bara and the low-
STG. For WHR matching the engine, a bypass is pressure cycle will be 4 to 5 bara.
installed to increase the temperature of the ex-
haust gas and improve the boiler output.

To funnel

Pipe
Electrical wiring
LP steam Main switchboard
Steam
Economiser Gen.Set

HP steam Gen.Set

Gen.Set

Steam
regulating
valve Steam
turbine
Butterfly
Valve Gearbox
Exhaust gas receiver

To economiser Cooling
Condenser Water
Main engine

Shaft
Generator/ Feedwater
Motor pump Hotwell

178 56 96-4.0

Fig. 4.05.03: Steam diagram

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 5 of 12

Maintenance space
A B

Steam turbine Reduction gear Generator

Overhaul height
C
Expansion joint Condenser

D
Condensate pump

Maintenance space
F E

Width
G

PTG-system A B C D E F G
size m m m m m m m
1,000 4.5 - 5.0 2.0 - 2.5 3.5 - 4.0 3.0 - 4.0 3.0 - 4.0 3.0 - 4.0 2.5 - 3.0
1,500 5.5 - 7.5 2.5 - 3.0 3.5 - 4.0 4.5 - 5.5 4.0 - 5.0 5.5 - 6.5 2.5 - 3.0
2,000 7.0 - 9.0 3.0 - 4.0 4.8 - 5.1 5.0 - 6.0 4.5 - 5.0 7.0 - 8.0 2.8 - 3.3
3,000 7.0 - 9.0 3.0 - 4.0 4.8 - 5.1 5.0 - 6.0 5.0 - 5.5 8.0 - 9.0 3.0 - 3.5
5,000 8.0 -10.0 3.5 - 4.5 4.8 - 5.1 5.5 - 6.5 5.0 - 6.5 9.0 -10.0 3.5 - 4.0
178 57 02-5.0

Fig. 4.05.04: Typical system for 1,000 kW STG system

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 6 of 12

Combined Turbines

Because the installation of the power turbine also most cases, connected to the steam turbine via a
will result in an increase the exhaust gas tempera- gearbox, and the steam turbine is then connected
ture after the turbochargers, it is possible to in- to the generator. It is also possible to have a gen-
stall both the power turbine, the larger boiler and erator with connections in both ends, and then
steam turbine on the same engine. This means connect the power turbine in the one end and the
that the energy from the exhaust gas is utilised in steam turbine in the other end. In both cases con-
the best way possible by todays components. trol of one generator only is needed.

When looking at the system with both power and For dimensions of a typical system see
steam turbine, it will often be the case that power Fig. 4.05.06.
turbine and steam turbine are connected to the
same generator. In some cases, it is also possible As mentioned, the systems with steam turbines
to have each turbine on a separate generator, require a larger boiler to be installed. The size
though mostly seen on stationary engines, where of the boiler system will be roughly three to four
the frequency control is simpler because of the times the size of an ordinary boiler system, but
large grid that the generator can lean against. the actual boiler size has to be calculated from
For marine installations the power turbine is, in case to case.

To funnel

Pipe Main switchboard

Electrical wiring Gen.Set


LP steam
Steam
Economiser
Gen.Set

HP steam

Steam
Quick closing valve regulating
valve

Power Steam
Quick turbine
Opening turbine
Gearbox
Valve
Gearbox
Exhaust gas receiver
Butterfly Quick
valve closing
valve
To economiser Condenser Cooling
water
Main engine

Shaft
generator/ Feedwater
motor pump Hotwell

178 57 03-7.0

Fig. 4.05.05: Combined turbines diagram

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 7 of 12

Maintenance space
A B

Reduction gear

Power turbine Steam turbine Reduction gear Generator

Overhaul height
C
Expansion joint Condenser

D
Condensate pump

Maintenance space
F E

Width:
G

PTG-system A B C D E F G
size m m m m m m m
1,500 7.5 - 8.0 2.0 - 2.5 3.5 - 4.0 3.0 - 4.0 3.0 - 4.0 3.0 - 4.0 2.5 - 3.0
3,000 8.5 - 10.5 3.0 - 4.0 3.5 - 4.0 4.5 - 5.5 4.0 - 5.0 5.5 - 6.5 2.5 - 3.0
4,000 10.0 - 12.0 3.0 - 4.0 4.8 - 5.1 5.0 - 6.0 4.5 - 5.5 6.0 - 7.0 2.8 - 3.3
7,000 10.0 - 12.0 3.5 - 4.5 4.8 - 5.1 5.0 - 6.0 5.0 - 5.5 8.0 - 9.0 3.0 - 3.5
8,500 11.0 - 13.0 3.5 - 4.5 4.8 - 5.1 5.5 - 6.5 5.5 - 6.5 9.0 -10.0 3.5 - 4.0

178 57 08-6.0

Fig. 4.05.06: Typical system

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 8 of 12

WHR output

Because all the components come from different Detailed information on the different systems
manufacturers, the final output and the system is found in our paper Thermo Efficiency Sys-
efficiency has to be calculated from case to case. tem, where the different systems are described
However, Fig. 4.05.07 shows a guidance of pos- in greater detail. The paper is available at:
sible outputs based on theoretically calculated www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
outputs from the system. Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
Technical Papers, from where it can be down-
loaded.

Guidance output of WHR for K98ME/MC7 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 1,467 2,241 3,411
6
80 936 1,593 2,277
100 1,719 2,619 3,987
7
80 1,098 1,863 2,664
100 1,962 3,006 4,572
8
80 1,251 2,133 3,060
100 2,214 3,393 5,157
9
80 1,413 2,412 3,456
100 2,466 3,780 5,742
10
80 1,566 2,691 3,843
100 2,709 4,158 6,309
11
80 1,728 2,952 4,239
100 2,961 4,545 6,912
12
80 1,890 3,231 4,635
100 3,456 5,319 8,082
14
80 2,205 3,789 5,418

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 9 of 12

Guidance output of WHR for K98MC-C/ME-C7 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 1,422 2,178 3,312
6
80 909 1,548 2,214
100 1,656 2,547 3,870
7
80 1,053 1,809 2,583
100 1,899 2,925 4,428
8
80 1,206 2,079 2,961
100 2,142 3,303 5,004
9
80 1,359 2,340 3,348
100 2,376 3,672 5,571
10
80 1,512 2,610 3,735
100 2,619 4,050 6,138
11
80 1,665 2,880 4,113
100 2,862 4,428 6,696
12
80 1,818 3,150 4,491
100 3,339 5,175 7,830
14
80 2,133 3,690 5,256

Guidance output of WHR for S90MC-C/ME-C8 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 1,242 1,800 2,799
6
80 792 1,269 1,872
100 1,449 2,115 3,276
7
80 927 1,494 2,187
100 1,656 2,421 3,753
8
80 1,053 1,719 2,502
100 1,872 2,736 4,239
9
80 1,188 1,944 2,835

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 10 of 12

Guidance output of WHR for K90ME-C9 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 1,350 2,115 3,195
6
80 864 1,512 2,151
100 1,575 2,475 3,735
7
80 1,008 1,773 2,520
100 1,809 2,853 4,293
8
80 1,152 2,034 2,889
100 2,034 3,213 4,833
9
80 1,296 2,295 3,249
100 2,259 3,573 5,382
10
80 1,440 2,547 3,618
100 2,493 3,942 5,931
11
80 1,584 2,817 3,996
100 2,718 4,302 6,471
12
80 1,737 3,078 4,356

Guidance output of WHR for S80MC-C/ME-C8 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 981 1,440 2,223
6
80 630 1,017 1,485
100 1,152 1,683 2,601
7
80 729 1,188 1,728
100 1,314 1,926 2,979
8
80 837 1,368 1,989

Guidance output of WHR for S80ME-C9 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 1,062 1,575 2,430
6
80 675 1,116 1,629
100 1,242 1,854 2,853
7
80 792 1,323 1,917
100 1,422 2,124 3,267
8
80 900 1,512 2,187
100 1,593 2,394 3,681
9
80 1,017 1,701 2,466

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 11 of 12

Guidance output of WHR for K80MC-C/ME-C6 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 846 1,269 1,944
6
80 540 891 1,296
100 990 1,485 2,277
7
80 630 1,044 1,512
100 1,134 1,710 2,619
8
80 720 1,215 1,746
100 1,278 1,935 2,943
9
80 810 1,368 1,962
100 1,422 2,160 3,294
10
80 900 1,539 2,196
100 1,566 2,376 3,618
11
80 999 1,683 2,421
100 1,710 2,601 3,960
12
80 1,089 1,845 2,646

Guidance output of WHR for K80ME-C9 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 1,062 1,647 2,502
6
80 675 1,179 1,683
100 1,242 1,935 2,925
7
80 792 1,377 1,962
100 1,422 2,223 3,357
8
80 909 1,584 2,259
100 1,602 2,502 3,789
9
80 1,026 1,791 2,547
100 1,782 2,790 4,221
10
80 1,134 1,989 2,835
100 1,962 3,078 4,644
11
80 1,251 2,196 3,123
100 2,142 3,366 5,085
12
80 1,368 2,403 3,420

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 12 of 12

Guidance output of WHR for S70MC-C/ME-C8 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 639 918 1,422
5
80 405 639 945
100 765 1,116 1,728
6
80 486 783 1,143
100 900 1,305 2,025
7
80 567 927 1,350
100 1,026 1,494 2,322
8
80 657 1,053 1,539

Guidance output of WHR for L70MC-C/ME-C8 engine rated in L1 at ISO conditions


Engine power PTG STG Combined Turbines
Cyl.
% SMCR kWe kWe kWe
100 639 918 1,422
5
80 405 639 945
100 765 1,116 1,728
6
80 486 783 1,143
100 900 1,305 2,025
7
80 567 927 1,350
100 1,026 1,494 2,322
8
80 657 1,053 1,539

Table 4.05.07: Theoretically calculated outputs

MAN B&W 98-70 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 12-8.3
MAN B&W 4.05
Page 1 of 1

Waste Heat Recovery Systems (WHR)

This section is not applicable

for

65-26 MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B

MAN B&W S65ME-C/-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B,


L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC
MAN Diesel 198 79 59-5.0
MAN Diesel 4.06
Page 1 of 3

L16/24 GenSet Data


Bore: 160 mm Stroke: 240 mm
Power layout
1,200 r/min 60 Hz 1,000 r/min 50 Hz
Eng. kW Gen. kW Eng. kW Gen. kW
5L16/24 500 475 450 430
6L16/24 660 625 570 542
7L16/24 770 730 665 632
8L16/24 880 835 760 722
9L16/24 990 940 855 812

A B 830 1000

C Q

178 23 031.0

**Dry weight
No. of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (1,000 r/min) 2,751 1,400 4,151 2,457 9.5
5 (1,200 r/min) 2,751 1,400 4,151 2,457 9.5
6 (1,000 r/min) 3,026 1,490 4,516 2,457 10.5
6 (1,200 r/min) 3,026 1,490 4,516 2,457 10.5
7 (1,000 r/min) 3,501 1,585 5,086 2,457 11.4
7 (1,200 r/min) 3,501 1,585 5,086 2,457 11.4
8 (1,000 r/min) 3,776 1,680 5,456 2,495 12.4
8 (1,200 r/min) 3,776 1,680 5,456 2,457 12.4
9 (1,000 r/min) 4,151 1,680 5,731 2,495 13.1
9 (1,200 r/min) 4,151 1,680 5,731 2,495 13.1

P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm
Q Min. distance between engines: 1,800 mm
* Depending on alternator
** Weight incl. standard alternator (based on a Leroy Somer alternator)
All dimensions and masses are approximate and subject to change without prior notice.
178 33 874.3

Fig. 4.06.01: Power and outline of L16/24

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 054.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.06
Page 2 of 3

L16/24 GenSet Data

Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9

Max. continuous rating at 1,000 rpm kW 450 540 630 720 810

Engine Driven Pumps:


H.T. cooling water pump (2.0 bar)** m3/h 10.9 12.7 14.5 16.3 18.1
L.T. cooling water pump (1.7 bar)** m3/h 15.7 18.9 22.0 25.1 28.3
Lubricating oil (3-5.0 bar) m3/h 21 23 24 26 28
External Pumps:
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.31 0.38 0.44 0.50 0.57
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discharge pressure) m/h 0.15 0.18 0.22 0.25 0.28
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.32 0.38 0.45 0.51 0.57
Cooling Capacities:
Lubricating oil kW 79 95 110 126 142
Charge air L.T. kW 43 51 60 68 77
*Flow L.T. at 36C inlet and 44C outlet m3/h 13.1 15.7 18.4 21.0 23.6
Jacket cooling kW 107 129 150 171 193
Charge air H.T kW 107 129 150 171 193
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 3,321 3,985 4,649 5,314 5,978
Exhaust gas temp. C 330 330 330 330 330
Max. allowable back press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/h 3,231 3,877 4,523 5,170 5,816
Starting Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm 0.47 0.56 0.65 0.75 0.84
Air consumption per start Nm 0.80 0.96 1.12 1.28 1.44
Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 11 13 15 17 19
Alternator kW (see separate data from the alternator maker)
The stated heat balances are based on tropical conditions, the flows are based on ISO ambient condition.

* The outlet temperature of the H.T. water is fixed to 80C, and


44C for L.T. water. At different inlet temperatures the flow will
change accordingly.

Example: if the inlet temperature is 25C, then the L.T. flow will
change to (44-36)/(44-25)*100 = 42% of the original flow. If the
temperature rises above 36C, then the L.T. outlet will rise ac-
cordingly.
178 56 53-3.0

** Max. permission inlet pressure 2.0 bar.

Fig. 4.06.02a: List of capacities for L16/24 1,000 rpm, IMO Tier I. Tier II values available on request.

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 054.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.06
Page 3 of 3

L16/24 GenSet Data

Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9

Max continues rating 1,200 rpm kW 500 660 770 880 990

Engine driven pumps:


LT cooling water pump 2 bar m/h 27 27 27 27 27
HT cooling water pump 2 bar m/h 27 27 27 27 27
Lubricating oil main pump 8 bar m/h 21 21 35 35 35
Separate pumps:
Max. Delivery pressure of cooling water pumps bar 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.35 0.46 0.54 0.61 0.69
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discharge pressure) m/h 0.17 0.22 0.26 0.30 0.34
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.35 0.46 0.54 0.62 0.70
Cooling capacity:
Lubricating oil kW 79 103 122 140 159
Charge air LT kW 40 57 70 82 95
Total LT system kW 119 160 192 222 254
Flow LT at 36C inlet and 44C outlet m/h 13 17 21 24 27
Jacket cooling kW 119 162 191 220 249
Charge air HT kW 123 169 190 211 230
Total HT system kW 242 331 381 431 479
Flow HT at 44Cinlet and 80C outlet m/h 6 8 9 10 11
Total from engine kW 361 491 573 653 733
LT flow at 36C inlet m/h 13 17 21 24 27
LT temp. Outlet engine C 60 61 60 60 59
(at 36C and 1 string cooling water system)
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 3,400 4,600 5,500 6,200 7,000
Exhaust gas temp. C 330 340 340 340 340
Max. Allowable back press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/h 3,280 4,500 5,300 6,000 6,800
Starting Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm 0.47 0.56 0.65 0.75 0.84
Air consumption per start Nm 0.80 0.96 1.12 1.28 1.44
Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 9 13 15 18 21
Alternator kW (see separate data from the alternator maker)

The stated heat balances are based on tropical conditions. The exhaust gas data (exhaust gas flow, exhaust gas temp.
and air consumption). are based on ISO ambient condition.

* The outlet temperature of the HT water is fixed to 80C, and 44C for the LT water

At different inlet temperature the flow will change accordingly.

Example: If the inlet temperature is 25C then the LT flow will change to (44-36)/(44-25)*100 = 42% of the original flow.
If the temperature rises above 36C, then the L.T. outlet will rise acordingly.

Fig. 4.06.02b: List of capacities for L16/24 1,200 rpm, IMO Tier I. Tier II values available on request.

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 054.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.07
Page 1 of 3

L21/31 GenSet Data


Bore: 210 mm Stroke: 310 mm
Power layout
900 r/min 60 Hz 1,000 r/min 50 Hz
Eng. kW Gen. kW Eng. kW Gen. kW
5L21/31 1,000 950 1,000 950
6L21/31 1,320 1,254 1,320 1,254
7L21/31 1,540 1,463 1,540 1,463
8L21/31 1,760 1,672 1,760 1,672
9L21/31 1,980 1,881 1,980 1,881

A B 1,200 1,400

C Q

178 23 043.2

**Dry weight
Cyl. no A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (900 rpm) 3,959 1,820 5,829 3,183 21.5
5 (1000 rpm) 3,959 1,870 5,829 3,183 21.5
6 (900 rpm) 4,314 2,000 6,314 3,183 23.7
6 (1000 rpm) 4,314 2,000 6,314 3,183 23.7
7 (900 rpm) 4,669 1,970 6,639 3,183 25.9
7 (1000 rpm) 4,669 1,970 6,639 3,183 25.9
8 (900 rpm) 5,024 2,250 7,274 3,289 28.5
8 (1000 rpm) 5,024 2,250 7,274 3,289 28.5
9 (900 rpm) 5,379 2,400 7,779 3,289 30.9
9 (1000 rpm) 5,379 2,400 7,779 3,289 30.9

P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2000 mm.
Q Min. distance between engines: 2400 mm (without gallery) and 2600 mm (with galley)
* Depending on alternator
** Weight incl. standard alternator (based on a Uljanik alternator)
All dimensions and masses are approximate, and subject to changes without prior notice.

Fig. 4.07.01: Power and outline of L21/31

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 066.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.07
Page 2 of 3

L21/31 GenSet Data


Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9
Maximum continuous rating at 900 rpm kW 950 1,320 1,540 1,760 1,980

Engine-driven pumps:
LT cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m/h 55 55 55 55 55
HT cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m/h 55 55 55 55 55
Lubricating oil pump (3-5 bar) m/h 31 31 41 41 41
External pumps:
Max. delivery pressure of cooling water pumps bar 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.65 0.91 1.06 1.21 1.36
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discharge pressure) m/h 0.32 0.44 0.52 0.59 0.67
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.66 0.92 1.07 1.23 1.38
Cooling capacities:
Lubricating oil kW 195 158 189 218 247
LT charge air kW 118 313 366 418 468
Total LT system kW 313 471 555 636 715
LT flow at 36C inlet and 44C outlet* m/h 27.0 44.0 48.1 51.9 54.0
Jacket cooling kW 154 274 326 376 427
HT charge air kW 201 337 383 429 475
Total HT system kW 355 611 709 805 902
HT flow at 44C inlet and 80C outlet* m/h 8.5 19.8 22.6 25.3 27.9
Total from engine kW 668 1082 1264 1441 1617
LT flow from engine at 36C inlet m/h 27.0 43.5 47.6 51.3 53.5
LT outlet temperature from engine at 36C inlet C 55 58 59 61 63
( 1-string cooling water system )
Gas data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 6,679 9,600 11,200 12,800 14,400
Exhaust gas temperature at turbine outlet C 335 348 348 348 348
Maximum allowable back pressure bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/h 6,489 9,330 10,900 12,400 14,000
Starting air system:
Air consumption per start incl. air for jet assist Nm 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8
Heat radiation:
Engine kW 49 50 54 58
Alternator kW ( See separate data from alternator maker )

The stated heat balances are based on 100% load and tropical
condition.
The mass flows and exhaust gas temperature are based on ISO
ambient condition.
* The outlet temperature of the HT water is fixed to 80C, and
44C for the LT water.
At different inlet temperature the flow will change accordingly.
17856 53-3.0
Example: If the inlet temperature is 25C then the LT flow will
change to (44-36)/(44-25)*100 = 42% of the original flow.
The HT flow will not change.

Fig. 4.07.02a: List of capacities for L21/31, 900 rpm, IMO Tier I. Tier II values available on request.

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 066.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.07
Page 3 of 3

L21/31 GenSet Data


Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9
Maximum continuous rating at 1000 rpm kW 1,000 1,320 1,540 1,760 1,980

Engine-driven pumps:
LT cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m/h 61 61 61 61 61
HT cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m/h 61 61 61 61 61
Lubricating oil pump (3-5 bar) m/h 34 34 46 46 46
External pumps:
Max. delivery pressure of cooling water pumps bar 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.69 0.92 1.08 1.23 1.38
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discharge pressure) m/h 0.34 0.45 0.53 0.60 0.68
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.70 0.93 1.09 1.25 1.40
Cooling capacities:
Lubricating oil kW 206 162 192 222 252
LT charge air kW 125 333 388 443 499
Total LT system kW 331 495 580 665 751
LT flow at 36C inlet and 44C outlet* m/h 35.5 47.8 52.1 56.2 60.5
Jacket cooling kW 163 280 332 383 435
HT charge air kW 212 361 411 460 509
Total HT system kW 374 641 743 843 944
HT flow at 44C inlet and 80C outlet* m/h 8.9 20.9 23.9 26.7 29.5
Total from engine kW 705 1136 1323 1508 1695
LT flow from engine at 36C inlet m/h 35.5 47.2 51.5 55.6 59.9
LT outlet temperature from engine at 36C inlet C 53 57 59 60 61
(1-string cooling water system)
Gas data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 6,920 10,200 11,900 13,600 15,300
Exhaust gas temperature at turbine outlet C 335 333 333 333 333
Maximum allowable back pressure bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/h 6,720 9,940 11,600 13,200 14,900
Starting air system:
Air consumption per start incl. air for jet assist Nm 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8
Heat radiation:
Engine kW 21 47 50 54 56
Alternator kW ( See separate data from alternator maker )

The stated heat balances are based on 100% load and tropical
condition.
The mass flows and exhaust gas temperature are based on ISO
ambient condition.
* The outlet temperature of the HT water is fixed to 80C, and
44C for the LT water.
At different inlet temperature the flow will change accordingly.
17856 53-3.0
Example: If the inlet temperature is 25C then the LT flow will
change to (44-36)/(44-25)*100 = 42% of the original flow.
The HT flow will not change.

Fig. 4.07.02a: List of capacities for L21/31, 1,000 rpm, IMO Tier I. Tier II values available on request.

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 066.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.08
Page 1 of 3

L23/30H GenSet Data

Bore: 225 mm Stroke: 300 mm


Power layout
720 r/min 60 Hz 750 r/min 50 Hz 900 r/min 60 Hz
Eng. kW Gen. kW Eng. kW Gen. kW Eng. kW Gen. kW
5L23/30H 650 620 675 640
6L23/30H 780 740 810 770 960 910
7L23/30H 910 865 945 900 1,120 1,065
8L23/30H 1,040 990 1,080 1,025 1,280 1,215

H P

A B 1,270 1,600

C Q

178 23 067.0

**Dry weight
No. of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (720 r/min) 3,369 2,155 5,524 2,383 18.0
5 (750 r/min) 3,369 2,155 5,524 2,383 18.0
6 (720 r/min) 3,738 2,265 6,004 2,383 19.7
6 (750 r/min) 3,738 2,265 6,004 2,383 19.7
6 (900 r/min) 3,738 2,265 6,004 2,815 21.0
7 (720 r/min) 4,109 2,395 6,504 2,815 21.4
7 (750 r/min) 4,109 2,395 6,504 2,815 21.4
7 (900 r/min) 4,109 2,395 6,504 2,815 22.8
8 (720 r/min) 4,475 2,480 6,959 2,815 23.5
8 (750 r/min) 4,475 2,480 6,959 2,815 23.5
8 (900 r/min) 4,475 2,340 6,815 2,815 24.5

P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm 178 34 537.1
Q Min. distance between engines: 2,250 mm
* Depending on alternator
** Weight includes a standard alternator, make A. van Kaick
All dimensions and masses are approximate and subject to change without prior notice.

Fig. 4.08.01: Power and outline of L23/30H

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 078.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.08
Page 2 of 3

L23/30H GenSet Data


Cyl. 5 6 7 8

Max. continuous rating at 720/750 RPM kW 650/675 780/810 910/945 1,040/1,080

Engine-driven Pumps:
Fuel oil feed pump (5.5-7.5 bar) m3/h 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0
L.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 55 55 55 55
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 36 36 36 36
Lub. oil main pump (3-5 bar) m3/h 16 16 20 20
Separate Pumps:
Diesel oil pump (4 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.46/0.48 0.55/0.57 0.64/0.67 0.73/0.76
Fuel oil supply pump *** (4 bar discharge pressure) m3/h 0.22/0.23 0.27/0.28 0.31/0.33 0.36/0.37
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.46/0.48 0.56/0.58 0.65/0.67 0.74/0.77
L.T. cooling water pump* (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 35 42 48 55
L.T. cooling water pump** (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 48 54 60 73
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 20 24 28 32
Lub. oil stand-by pump (3-5 bar) m3/h 14.0 15.0 16.0 17.0
Cooling Capacities:

Lubricating Oil:
Heat dissipation kW 69 84 98 112
L.T. cooling water quantity* m3/h 5.3 6.4 7.5 8.5
L.T. cooling water quantity** m3/h 18 18 18 25
Lub. oil temp. inlet cooler C 67 67 67 67
L.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler C 36 36 36 36
Charge Air:
Heat dissipation kW 251 299 348 395
L.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 30 36 42 48
L.T. cooling water inlet cooler C 36 36 36 36
Jacket Cooling:
Heat dissipation kW 182 219 257 294
H.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 20 24 28 32
H.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler C 77 77 77 77
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 5,510 6,620 7,720 8,820
Exhaust gas temp. C 310 310 310 310
Max. allowable back. press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/s 1.49 1.79 2.09 2.39
Starting Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm3 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0
Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 21 25 29 34
Generator kW (See separat data from generator maker)
The stated heat dissipation, capacities of gas and engine-driven pumps are given at 720 RPM. Heat dissipation gas and pump capaci-
ties at 750 RPM are 4% higher than stated. If L.T. cooling are sea water, the L.T. inlet is 32 C instead of 36C.
Based on tropical conditions, except for exhaust flow and air consumption which are based on ISO conditions.
* Only valid for engines equipped with internal basic cooling water system nos. 1 and 2.
** Only valid for engines equipped with combined coolers, internal basic cooling water system no. 3.
*** To compensate for built on pumps, ambient condition, calorific value and adequate circulations flow. The ISO fuel oil consumption is
multiplied by 1.45.
Fig. 4.08.02a: List of capacities for L23/30H, 720/750 rpm, IMO Tier I.

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 078.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.08
Page 3 of 3

L23/30H GenSet Data


Cyl. 6 7 8

Max. continuous rating at 900 RPM kW 960 1,120 1,280

Engine-driven Pumps:
Fuel oil feed pump (5.5-7.5 bar) m3/h 1.3 1.3 1.3
L.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 69 69 69
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 45 45 45
Lub. oil main pump (3.5-5 bar) m3/h 20 20 20
Separate Pumps:
Diesel oil pump (4 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.69 0.81 0.92
Fuel oil supply pump*** (4 bar discharge pressure) m3/h 0.34 0.40 0.45
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.70 0.82 0.94
L.T. cooling water pump* (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 52 61 70
L.T. cooling water pump** (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 63 71 85
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 30 35 40
Lub. oil stand-by pump (3.5-5 bar) m3/h 17 18 19
Cooling Capacities:

Lubricating Oil:
Heat dissipation kW 117 137 158
L.T. cooling water quantity* m3/h 7.5 8.8 10.1
SW L.T. cooling water quantity** m3/h 18 18 25
Lub. oil temp. inlet cooler C 67 67 67
L.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler C 36 36 36
Charge Air:
Heat dissipation kW 369 428 487
L.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 46 53 61
L.T. cooling water inlet cooler C 36 36 36
Jacket Cooling:
Heat dissipation kW 239 281 323
H.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 30 35 40
H.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler C 77 77 77
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 8,370 9,770 11,160
Exhaust gas temp. C 325 325 325
Max. allowable back. press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/s 2.25 2.62 3.00
Startiang Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm3 2.0 2.0 2.0
Haeat Radiation:
Engine kW 32 37 42
Generator kW (See separat data from generator maker)
If L.T. cooling are sea water, the L.T. inlet is 32 C instead of 36 C.
Based on tropical conditions, except for exhaust flow and air consumption which are based on ISO conditions.
* Only valid for engines equipped with internal basic cooling water system nos. 1 and 2.
** Only valid for engines equipped with combined coolers, internal basic cooling water system no. 3.
*** To compensate for built on pumps, ambient condition, calorific value and adequate circulations flow. The ISO fuel oil consumption is
multiplied by 1.45.

Fig. 4.08.02b: List of capacities for L23/30H, 900 rpm, IMO Tier I.

MAN B&W S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,


L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC,
MAN Diesel 198 42 078.5

S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC/MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN Diesel 4.09
Page 1 of 3

L27/38 GenSet Data


Bore: 270 mm Stroke: 380 mm
Power layout
720/750 r/min 60/50 Hz
720 r/min 60 Hz 750 r/min 50 Hz
(MGO/MDO) (MGO/MDO)
Eng. kW Gen. kW Eng. kW Gen. kW Eng. kW Gen. kW
5L27/38 1,500 1,440 1,600 1,536 - -
6L27/38 1,980 1,900 1,980 1,900 2,100 2,016
7L27/38 2,310 2,218 2,310 2,218 2,450 2,352
8L27/38 2,640 2,534 2,640 2,534 2,800 2,688
9L27/38 2,970 2,851 2,970 2,851 3,150 3,054

H P

A B 1,480 1,770

C Q 1,285

178 23 079.0

**Dry weight
No. of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (720 r/min) 4,346 2,486 6,832 3,628 42.3
5 (750 r/min) 4,346 2,486 6,832 3,628 42.3
6 (720 r/min) 4,791 2,766 7,557 3,712 45.8
6 (750 r/min) 4,791 2,766 7,557 3,712 46.1
7 (720 r/min) 5,236 2,766 8,002 3,712 52.1
7 (750 r/min) 5,236 2,766 8,002 3,712 52.1
8 (720 r/min) 5,681 2,986 8,667 3,899 56.3
8 (750 r/min) 5,681 2,986 8,667 3,899 58.3
9 (720 r/min) 6,126 2,986 9,112 3,899 63.9
9 (750 r/min) 6,126 2,986 9,112 3,899 63.9

P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm 178 33 898.2

Q Min. distance between engines: 2,900 mm (without gallery) and 3,100 mm (with gallery)
* Depending on alternator
** Weight includes a standard alternator
All dimensions and masses are approximate and subject to change without prior notice.

Fig. 4.09.01: Power and outline of L27/38

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C, K90MC-C/ME/ME-C,


S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,
L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 42 091.5

L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46ME-B, S40ME-B, S35ME-B


MAN Diesel 4.09
Page 2 of 3

L27/38 GenSet Data

Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9

Max continues rating 720 RPM kW 1,500 1,980 2,310 2,640 2,970

Engine driven pumps:


LT cooling water pump (2.5 bar) m/h 58 58 58 58 58
HT cooling water pump (2.5 bar) m/h 58 58 58 58 58
Lubricating oil main pump (8 bar) m/h 64 64 92 92 92
Separate pumps:
Max. Delivery pressure of cooling water pumps bar 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 1.02 1.33 1.55 1.77 2.00
Fuel oil Supply pump (4 bar at discharge pressure) m/h 0.50 0.66 0.76 0.87 0.98
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 1.03 1.35 1.57 1.80 2.02
Cooling capacity:
Lubricating oil kW 206 283 328 376 420
Charge air LT kW 144 392 436 473 504
Total LT system kW 350 675 764 849 924
Flow LT at 36C inlet and 44C outlet m/h 38 58 58 58 58
Jacket cooling kW 287 486 573 664 754
Charge air HT kW 390 558 640 722 802
Total HT system kW 677 1,044 1,213 1,386 1,556
Flow HT at 44Cinlet and 80C outlet m/h 16 22 27 32 38
Total from engine kW 1,027 1,719 1,977 2,235 2,480
LT flow at 36C inlet m/h 38 58 58 58 58
LT temp. Outlet engine C 59 58 61 64 68
(at 36C and 1 string cooling water system)
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 10,476 15,000 17,400 19,900 22,400
Exhaust gas temp. C 330 295 295 295 295
Max. Allowable back press. bar 0,025 0,025 0,025 0,025 0,025
Air consumption kg/h 10,177 14,600 17,000 19,400 21,800
Starting Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm3 2,5 2,9 3,3 3,8 4,3
Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 53 64 75 68 73
Alternator kW (see separate data from the alternator maker)

The stated heat balances are based on tropical conditions.


The exhaust gas data (exhaust gas flow, exhaust gas temp.
and air consumption). are based on ISO ambient condition.

* The outlet temperature of the HT water is fixed to 80C, and


44C for the LT water

At different inlet temperature the flow will change accordingly.


178 48 636.1

Example: If the inlet temperature is 25C then the LT flow will


change to (46-36)/(46-25)*100 = 53% of the original flow.
The HT flow will not change.
Fig. 4.09.02a: List of capacities for L27/38, 720 rpm, IMO Tier I. Tier II values available on request.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C, K90MC-C/ME/ME-C,


S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,
L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 42 091.5

L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46ME-B, S40ME-B, S35ME-B


MAN Diesel 4.09
Page 3 of 3

L27/38 GenSet Data

Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9

Max continues rating 750 RPM kW 1,600 1,980 2,310 2,640 2,970
Engine driven pumps:
LT cooling water pump 2.5 bar m/h 70 70 70 70 70
HT cooling water pump 2.5 bar m/h 70 70 70 70 70
Lubricating oil main pump 8 bar m/h 66 66 96 96 96
Separate pumps:
Max. Delivery pressure of cooling water pumps bar 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Diesel oil pump (5 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 1.10 1.34 1.57 1.79 2.01
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discharge pressure) m/h 0.54 0.66 0.77 0.88 0.99
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 1.11 1.36 1.59 1.81 2.04
Cooling capacity:
Lubricating oil kW 217 283 328 376 420
Charge air LT kW 155 392 436 473 504
Total LT system kW 372 675 764 849 924
Flow LT at 36C inlet and 44C outlet m/h 40 70 70 70 70
Jacket cooling kW 402 486 573 664 754
Charge air HT kW 457 558 640 722 802
Total HT system kW 859 1,044 1,213 1,386 1,556
Flow HT at 44Cinlet and 80C outlet m/h 21 22 27 32 38
Total from engine kW 1,231 1,719 1,977 2,235 2,480
LT flow at 36C inlet m/h 40 70 70 70 70
LT temp. Outlet engine C 62 55 58 61 64
(at 36C and 1 string cooling water system)
Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 11,693 15,000 17,400 19,900 22,400
Exhaust gas temp. C 330 305 305 305 305
Max. Allowable back press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/h 11,662 14,600 17,000 19,400 21,800
Starting Air System:
Air consumption per start Nm3 2.5 2.9 3.3 3.8 4.3
Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 54 64 75 68 73
Alternator kW (see separate data from the alternator maker)

The stated heat balances are based on tropical conditions.


The exhaust gas data (exhaust gas flow, exhaust gas temp.
and air consumption). are based on ISO ambient condition.

* The outlet temperature of the HT water is fixed to 80C, and


44C for the LT water

At different inlet temperature the flow will change accordingly.


178 48 636.1

Example: If the inlet temperature is 25C then the LT flow will


change to (46-36)/(46-25)*100 = 53% of the original flow.
The HT flow will not change.
Fig. 4.09.02b: List of capacities for L27/38, 750 rpm, IMO Tier I. Tier II values available on request.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C, K90MC-C/ME/ME-C,


S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,
L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 42 091.5

L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46ME-B, S40ME-B, S35ME-B


MAN Diesel 4.10
Page 1 of 2

L28/32H GenSet Data

Bore: 280 mm Stroke: 320 mm


Power layout
720 r/min 60 Hz 750 r/min 50 Hz
Eng. kW Gen. kW Eng. kW Gen. kW
5L28/32H 1,050 1,000 1,100 1,045
6L28/32H 1,260 1,200 1,320 1,255
7L28/32H 1,470 1,400 1,540 1,465
8L28/32H 1,680 1,600 1,760 1,670
9L28/32H 1,890 1,800 1,980 1,880

H P

A B 1,490 1,800

C Q 1,126

178 23 092.0

**Dry weight
No. of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
5 (720 r/min) 4,279 2,400 6,679 3,184 32.6
5 (750 r/min) 4,279 2,400 6,679 3,184 32.6
6 (720 r/min) 4,759 2,510 7,269 3,184 36.3
6 (750 r/min) 4,759 2,510 7,269 3,184 36.3
7 (720 r/min) 5,499 2,680 8,179 3,374 39.4
7 (750 r/min) 5,499 2,680 8,179 3,374 39.4
8 (720 r/min) 5,979 2,770 8,749 3,374 40.7
8 (750 r/min) 5,979 2,770 8,749 3,374 40.7
9 (720 r/min) 6,199 2,690 8,889 3,534 47.1
9 (750 r/min) 6,199 2,690 8,889 3,534 47.1

P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm
Q Min. distance between engines: 2,655 mm (without gallery) and 2,850 mm (with gallery)
* Depending on alternator
** Weight includes a standard alternator, make A. van Kaick
All dimensions and masses are approximate and subject to change without prior notice. 178 33 921.3

Fig. 4.10.01: Power and outline of L28/32H

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C, K90MC-C/ME/ME-C,


S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,
L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 42 101.5

L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46ME-B, S40ME-B, S35ME-B


MAN Diesel 4.10
Page 2 of 2

L28/32H GenSet Data


Cyl. 5 6 7 8 9
720/ 1,050/ 1,260/ 1,470/ 1,680/ 1,890/
Max. continuous rating at kW
750 RPM 1,100 1,320 1,540 1,760 1,980

Engine-driven Pumps:
Fuel oil feed pump (5.5-7.5 bar) m3/h 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.4
L.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 45 60 75 75 75
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 45 45 60 60 60
Lub. oil main pump (3-5 bar) m3/h 23 23 31 31 31

Separate Pumps:
Diesel oil Pump (4 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.73/0.77 0.88/0.92 1.02/1.08 1.17/1.23 1.32/1.38
Fuel oil supply pump *** (4 bar discharge pressure) m3/h 0.36/0.38 0.43/0.45 0.50/0.53 0.57/0.60 0.64/0.68
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 0.74/0.78 0.89/0.93 1.04/1.09 1.18/1.25 1.33/1.40
L.T. cooling water pump* (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 45 54 65 77 89
L.T. cooling water pump** (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 65 73 95 105 115
H.T. cooling water pump (1-2.5 bar) m3/h 37 45 50 55 60
Lub. oil stand-by pump (3-5 bar) m3/h 22 23 25 27 28
Cooling Capacities:
Lubricating Oil:
Heat dissipation kW 105 127 149 172 194
L.T. cooling water quantity* m3/h 7.8 9.4 11.0 12.7 14.4
SW L.T. cooling water quantity** m3/h 28 28 40 40 40
Lub. oil temp. inlet cooler C 67 67 67 67 67
L.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler C 36 36 36 36 36

Charge Air:
Heat dissipation kW 393 467 541 614 687
L.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 37 45 55 65 75
L.T. cooling water inlet cooler C 36 36 36 36 36
Jacket Cooling:
Heat dissipation kW 264 320 375 432 489
H.T. cooling water quantity m3/h 37 45 50 55 60
H.T. cooling water temp. inlet cooler C 77 77 77 77 77

Gas Data:
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 9,260 11,110 12,970 14,820 16,670
Exhaust gas temp. C 305 305 305 305 305
Max. allowable back. press. bar 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025 0.025
Air consumption kg/s 2.51 3.02 3.52 4.02 4.53

Starting Air System:


Air consumption per start Nm3 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5

Heat Radiation:
Engine kW 26 32 38 44 50
Generator kW (See separat data from generator maker)

The stated heat dissipation, capacities of gas and engine-driven pumps are given at 720 RPM. Heat dissipation gas and pump capaci-
ties at 750 RPM are 4% higher than stated. If L.T. cooling are sea water, the L.T. inlet is 32 C instead of 36C.
Based on tropical conditions, except for exhaust flow and air consumption which are based on ISO conditions.
* Only valid for engines equipped with internal basic cooling water system nos. 1 and 2.
** Only valid for engines equipped with combined coolers, internal basic cooling water system no. 3.
*** To compensate for built on pumps, ambient condition, calorific value and adequate circulations flow. The ISO fuel oil consumption
is multiplied by 1.45.
Fig. 4.10.02: List of capacities for L28/32H, IMO Tier I.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C, K90MC-C/ME/ME-C,


S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C, S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI,
L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 42 101.5

L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46ME-B, S40ME-B, S35ME-B


MAN Diesel 4.11
Page 1 of 2

L32/40 GenSet Data


Bore: 320 mm Stroke: 400 mm
Power layout
720 r/min 60 Hz 750 r/min 50 Hz
Eng. kW Gen. kW Eng. kW Gen. kW
6L32/40 3,000 2,895 3,000 2,895
7L32/40 3,500 3,380 3,500 3,380
8L32/40 4,000 3,860 4,000 3,860
9L32/40 4,500 4,345 4,500 4,345

H
P

A B 2,360 2,584

C Q 1,527

178 23 102.0

**Dry weight
No of Cyls. A (mm) * B (mm) * C (mm) H (mm)
GenSet (t)
6 (720 r/min) 6,340 3,415 9,755 4,510 75.0
6 (750 r/min) 6,340 3,415 9,755 4,510 75.0
7 (720 r/min) 6,870 3,415 10,285 4,510 79.0
7 (750 r/min) 6,870 3,415 10,285 4,510 79.0
8 (720 r/min) 7,400 3,635 11,035 4,780 87.0
8 (750 r/min) 7,400 3,635 11,035 4,780 87.0
9 (720 r/min) 7,930 3,635 11,565 4,780 91.0
9 (750 r/min) 7,930 3,635 11,565 4,780 91.0

P Free passage between the engines, width 600 mm and height 2,000 mm
Q Min. distance between engines: 2,835 mm (without gallery) and 3,220 mm (with gallery)
* Depending on alternator
** Weight includes an alternator, Type B16, Make Siemens
All dimensions and masses are approximate and subject to change without prior notice.
178 34 557.3

Fig. 4.11.01: Power and outline of 32/40

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C,


S90MC-C/ME-C, K90MC-C/ME/ME-C MAN Diesel 198 42 113.2
MAN Diesel 4.11
Page 2 of 2

L32/40 GenSet Data

500 kW/cyl
Cyl. 6 7 8 9
Max continues rating at: 720 RPM kW 3,000 3,500 4,000 4,500
750 RPM kW 3,000 3,500 4,000 4,500
Engine driven pumps:
LT cooling water pump 4.5 bar m/h 70 70 140 140
HT cooling water pump 4.5 bar m/h 70 70 70 70
Lubricating oil main pump 8 bar m/h 115 115 135 135
Pre-lubrication oil pump 1.5 bar m/h 21 21 27 34
Separate pumps:
Diesel oil pump (4 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 1.99 2.32 2.65 2.98
Fuel oil supply pump (4 bar discarge pressure) m/h 0.97 1.14 1.30 1.46
Fuel oil circulating pump (8 bar at fuel oil inlet A1) m/h 2.01 2.35 2.68 3.02
Fuel nozzle pump 3 bar m/h 1,0 1,2 1,4 1,6
LT cooling water pump 3 bar m/h 57 70 74 85
HT cooling water pump 4.3 bar m/h 42 49 56 63
Cooling capacity:
LT charge air kW 379 442 517 581
Lubrication oil engine kW 456 532 608 684
Lub. Seperator heat kW 25 29 33 38
Total Lub. Oil heat kW 481 561 641 721
Total heat dissipated LT side incl. Heat from Lub. Seperator kW 860 1,003 1,158 1,303
LT flow at 36C inlet engine m/h 57 70 74 85
Lub. Oil m/h 100 + z 110 + z 120 + z 130 + z
HT charge air kW 774 871 1011 1105
Jacket cooling kW 436 508 581 654
Total heat from HT side kW 1210 1380 1592 1759
HT temp. Inlet engine C 60 60 60 61
HT flow at 85C outlet engine m/h 42 49 56 63
Nozzel cooling kW 12 14 16 18
Gas Data:
Air consumption kg/h 21,600 25,200 28,800 32,400
Exhaust gas flow kg/h 22,200 25,900 29,600 33,300
Exhaust gas temperature at turbine outlet C 336 336 336 336
Starting air system:
Air consumption per start incl. Air for jet assist Nm 2,4 2,5 3,6 3,7
Heat ratiation:
Engine kW 109 127 145 164
Alternator kW (See separate data from alternator maker)

The stated heat balances are based on 100% load and tropical condition.
The mass flows and exhaust gas temperature are based on ISO ambient
condition.
Pump capacities of engine-driven pumps at 750 RPM are 4% higher than
stated.

z = Flushing oil of automatic filter.

Fig. 4.11.02: List of capacities for L32/40, IMO Tier I. 178 23 11-4.0

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C,


S90MC-C/ME-C, K90MC-C/ME/ME-C MAN Diesel 198 42 113.2
MAN B&W

Installation Aspects

5
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 5.01
Page 1 of 1

Space Requirements and Overhaul Heights

The latest version of most of the drawings of A special crane beam for dismantling the turbo-
this section is available for download at www. charger must be fitted. The lifting capacity of the
mandieselturbo.com under Products Marine crane beam for dismantling the turbocharger is
Engines & Systems Low Speed Installation stated in Section 5.03.
Drawings. First choose engine series, then engine
type and select from the list of drawings available The overhaul tools for the engine are designed
for download. to be used with a crane hook according to DIN
15400, June 1990, material class M and load ca-
pacity 1Am and dimensions of the single hook
Space Requirements for the Engine type according to DIN 15401, part 1.

The space requirements stated in Section 5.02 The total length of the engine at the crankshaft
are valid for engines rated at nominal MCR (L1). level may vary depending on the equipment to
be fitted on the fore end of the engine, such as
The additional space needed for engines adjustable counterweights, tuning wheel, moment
equipped with PTO is stated in Chapter 4. compensators or PTO.

If, during the project stage, the outer dimensions


of the turbocharger seem to cause problems, it
is possible, for the same number of cylinders, to
use turbochargers with smaller dimensions by
increasing the indicated number of turbochargers
by one, see Chapter 3.

Overhaul of Engine

The distances stated from the centre of the crank-


shaft to the crane hook are for the normal lifting
procedure and the reduced height lifting proce-
dure (involving tilting of main components). The
lifting capacity of a normal engine room crane can
be found in Fig. 5.04.01.

The area covered by the engine room crane shall


be wide enough to reach any heavy spare part re-
quired in the engine room.

A lower overhaul height is, however, available by


using the MAN B&W DoubleJib crane, built by
Danish Crane Building A/S, shown in Figs. 5.04.02
and 5.04.03.

Please note that the distance E in Fig. 5.02.01,


given for a doublejib crane is from the centre
of the crankshaft to the lower edge of the deck
beam.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-CGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 43 754.7
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "

#YL
 

$ECKBEAM
6

#
&
%

(
"ULKHEAD
&LOOR

 
 
 

 
  *
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK

+ ! ^ #OFFERDAM  

178 57 99-5.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 9,150 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for guid-


ance only. If the dimensions cannot be fulfilled,
please contact MAN Diesel or our local represen-
tative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W K98MC7


MAN Diesel 198 59 91-7.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14
Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A min. 13,531 15,281 18,271 20,021 21,771 23,521 25,271 A maximum shows engine with
built-on torsional vibration damper
max. 13,955 15,705 18,695 20,445 22,195 23,945 25,695 For PTO: See corresponding space require-
ment
6,395 MAN Diesel TCA The required space to
6,035 ABB TPL the engine room casing
B
includes hydraulic top
6,105 Mitsubishi MET bracing
5,325 5,567 5,808 5,754 6,027 6,164 6,301 MAN Diesel TCA Dimensions according to
C 5,163 5,405 5,905 5,592 5,865 6,002 6,398 ABB TPL turbocharger choice at
5,093 5,490 5,731 5,522 5,950 6,087 6,069 Mitsubishi MET nominal MCR

Available on request
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600
D 4,426 4,466 4,606 4,686 4,741 4,811 4,881 mm and must fulfil minimum height to tank
top according to classification rules
The distance from crankshaft centre line to
E 13,100 lower edge of deck beam, when using MAN
B&W Double Jib Crane
Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting pro-
13,400
cedure
F
Minimum overhaul height, reduced height
13,125
lifting procedure
See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fit-
G 4,850
ted on camshaft side
8,910 8,910 8,910 8,910 8,910 8,910 8,910 MAN Diesel TCA Dimensions according to
H 8,750 8,750 8,860 8,750 8,750 8,750 8,860 ABB TPL turbocharger choice at
8,870 8,845 8,845 8,870 8,845 8,845 8,870 Mitsubishi MET nominal MCR
Space for tightening control of holding down
J 640
bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propel-
K See text ler shaft, if the propeller shaft is to be drawn
into the engine room
Maximum 30 when engine room has mini-
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
mum headroom above the turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W K98MC7


MAN Diesel 198 59 91-7.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "

#YL  

$ECKBEAM

#
6
&
%

(
"ULKHEAD
&LOOR

 
 
 

 
  *
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK

+ ! ^ #OFFERDAM  

178 58 00-7.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 9,150 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for guid-


ance only. If the dimensions cannot be fulfilled,
please contact MAN Diesel or our local represen-
tative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W K98MC-C7


MAN Diesel 198 59 92-9.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14
Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A min. 13,531 15,281 18,271 20,021 21,771 23,521 25,271 A maximum shows engine with
built-on torsional vibration damper
max. 13,955 15,705 18,695 20,445 22,195 23,945 25,695 For PTO: See corresponding space require-
ment
6,395 MAN Diesel TCA The required space to
6,035 ABB TPL the engine room casing
B
includes hydraulic top
6,105 Mitsubishi MET bracing
5,125 5,367 5,608 5,554 5,691 5,964 6,101 MAN Diesel TCA Dimensions according to
C 4,963 4,877 5,705 5,392 5,529 6,061 6,198 ABB TPL turbocharger choice at

Available on request
4,893 5,290 5,099 5,322 5,459 5,887 5,684 MitsubishiMET nominal MCR
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600
D 4,461 4,541 4,621 4,711 4,761 4,831 4,901 mm and must fulfil minimum height to tank
top according to classification rules
The distance from crankshaft centre line to
E 12,650 lower edge of deck beam, when using MAN
B&W Double Jib Crane
Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting pro-
F 12,825
cedure
See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fit-
G 4,850
ted on camshaft side
8,650 8,650 8,650 8,650 8,650 8,650 8,650 MAN Diesel TCA Dimensions according to
H 8,490 8,490 8,600 8,490 8,490 8,600 8,600 ABB TPL turbocharger choice at
8,610 8,585 8,585 8,610 8,610 8,585 8,610 Mitsubishi MET nominal MCR
Space for tightening control of holding down
J 640
bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propel-
K See text ler shaft, if the propeller shaft is to be drawn
into the engine room
Maximum 30 when engine room has mini-
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
mum headroom above the turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W K98MC-C7


MAN Diesel 198 59 92-9.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "
 

#YL
$ECKBEAM

#
6
%
&

(
  "ULKHEAD

 
&LOOR
 

 
  *
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK
#OFFERDAM

+ !   

178 57 98-3.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 8,850 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for guid-


ance only. If the dimensions cannot be fulfilled,
please contact MAN Diesel or our local represen-
tative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W S90MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 90-5.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 6 7 8 9
Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine without crankshaft flange
A min. 12,307 13,909 15,511 18,293
A maximum shows engine with built-on torsional vibration
damper
max. 13,076 14,678 16,280 19,062
For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
- - - - MAN Diesel TCA
The required space to the engine room casing in-
B 5,750 5,870 5,870 5,870 ABB TPL
cludes mechanical top bracing
5,830 5,990 5,990 - Mitsubishi MET
4,605 5,125 5,367 5,487 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
C 4,445 4,963 5,205 5,325 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
4,489 4,893 5,135 5,410 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil minimum
D 4,630 4,680 4,745 4,825
height to tank top according to classification rules
The distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge of deck beam,
E 14,275
when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
14,500 Vertical lift of piston, one cylinder cover stud removed
F
13,525 Tilted lift of piston, one cylinder cover stud removed
G - See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on camshaft side
8,870 - - - MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
H 8,520 8,710 8,710 8,710 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
8,585 8,652 8,652 - Mitsubishi MET
J 640 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the propeller shaft
K See text
is to be drawn into the engine room
Maximum 75 when engine room has minimum headroom above the
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W S90MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 90-5.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "

#YL
 

$ECKBEAM

#
6
&
%

(
"ULKHEAD
&LOOR

 
 

 

 
  *
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK
#OFFERDAM
+ ! ^  

178 21 06-6.1

Normal/minimum centre line distance for twin


engine installation: 8,850/7,500 mm (7,500 mm
for common gallery for starboard and port design
engines).

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for guid-


ance only. If the dimensions cannot be fulfilled,
please contact MAN Diesel or our local represen-
tative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W K90MC-C6


MAN Diesel 198 57 72-5.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
min. 12,502 14,104 15,706 18,458 20,060 21,662 23,264 A maximum shows engine with
A built-on tuning wheel
max. 13,147 14,749 16,351 19,103 20,705 22,307 23,909 For PTO: See corresponding space require-
ment
5,850 MAN Diesel TCA The required space to
the engine room casing
B 5,850 ABB TPL
includes mechanical top
5,390 Mitsubishi MET bracing
4,363 4,779 5,125 5,246 5,487 5,418 5,554 MAN Diesel TCA Dimensions according to
C 4,203 4,617 4,963 5,084 5,584 5,256 5,392 ABB TPL turbocharger choice at
4,247 4,547 4,893 5,169 5,410 5,186 5,322 Mitsubishi MET nominal MCR
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600
D 4,244 4,299 4,374 4,459 4,509 4,584 4,644 mm and must fulfil minimum height to tank
top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft cen-
E 12,375 tre line to lower edge of deck beam, when
using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting pro-
12,800
cedure
F
Minimum overhaul height, reduced height
12,600
lifting procedure
See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted
G 4,700
on camshaft side
8,540 8,539 8,539 8,539 8,539 8,539 8,539 MAN Diesel TCA Dimensions according to
H 8,514 8,380 8,380 8,380 - 8,380 8,380 ABB TPL turbocharger choice at
8,578 8,372 8,372 8,595 8,595 8,372 8,372 Mitsubishi MET nominal MCR
Space for tightening control of holding down
J 640
bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propel-
K See text ler shaft, if the propeller shaft is to be drawn
into the engine room
Maximum 30 when engine room has mini-
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
mum headroom above the turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W K90MC-C6


MAN Diesel 198 57 72-5.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "

#9,
$ECKBEAM  

 

#
6
%
&

(
  &LOOR
"ULKHEAD

  
  *

4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK

#OFFERDAM
 
+ ! 

178 57 97-1.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 7,650 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for


guidance only. If the dimensions cannot be
fulfilled, please contact MAN Diesel or our local
representative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W S80MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 89-5.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 6 7 8

min. 11,229 12,653 14,077 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. - - - For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
- - - MAN Diesel TCA
The required space to the engine room casing includes me-
B - 5,580 5,650 ABB TPL
chanical top bracing
- 5,530 5,870 Mitsubishi MET
5,066 4,484 5,004 MAN Diesel TCA
C 5,163 4,324 4,989 ABB TPL Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at nominal MCR
4,989 4,368
4,772 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil minimum height to
D 4,546 4,581 4,661
tank top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge of deck beam,
E 12,950
when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
14,325 Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting procedure
F
13,175 Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting procedure
G 4,100 See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on camshaft side
8,723 8,720 8,723 MAN Diesel TCA
H - 8,675 8,780 ABB TPL Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at nominal MCR
8,778 8,740 8,681 Mitsubishi MET
J 510 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the propeller shaft is to be
K See text
drawn into the engine room
0, 15, 30, 45, 60,
V Maximum 45 when engine room has minimum headroom above the turbocharger
75, 90

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W S80MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 89-5.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "
 

#YL
$ECKBEAM

#
6

%
&

(
"ULKHEAD
  &LOOR

   
 

  *
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK #OFFERDAM
+ ! ^
 

178 89 98-8.1

Normal/minimum centre line distance for twin


engine installation: 8,450/7,150 mm (7,150 mm for
common gallery for starboard and port design
engines).

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for


guidance only. If the dimensions cannot be
fulfilled, please contact MAN Diesel or our local
representative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W K80MC-C6


MAN Diesel 198 57 75-0.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
min. 11,154 12,578 14,002 16,476 17,900 19,324 20,748
A maximum shows engine with built-on
A
tuning wheel
max. 11,736 13,160 14,584 17,058 18,482 19,906 21,330
For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
- - - - - - - MAN Diesel TCA The required space to the
B - 5,315 5,315 - - - - ABB TPL engine room casing includes
- - - 5,405 5,405 5,405 - Mitsubishi MET mechanical top bracing
4,766 5,066 4,658 5,004 5,125 5,246 5,367 MAN Diesel TCA Dimensions according to
C 4,604 4,083 4,324 4,842 4,963 5,084 5,205 ABB TPL turbocharger choice at
4,689 4,127 4,368 4,772 4,893 5,014 5,290 Mitsubishi MET nominal MCR
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm
D 4,012 4,077 4,142 4,237 4,282 4,342 4,392 and must fulfil minimum height to tank top ac-
cording to classification rules
The distance from crankshaft centre line to lower
E 11,300 edge of deck beam, when using MAN B&W
Double Jib Crane
Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting
11,900
procedure
F
Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting
11,500
procedure
See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on
G 4,500
camshaft side
7,742 7,742 7,742 7,742 7,742 7,742 7,742 MAN Diesel TCA Dimensions according to tur-
H 7,680 7,409 7,409 7,680 7,680 7,680 7,680 ABB TPL bocharger choice at nominal
- 7,475 7,475 7,758 7,758 7,758 - Mitsubishi MET MCR
Space for tightening control of holding down
J 510
bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propeller
K See text shaft, if the propeller shaft is to be drawn into the
engine room
Maximum 30 when engine room has minimum
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
headroom above the turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W K80MC-C6


MAN Diesel 198 57 75-0.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "
 

$ECKBEAM
#YL

#
6

&
%

(
 
  &LOOR


"ULKHEAD

  *

 
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK
#OFFERDAM

+ !   

178 57 92-2.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 6,850 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for


guidance only. If the dimensions cannot be
fulfilled, please contact MAN Diesel or our local
representative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W S70MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 83-4.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 5 6 7 8

min. 8,308 9,498 10,688 11,878 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. 8,733 9,923 11,113 12,303 For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
5,415 5,415 5,415 5,415 MAN Diesel TCA
The required space to the engine room casing includes
B 5,415 5,415 5,415 4,925 ABB TPL
mechanical top bracing
5,415 5,415 4,925 4,925 Mitsubishi MET
4,466 4,666 4,866 5,166 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
C 4,304 4,504 4,704 4,203 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
4,234 4,434 4,002 4,122 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil minimum
D 4,072 4,162 4,202 4,267
height to tank top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge of deck
E 11,675
beam, when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
12,475 Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting procedure
F
11,425 Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting procedure
G 3,700 See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on camshaft side
8,010 8,010 8,010 8,010 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
H 7,850 7,850 7,850 7,660 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
7,970 7,970 7,725 7,725 Mitsubishi MET

J 460 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts

K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the propeller shaft is
K See text
to be drawn into the engine room
Maximum 30 when engine room has minimum headroom above the
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W S70MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 83-4.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "

 

#YL
$ECKBEAM

#
6
&
%

(
"ULKHEAD


    &LOOR

 
  *
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK

#OFFERDAM
+ !   

514 37 01-0.0.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 6,850 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for


guidance only. If the dimensions cannot be
fulfilled, please contact MAN Diesel or our local
representative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W L70MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 66 52-1.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 5 6 7 8

min. 8,308 10,688 11,878 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
9,498
A A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. 8,821 10,011 11,201 12,391 For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
- - - - MAN Diesel TCA
The required space to the engine room casing includes
B - - - - ABB TPL
mechanical top bracing
- - 4,925 4,925 Mitsubishi MET
4,466 4,666 4,866 5,166 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
C 4,304 4,504 4,704 4,203 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
4,234 4,434 4,002 4,122 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil minimum
D 3,767 3,852 3,892 3,947
height to tank top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge of deck
E 10,475
beam, when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
11,250 Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting procedure
F
10,475 Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting procedure
G 3,700 See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on camshaft side
7,580 7,580 7,580 7,580 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
H 7,420 7,420 7,420 7,241 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
7,540 7,540 7,295 7,295 Mitsubishi MET

J 460 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts

K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the propeller shaft is
K See text
to be drawn into the engine room
Maximum 30 when engine room has minimum headroom above the
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W L70MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 66 52-1.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 4

Space Requirement

' "
 

#YL
$ECKBEAM

#
6
&
%

(
"ULKHEAD
  &LOOR


    *

 
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK

#OFFERDAM

+ !   

178 57 14-5.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 6,250 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for


guidance only. If the dimensions cannot be
fulfilled, please contact MAN Diesel or our local
representative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W S60MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 57 79-8.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 4

Cyl. No. 5 6 7 8

min. 7,122 8,142 9,162 10,182 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. 7,597 8,617 9,637 10,657 For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
4,850 4,850 5,100 5,100 MAN Diesel TCA
The required space to the engine room casing includes
B 4,280 4,680 5,100 5,100 ABB TPL
mechanical top bracing
4,590 4,590 5,100 5,100 Mitsubishi MET
3,787 3,887 4,087 4,566 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
C 3,521 3,727 3,927 4,404 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
3,546 3,771 4,029 4,334 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil minimum
D 3,705 3,780 3,820 3,890
height to tank top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge of deck
E 9,800
beam, when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
10,700 Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting procedure
F
9,975 Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting procedure
G 3,400 See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on camshaft side
7,045 7,045 7,045 7,045 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
H 6,582 6,700 6,886 6,886 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
6,760 6,760 7,005 7,005 Mitsubishi MET

J 345 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts

K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the propeller shaft is
K See text
to be drawn into the engine room
Maximum 45 when engine room has minimum headroom above the
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W S60MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 57 79-8.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 4

' "
 
. /
)
6

#YL
$ECKBEAM 2 3

&
% ,
(

 
 

"ULKHEAD


&LOOR

  *

 
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK

#OFFERDAM

+ !   

178 57 91-0.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 6,250 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for


guidance only. If the dimensions cannot be
fulfilled, please contact MAN Diesel or our local
representative.

Fig. 5.02.02a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on aft end (4 59 124)

MAN B&W S60MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 57 79-8.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 4

Cyl. No. 5 6 7 8

min. 7,122 8,142 9,162 10,182 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. 7,597 8,617 9,637 10,657 For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
MAN Diesel TCA
The required space to the engine room casing includes
B 2,850 ABB TPL
top bracing
Mitsubishi MET
4,312 4,587 5,141 5,416 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
C 4,046 4,427 4,979 5,254 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
4,071 4,471 4,909 5,184 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil minimum
D 3,705 3,780 3,820 3,890
height to tank top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge of deck
E 9,725
beam, when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
10,725 Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting procedure
F
9,975 Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting procedure
G 3,400 See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on camshaft side
7,684 7,684 7,684 7,684 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
H 7,000 7,234 7,535 7,535 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
7,015 - 7,350 7,350 Mitsubishi MET
2,355 2,355 2,355 2,355 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
I 2,150 2,280 2,463 2,463 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
2,387 - 2,425 2,425 Mitsubishi MET
J 345 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the propeller shaft is
K See text
to be drawn into the engine room
L 3,287 3,287 4,287 4,287 Space for air cooler element overhaul
N 2,450
O 2,234 The distances cover required space and hook travelling width for
R 2,272 turbocharger TCA88
S 2,229
Maximum 30 when engine room has minimum headroom above the
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.02b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W S60MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 57 79-8.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Space Requirement

' "

 
#YL

$ECKBEAM

#
6
&
%

(
"ULKHEAD


  &LOOR

 
    *
4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK

#OFFERDAM

+ !   

178 57 87-5.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 6,250 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for guid-


ance only. If the dimensions cannot be fulfilled,
please contact MAN Diesel or our local represen-
tative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W L60MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 80-9.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 2

Cyl. No. 5 6 7 8 9

A min. 7,122 8,142 9,162 10,182 11,202 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. 7,597 8,617 9,637 10,657 11,677 For PTO: See corresponding space requirement

- - - - - MAN Diesel TCA


The required space to the engine room casing
B 4,590 4,590 4,590 4,590 4,590 ABB TPL
includes mechanical top bracing
- - - 4,590 4,590 Mitsubishi MET
3,787 3,987 4,466 4,566 4,766 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
C 3,521 3,827 4,304 4,404 4,604 ABB TPL
nominal MCR
3,546 3,871 4,234 4,334 4,534 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil
D 3,437 3,537 3,562 3,632 3,632
minimum height to tank top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge of
E 8,925
deck beam, when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
9,675 Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting procedure
F
9,125 Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting procedure
See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on
G 3,400
camshaft side
6,677 6,677 6,677 6,677 6,677 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice at
H 6,209 6,332 - - - ABB TPL
nominal MCR
6,392 - 6,581 6,581 6,581 Mitsubishi MET
J 345 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the propeller
K See text
shaft is to be drawn into the engine room
Maximum 15 when engine room has minimum headroom above
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
the turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W L60MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 80-9.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 4

Space Requirement

' "
 

#YL $ECKBEAM

#
6

&
%

(
"ULKHEAD



&LOOR
 

 
  *

4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK
#OFFERDAM

 
+ ! ^

178 57 85-1.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 5,800 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for


guidance only. If the dimensions cannot be
fulfilled, please contact MAN Diesel or our local
representative.

Fig. 5.02.01a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on exhaust side (4 59 122)

MAN B&W S50MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 79-9.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 4

Cyl. No. 5 6 7 8 9

min. 5,924 6,774 7,624 8,474 9,324 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. 6,424 7,274 8,124 8,974 9,824 For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
4,310 4,310 4,580 4,580 4,580 MAN Diesel TCA
The required space to the engine room casing
B 4,310 4,310 4,310 4,580 4,580 ABB TPL
includes mechanical top bracing
4,310 4,580 4,580 4,580 - Mitsubishi MET
3,242 3,442 3,787 3,887 3,987 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice
C 3,121 3,221 3,521 3,727 3,827 ABB TPL
at nominal MCR
3,011 3,355 3,546 3,546 3,871 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil
D 3,198 3,278 3,308 3,358 3,358
minimum height to tank top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge
E 8,250
of deck beam, when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
9,000 Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting procedure
F
8,475 Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting procedure
G 3,175 See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on camshaft side
5,536 5,536 5,961 5,961 5,961 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice
H 5,561 5,561 5,561 5,557 5,557 ABB TPL
at nominal MCR
5,650 5,482 5,571 5,571 - Mitsubishi MET
J 350 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the
K See text
propeller shaft is to be drawn into the engine room
Maximum 30 when engine room has minimum headroom
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
above the turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.01b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W S50MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 79-9.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 4

' "
 
. /

)
6

$ECKBEAM
#YL

2 3

&
%
(

 "ULKHEAD ,
-
&LOOR


 

 
  *

4ANKTOP

$
,UBOILTANK
#OFFERDAM

 
+ ! ^

178 57 86-3.0

Normal centre line distance for twin engine instal-


lation: 5,800 mm.

The dimensions are given in mm, and are for


guidance only. If the dimensions cannot be
fulfilled, please contact MAN Diesel or our local
representative.

Fig. 5.02.02a: Space requirement for the engine, turbocharger on aft end (4 59 124)

MAN B&W S50MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 79-9.0
MAN B&W 5.02
Page  of 4

Cyl. No. 5 6 7 8 9

min. 5,924 6,774 7,624 8,474 9,324 Fore end: A minimum shows basic engine
A A maximum shows engine with built-on tuning wheel
max. 6,424 7,274 8,124 8,974 8,924 For PTO: See corresponding space requirement
MAN Diesel TCA
The required space to the engine room casing
B 2,780 ABB TPL
includes top bracing
Mitsubishi MET
3,617 3,892 4,312 4,450 4,587 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice
C 3,496 3,771 4,046 4,290 4,427 ABB TPL
at nominal MCR
3,386 3,805 4,071 4,209 4,471 Mitsubishi MET
The dimension includes a cofferdam of 600 mm and must fulfil
D 3,198 3,278 3,308 3,358 3,358
minimum height to tank top according to classification rules
The minimum distance from crankshaft centre line to lower edge
E 8,250
of deck beam, when using MAN B&W Double Jib Crane
9,000 Minimum overhaul height, normal lifting procedure
F
8,475 Minimum overhaul height, reduced height lifting procedure
G 3,175 See Engine Top Bracing, if top bracing fitted on camshaft side
6,375 6,375 6,490 6,490 6,490 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice
H 6,225 6,225 6,225 6,200 6,200 ABB TPL
at nominal MCR
- - 6,253 6,253 - Mitsubishi MET
1,950 1,950 2,120 2,120 2,120 MAN Diesel TCA
Dimensions according to turbocharger choice
I 2,086 2,086 2,086 2,100 2,100 ABB TPL
at nominal MCR
- - 2,071 2,071 - Mitsubishi MET
J 350 Space for tightening control of holding down bolts
K must be equal to or larger than the propeller shaft, if the propel-
K See text
ler shaft is to be drawn into the engine room
L 3,640 Space for air cooler element overhaul
M 3,850 4,240 4,240 4,240 4,240 Space for water mist catcher overhaul
N 1,700
O 1,716 The distances cover required space and hook travelling width for
R 1,492 turbocharger TCA66
S 1,698
Maximum 15 when engine room has minimum headroom above
V 0, 15, 30, 45, 60, 75, 90
the turbocharger

Fig. 5.02.02b: Space requirement for the engine

MAN B&W S50MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 79-9.0
MAN B&W 5.03
Page 1 of 4

Crane beam for overhaul of turbocharger

For the overhaul of a turbocharger, a crane beam The crane beam can be bolted to brackets that
with trolleys is required at each end of the turbo- are fastened to the ship structure or to columns
charger. that are located on the top platform of the engine.

Two trolleys are to be available at the compressor The lifting capacity of the crane beam for the
end and one trolley is needed at the gas inlet end. heaviest component W, is indicated in Fig.
5.03.01b for the various turbocharger makes. The
Crane beam no. 1 is for dismantling of turbocharg- crane beam shall be dimensioned for lifting the
er components. weight W with a deflection of some 5 mm only.
Crane beam no. 2 is for transporting turbocharger
components. HB indicates the position of the crane hook in the
See Figs. 5.03.01a and 5.03.02. vertical plane related to the centre of the turbo-
charger. HB and b also specifies the minimum
The crane beams can be omitted if the main engine space for dismantling.
room crane also covers the turbocharger area.
For engines with the turbocharger(s) located on
The crane beams are used and dimensioned for the exhaust side, EoD No. 4 59 122, the letter
lifting the following components: a indicates the distance between vertical cen-
trelines of the engine and the turbocharger.
Exhaust gas inlet casing
Turbocharger inlet silencer MAN B&W
Compressor casing Units TCA77 TCA88
W kg 2,000 3,000
Turbine rotor with bearings
HB mm 1,800 2,000
b m 800 1,000
The crane beams are to be placed in relation to the
turbocharger(s) so that the components around the ABB
gas outlet casing can be removed in connection Units TPL80 TPL85 TPL91
with overhaul of the turbocharger(s). W kg 1,500 3,000 4,500
HB mm 1,900 2,200 2,350
a Crane beam for b m 800 1,000 1,100
transportation of
Crane beam for Crane beam components
dismantling of ABB
components
Units A180 A185
Crane hook
Main engine/aft cylinder

W kg
Available on
HB mm
Engine room side

request
Gas outlet flange b m
Turbocharger
Mitsubishi
Units MET66 MET71 MET90
HB

W kg 1,500 1,800 3,500


b HB mm 1,800 1,800 2,200
b m 800 800 800
The figures a are stated on the Engine and Gallery Outline
drawing, Section 5.06.

Fig. 5.03.01b: Example of required height and distance


and weight based on S80ME-C and S80MC-C engines.
For data on other engines, please see section 5.03,
Fig. 5.03.01b of the specific engine Project Guide.
178 52 340.1

Fig. 5.03.01a: Required height and distance

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C/-GI/ME-B Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 62-9.0
MAN B&W 5.03
Page 2 of 4

Crane beam for turbochargers

Crane beam for transportation of components

Crane beam for dismantling of components

Spares

Crane beam for dismantling of components

Crane beam for transportation of components

178 52 746.0

Fig. 5.03.02: Crane beam for turbocharger

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C/-GI/ME-B Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 62-9.0
MAN B&W 5.03
Page 3 of 4

Crane beam for overhaul of air cooler


For 98-50 engines

Overhaul/exchange of scavenge air cooler.


6. Lower down the cooler insert between the gal-
Valid for air cooler design for the following engines lery brackets and down to the engine room
with more than one turbochargers mounted on the floor.
exhaust side. Make sure that the cooler insert is supported,
e.g. on a wooden support.
1. Dismantle all the pipes in the area around the
air cooler. 7. Move the air cooler insert to an area covered
by the engine room crane using the lifting
2. Dismantle all the pipes around the inlet cover beam mounted below the lower gallery of the
for the cooler. engine.

3. Take out the cooler insert by using the above 8. By using the engine room crane the air cooler
placed crane beam mounted on the engine. insert can be lifted out of the engine room.

4. Turn the cooler insert to an upright position.

5. Dismantle the platforms below the air cooler.

Engine room crane


5

1 2 3

Fig.: 5.03.03: Crane beam for overhaul of air cooler, turbochargers located on exhaust side of the engine 178 52 734.0

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C/-GI/ME-B Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 62-9.0
MAN B&W 5.03
Page 4 of 4

Crane beam for overhaul of air cooler


For 50 engines

Overhaul/exchange of scavenge air cooler. 3. Take out the cooler insert by using the above
placed crane beam mounted on the engine.
The text and figures are for guidance only.
4. Turn the cooler insert to an upright position.
Valid for all engines with aft mounted Turbocharger.
5. By using the engine room crane the air cooler
1. Dismantle all the pipes in the area around the insert can be lifted out of the engine room.
air cooler.

2. Dismantle all the pipes around the inlet cover


for the cooler.

Crane beam
for A/C

1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4

Fig.: 5.03.04: Crane beam for overhaul of air cooler, turbocharger located on aft end of the engine 517 93 99-9.0.0

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C/-GI/ME-B Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 62-9.0
MAN B&W 5.04
Page 1 of 3

Engine room crane

The crane hook travelling area must cover at least down to a level corresponding to the centre line of
the full length of the engine and a width in accord- the crankshaft.
ance with dimension A given on the drawing (see
cross-hatched area). For overhaul of the turbocharger(s), trolley mount-
ed chain hoists must be installed on a separate
It is furthermore recommended that the engine crane beam or, alternatively, in combination with
room crane can be used for transport of heavy the engine room crane structure, see separate
spare parts from the engine room hatch to the drawing with information about the required lifting
spare part stores and to the engine. capacity for overhaul of turbochargers.
See example on this drawing.

The crane hook should at least be able to reach

MAN B&W Doublejib Crane


Re
D

2) Spares
by
Normal crane
1)

Deck Deck
H1/H2

Deck beam Deck beam

H3
A A

Crankshaft Crankshaft

Engine room hatch

MAN B&W Doublejib Crane


1) The lifting
2) tools for the engine are designed to fit together Recommended area to be covered
D

Spares
with a standard crane hook with a lifting capacity in ac- by the engine room crane
cordance with the figure stated in the table. If a larger
crane hook is used, it may not fit directly to the overhaul
1)

tools, and
Deckthe use of an intermediate shackle or similarDeck
H1/H2

between the lifting tool and the crane hook will affect the
Deck beam
A

Deck beam
requirements for the minimum lifting height in the engine
H3

A room (dimension H). A

Crankshaft
2) The hatched area shows the height where an MAN B&W
Double-Jib Crane has to be used.
Minimum area
Engine room hatch to be covered
by the engine
room crane

519 24 62-8.0.0

Fig. 5.04.01: Engine room crane

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 43-8.0
MAN B&W 5.04
Page 2 of 3

Normal Crane
Height to crane hook in MAN B&W Double-Jib Crane
mm for:

Crane capacity in Reduced


Crane
tons selected height lift-
Mass in kg including operating
in accordance with ing
lifting tools width
DIN and JIS Normal procedure
in mm Building-in height
standard capacities lifting involving
in mm
procedure tilting of
main com-
ponents
(option)

A H1 H2 H3 D

centre line crankshaft

centre line crankshaft


Minimum height from

Minimum height from

Minimum height from

quired for removal of

ing any exhaust stud


Additional height re-

pletewithout remov-
exhaust valve com-
Piston with rod and

to centre line crane

to centre line crane


Minimum distance

shaft to underside
Cylinder liner with

DoubleJib Crane

centre line crank-


Cylinder cover
complete with

cooling jacket
exhaust valve

Normal crane
Engine type

stuffing box

deck beam
MAN B&W

hook

hook
K98MC7 10,700 9,125 6,050 12.5 2x6.3 3,950 13,400 13,125 13,100 1,100
K98MC-C7 10,700 7,825 5,950 12.5 2x6.3 3,950 12,825 - 12,650 1,075
S90MC-C8 9,200 9,175 5,325 10.0 2x6.3 3,900 14,500 13,525 14,275 500
K90MC
K90MC-C9 Available on request
S80MC-C9
S80MC-C8 6,200 8,350 4,125 10.0 2x5.0 3,200 14,325 13,175 12,950 675
K80MC-C6 6,375 4,800 3,675 8.0 2x4.0 3,500 11,900 11,500 11,300 575
K80ME-C9 Available on request
S70MC-C8 4,600 5,425 2,550 6.3 2x3.0 2,850 11,475 11,675 11,425 425
L70MC-C8 4,150 4,550 2,350 5.0 2x2.5 2,850 11,250 10,475 10,475 600
S65MC-C8 Available on request
S60MC-C8 2,875 3,425 1,650 4.0 2x2.0 2,650 10,725 9,975 9,725 475
L60MC-C8 2,575 2,775 1,550 3.2 2x2.0 2,650 9,675 9,125 8,925 575
S50MC-C8 1,700 1,900 975 2.0 2x1.6 2,150 9,000 8,475 8,250 425

Table 5.04.02: Engine room crane data.

The crane hook travelling area must cover at least The crane hook should at least be able to reach
the full length of the engine and a width in accor- down to a level corresponding to the centre line of
dance with dimension A given on the drawing, see the crankshaft.
crosshatched area.
For overhaul of the turbocharger(s), trolley mount-
It is furthermore recommended that the engine ed chain hoists must be installed on a separate
room crane can be used for transport of heavy crane beam or, alternatively, in combination with
spare parts from the engine room hatch to the the engine room crane structure, see Crane beam
spare part stores and to the engine. See example for overhaul of turbochargers with information
on this drawing. about the required lifting capacity for overhaul of
turbocharger(s).

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 43-8.0
MAN B&W 5.04
Page 3 of 3

Overhaul with MAN B&W DoubleJib crane


Deck beam

MAN B&W Double-Jib Crane

The DoubleJib crane


is available from:
Centreline crankshaft
Danish Crane Building A/S
P.O. Box 54
sterlandsvej 2
DK9240 Nibe, Denmark
Telephone: + 45 98 35 31 33
Telefax: + 45 98 35 30 33
Email: dcb@dcb.dk

178 24 863.0

Fig. 5.04.03: Overhaul with DoubleJib crane

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 43-8.0
MAN B&W 5.05
Page 1 of 1

Engine Outline

Please note that the information is to be found in


section 1.03 and in the Project Guide for the rel-
evant engine type.

The latest version of the dimensioned drawing


is available for download at www.mandiesel-
turbo.com under Products Marine Engines &
Systems Low Speed Installation Drawings.
First choose engine series, then engine type and
select Outline drawing for the actual number of
cylinders and type of turbocharger installation in
the list of drawings available for download.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 47 31-3.3
MAN B&W 5.06
Page 1 of 1

Gallery Outline

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

The latest version of the dimensioned drawing


is available for download at www.mandiesel-
turbo.com under Products Marine Engines &
Systems Low Speed Installation Drawings.
First choose engine series, then engine type and
select Outline drawing for the actual number of
cylinders and type of turbocharger installation in
the list of drawings available for download.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 54-7.2
MAN B&W 5.07
Page 1 of 1

Centre of Gravity

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 32-0.1
MAN B&W 5.08
Page 1 of 1

Water and Oil in Engine

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 31-9.1
MAN B&W 5.09
Page 1 of 1

Engine Pipe Connections

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 33-2.1
MAN B&W 5.10
Page 1 of 1

Counterflanges

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 34-4.1
MAN B&W 5.11
Page 1 of 1

Engine Seating and Holding Down Bolts

Please note that the latest version of most of the


drawings of this section is available for download
at www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
Installation Drawings. First choose engine series,
then engine type and select Engine seating in the
general section of the list of drawings available for
download.

Engine Seating and Arrangement of


Holding Down Bolts

The dimensions of the seating stated in Fig.


5.12.01 are for guidance only.

Further information is to be found in the Project


Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 49 23-1.2
MAN B&W 5.12
Page 1 of 1

Engine Seating Profile


Centre line
Continous girder crankshaft
to extend with
full dimensions If required by classification society,
apply this bracket.

K
Thickness of bracket is the same
as thickness of floorplates.

Centre line engine


L
N

Slots to be

J
cut in vertical
floor plates to
clear nuts
where necessary.

P Thickness of
floorplates
between main

I
engine girders. H

G F

E D

C B

Fig. 5.12.01: Profile of engine seating, epoxy chocks 178 06 434.3

Engine type A B C D E F G H I J K L M N P
K98MC7 3,255 2,730 50 1,955 60 1,525 50 1,510 30 781 1,700 80 50 500 38
K98MCC7 3,120 2,570 50 1,825 60 1,375 50 1,360 30 781 1,700 80 50 500 38
S90MCC8 3,360 2,875 44 2,100 55 1,755 44 1,730 30 920 1,800 75 50 470 34
K90MC9
Available om request
K90MCC9
K90MCC6 3,090 2,729 44 2,034 55 1,405 44 1,380 30 572 1,699 75 50 470 34
S80MCC8 3,275 2,815 40 2,100 50 1,735 40 1,710 25 920 1,736 70 50 440 34
K80MCC9 Available om request
K80MCC6 2,890 2,570 40 1,950 50 1,340 40 1,315 25 677 1,510 70 50 430 34
S70MCC8 2,880 2,485 36 1,890 45 1,530 36 1,515 22 805 1,520 65 50 400 34
L70MCC8 2,670 2,430 36 1,965 45 1,405 36 1,385 20 755 1,262 65 50 400 34
S65MCC8 Available om request
S60MCC8 2,410 2,175 30 1,855 40 1,330 30 1,315 20 700 1,300 60 50 400 25
L60MCC8 2,270 2,035 30 1,690 40 1,215 30 1,200 20 640 1,082 60 50 400 25
S50MCC8 2,090 1,880 28 1,505 36 1,110 28 1,095 20 518 1,088 50 47 400 22

Dimensions are stated in mm

Table 5.12.02: Engine seating data

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 45-1.0
MAN B&W 5.13
Page 1 of 2

Engine Top Bracing

The so-called guide force moments are caused by Without top bracing, the natural frequency of
the transverse reaction forces acting on the cross- the vibrating system comprising engine, ships
heads due to the connecting rod and crankshaft bottom, and ships side is often so low that reso-
mechanism. When the piston of a cylinder is not nance with the excitation source (the guide force
exactly in its top or bottom position the gas force moment) can occur close to the normal speed
from the combustion, transferred through the con- range, resulting in the risk of vibration.
necting rod, will have a component acting on the
crosshead and the crankshaft perpendicularly to With top bracing, such a resonance will occur
the axis of the cylinder. Its resultant is acting on above the normal speed range, as the natural fre-
the guide shoe and together they form a guide quencies of the double bottom/main engine sys-
force moment. tem will increase. The impact of vibration is thus
lowered.
The moments may excite engine vibrations mov-
ing the engine top athwart ships and causing a The top bracing is normally installed on the ex-
rocking (excited by H-moment) or twisting (excited haust side of the engine, but can alternatively be
by X-moment) movement of the engine. For en- installed on the manoeuvring side. A combination
gines with less than seven cylinders, this guide of exhaust side and manoeuvring side installation
force moment tends to rock the engine in the is also possible.
transverse direction, and for engines with seven
cylinders or more, it tends to twist the engine. The top bracing system is installed either as a
mechanical top bracing or a hydraulic top bracing.
The guide force moments are harmless to the Both systems are described below.
engine except when resonance vibrations occur
in the engine/double bottom system. They may,
however, cause annoying vibrations in the super- Mechanical top bracing
structure and/or engine room, if proper counter-
measures are not taken. The mechanical top bracing comprises stiff con-
nections between the engine and the hull.
As a detailed calculation of this system is normally
not available, MAN Diesel recommends that top The top bracing stiffener consists of a double
bracing is installed between the engines upper bar tightened with friction shims at each end of
platform brackets and the casing side. the mounting positions. The friction shims al-
low the top bracing stiffener to move in case of
However, the top bracing is not needed in all displacements caused by thermal expansion of
cases. In some cases the vibration level is lower if the engine or different loading conditions of the
the top bracing is not installed. This has normally vessel. Furthermore, the tightening is made with a
to be checked by measurements, i.e. with and well-defined force on the friction shims, using disc
without top bracing. springs, to prevent overloading of the system in
case of an excessive vibration level.
If a vibration measurement in the first vessel of a
series shows that the vibration level is acceptable
without the top bracing, we have no objection to
the top bracing being removed and the rest of
the series produced without top bracing. It is our
experience that especially the 7-cylinder engine
will often have a lower vibration level without top
bracing.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 46 725.8
MAN B&W 5.13
Page 2 of 2

The mechanical top bracing is to be made by the By a different pre-setting of the relief valve, the
shipyard in accordance with MAN Diesel instruc- top bracing is delivered in a low-pressure version
tions. (26 bar) or a high-pressure version (40 bar).

A
The top bracing unit is designed to allow dis-
A placements between the hull and engine caused
by thermal expansion of the engine or different
loading conditions of the vessel.

AA

Oil Accumulator

Hydraulic Control Unit


178 23 61-6.1

Fig. 5.13.01: Mechanical top bracing stiffener.


Option: 4 83 112
684

Cylinder Unit
Hydraulic top bracing

The hydraulic top bracing is an alternative to the


mechanical top bracing used mainly on engines

280
320

with a cylinder bore of 50 or more. The installation


normally features two, four or six independently
working top bracing units.

The top bracing unit consists of a single-acting hy-


draulic cylinder with a hydraulic control unit and an 475

accumulator mounted directly on the cylinder unit. Hull side Engine side

The top bracing is controlled by an automatic


switch in a control panel, which activates the top
bracing when the engine is running. It is possi-
ble to programme the switch to choose a certain
rpm range, at which the top bracing is active. For
14

service purposes, manual control from the control


350

250

panel is also possible.

When active, the hydraulic cylinder provides a


pressure on the engine in proportion to the vibra-
tion level. When the distance between the hull and
engine increases, oil flows into the cylinder under
178 57 48-8.0
pressure from the accumulator. When the dis-
tance decreases, a non-return valve prevents the Fig. 5.13.02: Outline of a hydraulic top bracing unit.
oil from flowing back to the accumulator, and the The unit is installed with the oil accumulator pointing
pressure rises. If the pressure reaches a preset either up or down. Option: 4 83 123
maximum value, a relief valve allows the oil to flow
back to the accumulator, hereby maintaining the
force on the engine below the specified value.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 46 725.8
MAN B&W 5.14
Page 1 of 1

Mechanical top bracing arrangement

Force per mechanical top bracing and maximum


horizontal deflection at attachment to the hull
Cyl.: 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 Force per
bracing in
Motor type Number of top bracings kN
K98MC-C
Available on request
K98MC
S90MC-C 6 6 7 7 209
K90MC-C 6 6 7 7 8 9 10 209
S80MC-C 5 6 6 165
K80MC-C 5 6 6 7 8 9 10 165
S70MC-C 4 5 6 6 126
L70MC-C 4 5 6 6 126
S60MC-C 4 5 6 6 93
L60MC-C 4 5 6 6 7 93
Centre line
crankshaft S50MC-C 4 5 5 6 6 64

Table 5.15.02: Mechanical top bracing force and


deflection

178 61 93-5.0

Fig. 5.15.01: Mechanical top bracing arrangement

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 40-2.0
MAN B&W 5.15
Page 1 of 1

Hydraulic top bracing arrangement

Force per hydraulic top bracing and maximum


horizontal deflection at attachment to the hull
Cyl.: 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 Force per
bracing in
Motor type Number of top bracings kN
K98MC-C 4 4 4 4 4 6 6 8 125,7
K98MC 4 4 4 4 4 6 6 8 125,7
S90MC-C 4 4 4 4 125,7
K90MC-C 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 125,7
S80MC-C 4 4 4 125,7
K80MC-C 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 125,7
S70MC-C 4 4 4 2 125,7
L70MC-C 4 4 4 2 125,7
S60MC-C 4 4 4 4 81,7
Centre line
crankshaft L60MC-C 4 4 4 4 4 81,7
S50MC-C 2 2 2 2 2 81,7

Table 5.15.02: Hydraulic top bracing force and deflection

Centre line

178 50 184.0

Fig. 5.15.01: Hydraulic top bracing arrangement

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 38-0.0
MAN B&W 5.16
Page  of 1

Components for Engine Control System

This section is not applicable

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 60 30-2.0
MAN B&W 5.17
Page 1 of 3

Shaftline Earthing Device

Scope and field of application Cabling of the shaftline earthing device to the hull
must be with a cable with a cross section not less
A difference in the electrical potential between the than 45 mm. The length of the cable to the hull
hull and the propeller shaft will be generated due should be as short as possible.
to the difference in materials and to the propeller
being immersed in sea water. Monitoring equipment should have a 4-20 mA
signal for alarm and a mV-meter with a switch for
In some cases, the difference in the electrical changing range. Primary range from 0 to 50 mV
potential has caused spark erosion on the thrust, DC and secondary range from 0 to 300 mV DC.
main bearings and journals of the crankshaft of
the engine. When the shaftline earthing device is working
correctly, the electrical potential will normally be
In order to reduce the electrical potential between within the range of 10-50 mV DC depending of
the crankshaft and the hull and thus prevent spark propeller size and revolutions.
erosion, a highly efficient shaftline earthing device
must be installed. The alarm set-point should be 80 mV for a high
alarm. The alarm signals with an alarm delay of 30
The shaftline earthing device should be able to seconds and an alarm cut-off, when the engine is
keep the electrical potential difference below 50 stopped, must be connected to the alarm system.
mV DC. A shaft-to-hull monitoring equipment with
a mV-meter and with an output signal to the alarm Connection of cables is shown in the sketch, see
system must be installed so that the potential and Fig. 5.17.01.
thus the correct function of the shaftline earthing
device can be monitored.

Note that only one shaftline earthing device is


needed in the propeller shaft system.

Design description

The shaftline earthing device consists of two silver


slip rings, two arrangements for holding brushes
including connecting cables and monitoring
equipment with a mV-meter and an output signal
for alarm.

The slip rings should be made of solid silver or


back-up rings of cobber with a silver layer all over.
The expected life span of the silver layer on the
slip rings should be minimum 5 years.

The brushes should be made of minimum 80%


silver and 20% graphite to ensure a sufficient
electrical conducting capability.

Resistivity of the silver should be less than 0.1


Ohm x m. The total resistance from the shaft to
the hull must not exceed 0.001 Ohm.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-GI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 49 292.4
MAN B&W 5.17
Page 2 of 3

Cable
connected
to the hull
Brush holder
arrangement

Monitoring
equipment
with mVmeter Cable
connected
to the hull

Slip ring Cable


to alarm
system

Slip ring
for monitoring
equipment Brush holder
arrangement

079 21 82-1.3.1.0

Fig. 5.17.01: Connection of cables for the shaftline earthing device

Shaftline earthing device installations

The shaftline earthing device slip rings must be


mounted on the foremost intermediate shaft as
close to the engine as possible, see Fig. 5.17.02

Rudder
Voltage monitoring
for shafthull potential
Propeller difference

Shaftline
earthing device

Current Main bearings

Propeller shaft Thrust bearing

Intermediate shaft Intermediate shaft bearing

079 21 82-1.3.2.0

Fig. 5.17.02: Installation of shaftline earthing device in an engine plant without shaft-mounted generator

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-GI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 49 292.4
MAN B&W 5.17
Page 3 of 3

When a generator is fitted in the propeller shaft


system, where the rotor of the generator is part of
the intermediate shaft, the shaftline earthing de-
vice must be mounted between the generator and
the engine, see Fig. 5.17.03

Rudder
Voltage monitoring
for shafthull potential
Propeller difference

Shaftline
earthing device

Current Main bearings

Propeller shaft Thrust bearing

Intermediate shaft Shaft mounted alternator


where the rotor is part of
the intermediate shaft
Intermediate shaft bearing

079 21 82-1.3.3.0

Fig. 5.17.03: Installation of shaftline earthing device in an engine plant with shaft-mounted generator

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-GI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 49 292.4
MAN B&W 5.18
Page 1 of 1

MAN Diesels Alpha Controllable Pitch Propeller and Alphatronic Propulsion Control

This section is not applicable

for

98-80 MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME-C, S80MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C MAN Diesel 198 79 50-9.0
MAN B&W 5.18
Page 1 of 8

MAN Diesels Alpha Controllable Pitch Propeller and Alphatronic Propulsion Control

MAN Diesels Alpha Controllable Pitch propeller VBS type CP propeller designation and range

On MAN Diesels Alpha VBS type Controllable The VBS type CP propellers are designated ac-
Pitch (CP) propeller, the hydraulic servo motor cording to the diameter of their hubs, i.e. VBS2240
setting the pitch is built into the propeller hub. A indicates a propeller hub diameter of 2,240 mm.
range of different hub sizes is available to select
an optimum hub for any given combination of The standard VBS type CP propeller programme,
power, revolutions and ice class. its diameters and the engine power range covered
is shown in Fig. 5.18.01.
Standard blade/hub materials are NiAlbronze.
Stainless steel is available as an option. The pro- The servo oil system controlling the setting of the
pellers are based on no ice class but are avail- propeller blade pitch is shown in Fig.5.18.05.
able up to the highest ice classes.

Propeller Diameter (mm)


10,000
V B S224 0
9,000
VB S20 80

V B S19 4
8,000 0
V B S18
00
7,000 V B S16
80
V B S15
60
V B S14
6,000 60
V B S13
80
V B S1
28 0
5,000 V B S1
180
V B S1
080
4,000 VBS
980
VBS
860
3,000 VBS
74 0
VBS
640
2,000

1,000

0
0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40
Engine Power (1,000 kW)

178 22 239.1

Fig. 5.18.01: VBS type Controllable Pitch (CP) propeller diameter (mm)

MAN B&W S70MC, S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65ME-C/ME-C-GI, S60MC, S60MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC, S50MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 46 953.5

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN B&W 5.18
Page 2 of 8

Data Sheet for Propeller

Identification:_ _______________________________

S W I

178 22 360.0

Fig. 5.18.02a: Dimension sketch for propeller design purposes

Type of vessel:_______________________________
For propeller design purposes please provide us
with the following information:

1. S:_______________ mm 7. Maximum rated power of shaft generator: kW


W:_ _____________ mm
I:________________ mm (as shown above) 8. Optimisation condition for the propeller:
To obtain the highest propeller efficiency
2. Stern tube and shafting arrangement layout please identify the most common service con-
dition for the vessel.
3. Propeller aperture drawing
Ship speed:____________________________ kn
4. Complete set of reports from model tank (re- Engine service load:_____________________ %
sistance test, selfpropulsion test and wake Service/sea margin:_____________________ %
measurement). In case model test is not avail- Shaft generator service load:_____________ kW
able the next page should be filled in. Draft:__________________________________ m

5. Drawing of lines plan 9. Comments:

6. Classification Society:___________
Ice class notation:_ _____________

Table 5.18.02b: Data sheet for propeller design purposes

MAN B&W S70MC, S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65ME-C/ME-C-GI, S60MC, S60MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B, MAN Diesel 198 46 953.5

L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC, S50MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,


S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC
MAN B&W 5.18
Page 3 of 8

Main Dimensions

Symbol Unit Ballast Loaded


Length between perpendiculars LPP m
Length of load water line LWL m
Breadth B m
Draft at forward perpendicular TF m
Draft at aft perpendicular TA m
Displacement o m3
Block coefficient (LPP) CB
Midship coefficient CM
Waterplane area coefficient CWL
Wetted surface with appendages S m2
Centre of buoyancy forward of LPP/2 LCB m
Propeller centre height above baseline H m
Bulb section area at forward perpendicular AB m2
178 22 970.0

Table 5.18.03: Data sheet for propeller design purposes, in case model test is not available this table should be filled in

Propeller clearance

To reduce pressure impulses and vibrations emit-


ted from the propeller to the hull, MAN Diesel
recommend a minimum tip clearance as shown in
Fig. 5.18.04.
Y

For ships with slender aft body and favourable


inflow conditions the lower values can be used,
whereas full afterbody and large variations in
D

wake field cause the upper values to be used. X

In twinscrew ships the blade tip may protrude Baseline


Z

below the base line. 178 22 372.0

Dismant-
High skew Nonskew Baseline
ling
Hub propeller propeller clearance
of cap
Y mm Y mm Z mm
X mm
VBS1280 390
VBS1380 420
VBS1460 450
VBS1560 480
1520% 2025% Min.
VBS 1680 515
of D of D 50100
VBS 1800 555
VBS 1940 590
VBS 2080 635
Fig. 5.18.04: Propeller clearance VBS 2240 680
178 48 589.0

MAN B&W S70MC, S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65ME-C/ME-C-GI, S60MC, S60MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC, S50MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 46 953.5

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN B&W 5.18
Page 4 of 8

Servo oil system for VBS type CP propeller

The design principle of the servo oil system for If deviation occurs, a proportional valve is actu-
MAN Diesels Alpha VBS type CP propeller is ated. Hereby high pressure oil is fed to one or the
shown in Fig. 5.18.05. other side of the servo piston, via the oil distribu-
tor ring, until the desired propeller pitch has been
The VBS system consists of a servo oil tank unit, reached.
the Hydraulic Power Unit, and a coupling flange
with electrical pitch feedback box and oil distribu- The pitch setting is normally remote controlled,
tor ring. but local emergency control is possible.

The electrical pitch feedback box continuously


measures the position of the pitch feedback ring
and compares this signal with the pitch order sig-
nal.

Hydraulic Power Unit

Oil tank
forward
seal
Stern
tube oil Pitch
tank order
PI
PAL
TI
PI PAH PAL
TAH

LAL PSL PSL


M M

Servo
piston
Pitch
feedback
Hydraulic
Lip ring seals pipe

M M
Propeller shaft

Zinc Monoblock Stern Oil distribution Drain


anode hub tube ring tank

178 22 384.1

Fig. 5.18.05: Servo oil system for MAN Diesels Alpha VBS type CP propeller

MAN B&W S70MC, S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65ME-C/ME-C-GI, S60MC, S60MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B, MAN Diesel 198 46 953.5

L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC, S50MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,


S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC
MAN B&W 5.18
Page 5 of 8

Hydraulic Power Unit for Alpha CP propeller

The servo oil tank unit, the Hydraulic Power Unit Maximum system pressure is set on the safety
for MAN Diesels Alpha CP propeller shown in Fig. valve.
5.18.06, consists of an oil tank with all other com-
ponents top mounted to facilitate installation at The return oil is led back to the tank via a thermo-
yard. static valve, cooler and paper filter.

Two electrically driven pumps draw oil from the oil The servo oil unit is equipped with alarms accord-
tank through a suction filter and deliver high pres- ing to the Classification Societys requirements
sure oil to the proportional valve. as well as necessary pressure and temperature
indicators.
One of two pumps are in service during normal
operation, while the second will start up at power- If the servo oil unit cannot be located with maxi-
ful manoeuvring. mum oil level below the oil distribution ring, the
system must incorporate an extra, small drain
A servo oil pressure adjusting valve ensures mini- tank complete with pump, located at a suitable
mum servo oil pressure at any time hereby mini- level, below the oil distributor ring drain lines.
mizing the electrical power consumption.

178 22 396.0

Fig. 5.18.06: Hydraulic Power Unit for MAN Diesels Alpha CP propeller, the servo oil tank unit

MAN B&W S70MC, S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65ME-C/ME-C-GI, S60MC, S60MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC, S50MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 53 208.2

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN B&W 5.18
Page 6 of 8

Alphatronic 2000 Propulsion Control System

MAN Diesels Alphatronic 2000 Propulsion Control Thrust control with optimization of propeller
System (PCS) is designed for control of propul pitch and shaft speed. Selection of combina
sion plants based on diesel engines with CP pro tor, constant speed or separate thrust mode is
pellers. The plant could for instance include tunnel possible. The rates of changes are controlled to
gear with PTO/PTI, PTO gear, multiple engines on ensure smooth manoeuvres and avoidance of
one gearbox as well as multiple propeller plants. propeller cavitation.

As shown in Fig. 5.18.07, the propulsion control A Load control function protects the engine
system comprises a computer controlled system against overload. The load control function con
with interconnections between control stations via tains a scavenge air smoke limiter, a load pro
a redundant bus and a hard wired backup control gramme for avoidance of high thermal stresses
system for direct pitch control at constant shaft in the engine, an automatic load reduction and
speed. an engineer controlled limitation of maximum
load.
The computer controlled system contains func
tions for: Functions for transfer of responsibility be
tween the local control stand, engine control
Machinery control of engine start/stop, engine room and control locations on the bridge are
load limits and possible gear clutches. incorporated in the system.

Main Control Station


Bridge Wing (Center) Bridge Wing
RPM Pitch RPM Pitch RPM Pitch

Operator Operator ES: Emergency Stop Operator


Panel (*) ES Panel BU ES Panel (*) ES
BU: BackUp Control

Duplicated Network

Handles
Bridge interface

Ships RPM Pitch


Alarm
System
System failure alarm, Load reduction, Load red. Cancel alarm
Operator
Panel
Engine Control Room

Engine Room Start/Stop/Slow turning, Start blocking, Remote/Local


Governor limiter cancel Shaft Generator
Speed Set / PMS
Fuel Index
Charge Air Press. Propulsion Auxiliary Control
Control Equipment
Governor

Local engine Engine overload (max. load)


control System
Pitch Set Coordinated
(In governor)

STOP
STOP

Remote/Local Control
START

Propeller Pitch
STOP

OVER Operator Backup selected System


LOAD Closed Loop
Panel Control Box
(OPP)
PI PI Engine speed
Pitch
Ahead/ Shut down, Shut down reset/cancel
Astern I
Terminals for Engine
PI
engine monitoring safety
sensors system
Terminals for
propeller
monitoring
sensors Pitch

178 22 406.1

Fig. 5.18.07: MAN Diesels Alphatronic 2000 Propulsion Control System

MAN B&W S70MC, S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65ME-C/ME-C-GI, S60MC, S60MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC, S50MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 53 221.3

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN B&W 5.18
Page 7 of 8

Propulsion control station on the main bridge

For remote control, a minimum of one control sta Propeller monitoring panel with backup in
tion located on the bridge is required. struments for propeller pitch and shaft speed.

This control station will incorporate three mod Thrust control panel with control lever for
ules, as shown in Fig. 5.18.08: thrust control, an emergency stop button and
push buttons for transfer of control between
Propulsion control panel with push buttons control stations on the bridge.
and indicators for machinery control and a dis
play with information of condition of operation
and status of system parameters.

288 144

PROPELLER PROPELLER
RPM PITCH
288

BACK UP
IN TAKE
CONTROL
CONTROL CONTROL
ON/OFF

178 22 418.1

Fig. 5.18.08: Main bridge station standard layout

MAN B&W S70MC, S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65ME-C/ME-C-GI, S60MC, S60MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC, S50MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 53 221.3

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN B&W 5.18
Page 8 of 8

Renk KAZ Clutch for auxilliary propulsion sys- Further information about Alpha CP propeller
tems
For further information about MAN Diesels Alpha
The Renk KAZ Clutch is a shaftline declutching Controllable Pitch (CP) propeller and the Alpha
device for auxilliary propulsion systems which tronic 2000 Remote Control System, please refer
meets the class notations for redundant propul to our publications:
sion.
CP Propeller Product Information
The Renk KAZ clutch facilitates reliable and
simple take home and take away functions in Alphatronic 2000 PCS Propulsion Control System
twostroke engine plants. It is described in Sec
tion 4.04. The publications are available at
www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
Technical Papers.

MAN B&W S70MC, S70MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C,


S65ME-C/ME-C-GI, S60MC, S60MC-C/ME-C/ME-C-GI/ME-B,
L60MC-C/ME-C, S50MC, S50MC-C/ME-C/ME-B, S46MC-C/ME-B,
MAN Diesel 198 53 221.3

S42MC, S40MC-C/ME-B, S35MC, S35MC-C/ME-B, L35MC, S26MC


MAN B&W

List of Capacities:
Pumps, Coolers &
Exhaust Gas

6
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 6.01
Page 1 of 2

Calculation of List of Capacities and Exhaust Gas Data

Updated engine and capacities data is available fied MCR and/or optimising point different from the
from the CEAS program on www.mandiesel- nominally rated MCR point, the list of capacities
turbo.com under Products Marine Engines & will be different from the nominal capacities.
Systems Low Speed CEAS - Engine Room
Dimensioning. Furthermore, among others, the exhaust gas data
depends on the ambient temperature conditions.
This chapter describes the necessary auxiliary ma-
chinery capacities to be used for a nominally rated Based on examples for a derated engine, the way
engine. The capacities given are valid for seawater of how to calculate the derated capacities, fresh-
cooling system and central cooling water system, water production and exhaust gas amounts and
respectively. For derated engine, i.e. with a speci- temperatures will be described in details.

Nomenclature

In the following description and examples of the auxiliary machinery capacities, freshwater generator pro-
duction and exhaust gas data, the below nomenclatures are used:

Engine ratings Point / Index Power Speed


Nominal MCR point L1 PL1 nL1
Specified MCR point M PM nM
Optimising point O PO nO
Service point S PS nS

Fig. 6.01.01: Nomenclature of basic engine ratings

Parameters Cooler index Flow index


Q = Heat dissipation air scavenge air cooler sw seawater flow
V = Volume flow lub lube oil cooler cw cooling/central water flow
M = Mass flow jw jacket water cooler exh exhaust gas
T = Temperature cent central cooler fw freshwater

Fig. 6.01.02: Nomenclature of coolers and volume flows, etc.

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 47-5.0
MAN B&W 6.01
Page 2 of 2

Engine configurations related to SFOC

The engine type is available in the following


version with respect to the efficiency of the
turbocharger:

K98MC/MC-C7, S90MC-C8, K90MC-C6,


S80MC-C7/8, K80MC-C6

With high efficiency turbocharger:


which is the basic design and for which the lists
of capacities Section 6.03 are calculated.

S70MCC-8, L70MC-C8, S60MC-C8,


L60MCC-8, S50MC-C8

A) With high efficiency turbocharger:


which is the basic design and for which the lists
of capacities Section 6.03 are calculated.

B) With conventional turbocharger,:


Which is an optional design (EoD No. 4 59 107)
if a higher exhaust gas temperature is required
for the exhaust gas boiler. This modification
will lead to a 78% reduction in the exhaust gas
amount and a temperature increase of about
20C. The SFOC penalty will be 2 g/kWh. The
corresponding lists of capacities are shown in
Section 6.03.

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 47-5.0
MAN B&W 6.02
Page 1 of 1

List of Capacities and Cooling Water Systems

The List of Capacities contain data regarding the The capacities for the starting air receivers and
necessary capacities of the auxiliary machinery the compressors are stated in Fig. 6.03.01.
for the main engine only, and refer to a nominally
rated engine. Complying with IMO Tier II NOx limi-
tations. Heat radiation and air consumption

The heat dissipation figures include 10% extra The radiation and convection heat losses to the
margin for overload running except for the scav- engine room is around 1% of the engine nominal
enge air cooler, which is an integrated part of the power (kW in L1).
diesel engine.
The air consumption is approximately 98.2%
of the calculated exhaust gas amount, ie.
Cooling Water Systems Mair = Mexh x 0.982.

The capacities given in the tables are based on


tropical ambient reference conditions and refer to Flanges on engine, etc.
engines with high efficiency/conventional turbo-
charger running at nominal MCR (L1) for: The location of the flanges on the engine are
shown in: Engine pipe connections, and the flang-
Seawater cooling system, es are identified by reference letters stated in the
See diagram, Fig. 6.02.01 and nominal capaci- List of flanges; both can be found in Chapter 5.
ties in Fig. 6.03.01
The diagrams use the Basic symbols for piping,
Central cooling water system, whereas the symbols for instrumentation accord-
See diagram, Fig. 6.02.02 and nominal capaci- ing to ISO 12191 and ISO 12192 and the in-
ties in Fig. 6.03.01 strumentation list found in Appendix A.

Scavenge air cooler

45 C

Seawater Seawater outlet


32 C 38 C
Lubricating oil cooler Jacket water cooler

80 C

Fig. 6.02.01: Diagram for seawater cooling system 178 11 264.1

Seawater outlet

80 C
Jaket
water
Central cooler
cooler
Scavenge
air 43 C
cooler (s)

Lubricating
45 C oil
cooler
Central coolant
Seawater inlet 36 C
32 C

Fig. 6.02.02: Diagram for central cooling water system 178 11 276.1

MAN B&W MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C/ME-B/ME-GI-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 74 63-3.0
MAN B&W 6.03
Page 1 of 1

List of capacities

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

Enclosed is an example of S70MC-C8.

See www.mandieselturbo.com under Products


Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
CEAS - Engine Room Dimensioning to calcu-
late list of capacities, enter engine specifications.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 48-7.0
MAN B&W 6.03
Page 1 of 4

List of Capacities for 5S70MC-C8-TII at NMCR - IMO NOx Tier II compliance

Seawater cooling Central cooling


Conventional TC High eff. TC Conventional TC High eff. TC

1 x MET83MA

1 x MET83MA
1 x TCA77-21

1 x TCA77-21
1 x A185-L34

1 x A185-L34
-

-
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 7.1 7.1 7.1 N.A. N.A. N.A. 7.1 7.1 7.1
Fuel oil supply m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 4.1 4.1 4.1 N.A. N.A. N.A. 4.1 4.1 4.1
Jacket cooling m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 135.0 135.0 135.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 135.0 135.0 135.0
Seawater cooling * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 530.0 530.0 540.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 510.0 520.0 520.0
Main lubrication oil * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 330.0 330.0 335.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 330.0 330.0 335.0
Central cooling * m/h - - - - - - - - - 410 410 410

Scavenge air cooler(s)


Heat diss. app. kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 6,820 6,820 6,820 N.A. N.A. N.A. 6,780 6,780 6,780
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 235 235 235
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 353 353 353 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Lubricating oil cooler


Heat diss. app. * kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 1,280 1,310 1,320 N.A. N.A. N.A. 1,280 1,310 1,320
Lube oil flow * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 330.0 330.0 335.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 330.0 330.0 335.0
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 175 175 175
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 177 177 187 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Jacket water cooler


Heat diss. app. kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 2,370 2,370 2,370 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2,370 2,370 2,370
Jacket water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 135 135 135 N.A. N.A. N.A. 135 135 135
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 175 175 175
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 177 177 187 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 10,430 10,460 10,470
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 410 410 410
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 510 520 520

Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 7.5 2 x 7.5 2 x 7.5 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 7.5 2 x 7.5 2 x 7.5
Compressor cap. m N.A. N.A. N.A. 450 450 450 N.A. N.A. N.A. 450 450 450

Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0 2 x 4.0
Compressor cap. m N.A. N.A. N.A. 240 240 240 N.A. N.A. N.A. 240 240 240

Other values
Fuel oil heater kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 185 185 185 N.A. N.A. N.A. 185 185 185
Exh. gas temp. C N.A. N.A. N.A. 245 245 245 N.A. N.A. N.A. 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 146,500 146,500 146,500 N.A. N.A. N.A. 146,500 146,500 146,500
Air consumption kg/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 39.9 39.9 39.9 N.A. N.A. N.A. 39.9 39.9 39.9

* For main engine arrangements with built-on power take-off (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system

For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/

Table 6.03.01e: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR

MAN B&W S70mc-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 70 92-9.0
MAN B&W 6.03
Page 2 of 4

List of Capacities for 6S70MC-C8-TII at NMCR - IMO NOx Tier II compliance

Seawater cooling Central cooling


Conventional TC High eff. TC Conventional TC High eff. TC

1 x MET83MA

1 x MET83MA
1 x TCA88-21

1 x TCA88-21
1 x A190-L34

1 x A190-L34
-

-
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 8.6 8.6 8.6 N.A. N.A. N.A. 8.6 8.6 8.6
Fuel oil supply m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 4.9 4.9 4.9 N.A. N.A. N.A. 4.9 4.9 4.9
Jacket cooling m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 165.0 165.0 165.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 165.0 165.0 165.0
Seawater cooling * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 640.0 640.0 640.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 620.0 620.0 620.0
Main lubrication oil * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 400.0 395.0 400.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 400.0 395.0 400.0
Central cooling * m/h - - - - - - - - - 495 495 495

Scavenge air cooler(s)


Heat diss. app. kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 8,190 8,190 8,190 N.A. N.A. N.A. 8,150 8,150 8,150
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 283 283 283
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 424 424 424 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Lubricating oil cooler


Heat diss. app. * kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 1,530 1,560 1,550 N.A. N.A. N.A. 1,530 1,560 1,550
Lube oil flow * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 400.0 395.0 400.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 400.0 395.0 400.0
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 212 212 212
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 216 216 216 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Jacket water cooler


Heat diss. app. kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 2,840 2,840 2,840 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2,840 2,840 2,840
Jacket water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 165 165 165 N.A. N.A. N.A. 165 165 165
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 212 212 212
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 216 216 216 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 12,520 12,550 12,540
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 495 495 495
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 620 620 620

Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0
Compressor cap. m N.A. N.A. N.A. 480 480 480 N.A. N.A. N.A. 480 480 480

Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5
Compressor cap. m N.A. N.A. N.A. 270 270 270 N.A. N.A. N.A. 270 270 270

Other values
Fuel oil heater kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 225 225 225 N.A. N.A. N.A. 225 225 225
Exh. gas temp. C N.A. N.A. N.A. 245 245 245 N.A. N.A. N.A. 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 175,800 175,800 175,800 N.A. N.A. N.A. 175,800 175,800 175,800
Air consumption kg/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 47.9 47.9 47.9 N.A. N.A. N.A. 47.9 47.9 47.9

* For main engine arrangements with built-on power take-off (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system

For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/

Table 6.03.01f: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR

MAN B&W S70mc-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 70 92-9.0
MAN B&W 6.03
Page 3 of 4

List of Capacities for 7S70MC-C8-TII at NMCR - IMO NOx Tier II compliance

Seawater cooling Central cooling


Conventional TC High eff. TC Conventional TC High eff. TC

1 x TPL91-B12

1 x TPL91-B12
2 x MET66MA

2 x MET66MA
1 x TCA88-21

1 x TCA88-21
-

-
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 10.0 10.0 10.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 10.0 10.0 10.0
Fuel oil supply m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 5.7 5.7 5.7 N.A. N.A. N.A. 5.7 5.7 5.7
Jacket cooling m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 190.0 190.0 190.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 190.0 190.0 190.0
Seawater cooling * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 750.0 750.0 750.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 720.0 720.0 720.0
Main lubrication oil * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 465.0 465.0 470.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 465.0 465.0 470.0
Central cooling * m/h - - - - - - - - - 570 580 580

Scavenge air cooler(s)


Heat diss. app. kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 9,550 9,550 9,550 N.A. N.A. N.A. 9,500 9,500 9,500
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 330 330 330
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 494 494 494 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Lubricating oil cooler


Heat diss. app. * kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 1,770 1,840 1,820 N.A. N.A. N.A. 1,770 1,840 1,820
Lube oil flow * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 465.0 465.0 470.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 465.0 465.0 470.0
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 240 250 250
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 256 256 256 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Jacket water cooler


Heat diss. app. kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 3,310 3,310 3,310 N.A. N.A. N.A. 3,310 3,310 3,310
Jacket water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 190 190 190 N.A. N.A. N.A. 190 190 190
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 240 250 250
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 256 256 256 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 14,580 14,650 14,630
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 570 580 580
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 720 720 720

Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0
Compressor cap. m N.A. N.A. N.A. 480 480 480 N.A. N.A. N.A. 480 480 480

Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5
Compressor cap. m N.A. N.A. N.A. 270 270 270 N.A. N.A. N.A. 270 270 270

Other values
Fuel oil heater kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 260 260 260 N.A. N.A. N.A. 260 260 260
Exh. gas temp. C N.A. N.A. N.A. 245 245 245 N.A. N.A. N.A. 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 205,100 205,100 205,100 N.A. N.A. N.A. 205,100 205,100 205,100
Air consumption kg/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 55.9 55.9 55.9 N.A. N.A. N.A. 55.9 55.9 55.9

* For main engine arrangements with built-on power take-off (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system

For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/

Table 6.03.01g: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR

MAN B&W S70mc-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 70 92-9.0
MAN B&W 6.03
Page 4 of 4

List of Capacities for 8S70MC-C8-TII at NMCR - IMO NOx Tier II compliance

Seawater cooling Central cooling


Conventional TC High eff. TC Conventional TC High eff. TC

1 x TPL91-B12

1 x TPL91-B12
2 x MET66MA

2 x MET66MA
1 x TCA88-25

1 x TCA88-25
-

-
Pumps
Fuel oil circulation m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 11.4 11.4 11.4 N.A. N.A. N.A. 11.4 11.4 11.4
Fuel oil supply m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 6.5 6.5 6.5 N.A. N.A. N.A. 6.5 6.5 6.5
Jacket cooling m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 215.0 215.0 215.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 215.0 215.0 215.0
Seawater cooling * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 850.0 850.0 850.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 820.0 820.0 820.0
Main lubrication oil * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 530.0 530.0 530.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 530.0 530.0 530.0
Central cooling * m/h - - - - - - - - - 650 660 660

Scavenge air cooler(s)


Heat diss. app. kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 10,920 10,920 10,920 N.A. N.A. N.A. 10,860 10,860 10,860
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 377 377 377
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 565 565 565 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Lubricating oil cooler


Heat diss. app. * kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 2,000 2,080 2,050 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2,000 2,080 2,050
Lube oil flow * m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 530.0 530.0 530.0 N.A. N.A. N.A. 530.0 530.0 530.0
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 273 283 283
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 285 285 285 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Jacket water cooler


Heat diss. app. kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 3,780 3,780 3,780 N.A. N.A. N.A. 3,780 3,780 3,780
Jacket water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 215 215 215 N.A. N.A. N.A. 215 215 215
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 273 283 283
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 285 285 285 N.A. N.A. N.A. - - -

Central cooler
Heat diss. app. * kW N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 16,640 16,720 16,690
Central water flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 650 660 660
Seawater flow m/h N.A. N.A. N.A. - - - N.A. N.A. N.A. 820 820 820

Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 12 starts. Fixed pitch propeller - reversible engine
Receiver volume m N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 8.5 2 x 8.5 2 x 8.5 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 8.5 2 x 8.5 2 x 8.5
Compressor cap. m N.A. N.A. N.A. 510 510 510 N.A. N.A. N.A. 510 510 510

Starting air system, 30.0 bar g, 6 starts. Controllable pitch propeller - non-reversible engine
Receiver volume m N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 N.A. N.A. N.A. 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5
Compressor cap. m N.A. N.A. N.A. 270 270 270 N.A. N.A. N.A. 270 270 270

Other values
Fuel oil heater kW N.A. N.A. N.A. 300 300 300 N.A. N.A. N.A. 300 300 300
Exh. gas temp. C N.A. N.A. N.A. 245 245 245 N.A. N.A. N.A. 245 245 245
Exh. gas amount kg/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 234,400 234,400 234,400 N.A. N.A. N.A. 234,400 234,400 234,400
Air consumption kg/h N.A. N.A. N.A. 63.8 63.8 63.8 N.A. N.A. N.A. 63.8 63.8 63.8

* For main engine arrangements with built-on power take-off (PTO) of a MAN Diesel recommended type and/or torsional vibration
damper the engine's capacities must be increased by those stated for the actual system

For List of Capacities for derated engines and performance data at part load please visit http://www.manbw.dk/ceas/erd/

Table 6.03.01h: Capacities for seawater and central systems as well as conventional and high efficiency turbochargers stated at NMCR

MAN B&W S70mc-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 70 92-9.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 1 of 12

Auxiliary Machinery Capacities


The dimensioning of heat exchangers (coolers) The percentage power (PM%) and speed (nM%) of L1
and pumps for derated engines can be calculated ie: PM% = PM/PL1 x 100%
on the basis of the heat dissipation values found nM% = nM/nL1 x 100%
by using the following description and diagrams. for specified MCR (M) of the derated engine is
Those for the nominal MCR (L1), may also be used used as input in the abovementioned diagrams,
if wanted. giving the % heat dissipation figures relative to
those in the List of Capacities,
The nomenclature of the basic engine ratings and
Specified MCR power, % of L1
coolers, etc. used in this section is shown in Fig. PM%
6.01.01 and 6.01.02. 110%

L1
100% 100%
98%
Cooler heat dissipations 94%
90%

For the specified MCR (M) the following three dia- L3 90% O=M

Qjw%
grams in Figs. 6.04.01, 6.04.02 and 6.04.03 show 86%
80%
reduction factors for the corresponding heat dis- 82% L2
sipations for the coolers, relative to the values 78%
70%
stated in the List of Capacities valid for nominal L4
MCR (L1).
60%
Specified MCR power, % of L1 80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105% 110% nM%
PM%
Specified MCR engine speed, % of L1
110%

L1 Qjw% = e ( 0.0811 x ln (n
M%
) + 0.8072 x ln (P
M%
) + 1.2614) 178 59 46-9.0

100% 100%

90% Fig. 6.04.02: Jacket water cooler, heat dissipation Qjw%


90% in point M, in % of the L1 value Qjw, L1
80%
L3 M

Qair% 70% 80% Specified MCR power, % of L1


L2 PM%
110%
65%
70% L1
100%
L4 98%
100%
96%
94%
92%
90% 90%
60% 88%
80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105% 110% nM% L3 M

Specified MCR engine speed, % of L1 80%


178 53 75-3.1
Qlub% L2

Qair% = 100 x (PM/PL1)1.68 x (nM/nL1) 0.83 x kO 70%


L4
kO = 1 + 0.27 x (1 PO/PM) = 1
60%
80% 85% 90% 95% 100% 105% 110% nM%
Fig. 6.04.01: Scavenge air cooler, heat dissipation Qair% in
Specified MCR engine speed, % of L1
point M, in % of the L1 value Qair, L1 and valid for PO = PM..
As optimising point O = M, correction kO = 1 178 53 77-7.1

Qlub% = 67.3009 x ln (nM%) + 7.6304 x ln (PM%)


245.0714

Fig. 6.04.03: Lubricating oil cooler, heat dissipation


Qlub% in point M, in % of the L1 value Qlub, L1

MAN B&W S90MC-C8-TII, K90MC-C6-TII,


S80MC-C8-TII, K80MC-C6-TII, S70MC-C8-TII,
S60MC-C8-TII, L60MC-C7/8-TII, S50MC-C8-TII
MAN Diesel 198 71 49-5.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 2 of 12

Pump pressures

Irrespective of the capacities selected as per the


above guidelines, the belowmentioned pump
heads at the mentioned maximum working tem-
peratures for each system shall be kept:

Pump head Max. working


bar temp C
Fuel oil supply pump 4 100
Fuel oil circulating pump 6 150
Lubricating oil pump:
K98MC-C7 4.9 70
K98MC7 4.8 70
S90MC-C8 4.7 70
S80MC-C8 4.6 70
K90MC-C6, S70MC-C8,
4.5 70
L70MC-C8
K80MC-C6 4.4 70
S60MC-C8, L60MC-C8 4.3 70
S50MC-C8 4.1 70
Seawater pump 2.5 50
Central cooling water pump 2.5 80
Jacket water pump 3.0 100

Flow velocities

For external pipe connections, we prescribe the


following maximum velocities:

Marine diesel oil .......................................... 1.0 m/s


Heavy fuel oil . ............................................. 0.6 m/s
Lubricating oil . ............................................ 1.8 m/s
Cooling water .............................................. 3.0 m/s

MAN B&W 98-50 ME/ME-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 41-4.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 3 of 12

Calculation of List of Capacities for Derated Engine


Example 1:

Pump and cooler capacities for a derated 6S70MC-C8-TII with high efficiency MAN Diesel turbocharger
type TCA, fixed pitch propeller and central cooling water system.

Nominal MCR, (L1) PL1: 19,620 kW (100.0%) and 91.0 r/min (100.0%)

Specified MCR, (M) PM: 16,677 kW (85.0%) and 81.9 r/min (90.0%)

Optmising point, (O) PO: 16,677 kW (85.0%) and 81.9 r/min (90.0%), PO = 100.0% of PM

The method of calculating the reduced capaci- Total cooling water flow through scavenge air
ties for point M (nM% = 90.0% and PM% = 85.0%) is coolers
shown below. Vcw,air,M = Vcw,air,L1 x Qair% / 100

The values valid for the nominal rated engine are Vcw,air,M = 283 x 0.831 = 235 m3/h
found in the List of Capacities, Figs. 6.03.01 and
6.03.02, and are listed together with the result in Cooling water flow through lubricating oil cooler
the figure on the next page. Vcw,lub,M = Vcw,lub,L1x Qlub% / 100

Heat dissipation of scavenge air cooler Vcw,lub,M = 212 x 0.917 = 194 m3/h
Fig. 6.04.01 which approximately indicates a Qair%
= 83.1% heat dissipation, i.e.: Cooling water flow through central cooler
Qair,M =Qair,L1 x Qair% / 100 (Central cooling water pump)
Vcw,cent,M = Vcw,air,M + Vcw,lub,M
Qair,M = 8,150 x 0.831 = 6,773 kW
Vcw,cent,M = 235 + 194 = 429 m3/h
Heat dissipation of jacket water cooler
Fig. 6.04.02 indicates a Qjw% = 88.5% heat dissi- Cooling water flow through jacket water cooler
pation; i.e.: (as for lube oil cooler)
Qjw,M = Qjw,L1 x Qjw% / 100 Vcw,jw,M = Vcw,lub,M

Qjw,M = 2,840 x 0.885 = 2,513 kW Vcw,jw,M = 194 m3/h

Heat dissipation of lube oil cooler Seawater pump for central cooler
Fig. 6.04.03 indicates a Qlub% = 91.7% heat dissi- As the seawater pump capacity and the central
pation; i.e.: cooler heat dissipation for the nominal rated en-
Qlub,M = Qlub, L1 x Qlub% / 100 gine found in the List of Capacities are 620 m3/h
and 12,520 kW the derated seawater pump flow
Qlub,M = 1,530 x 0.917 = 1,403 kW equals:

Heat dissipation of central water cooler Seawater pump:


Qcent,M = Qair,M + Qjw,M + Qlub, M Vsw,cent,M = Vsw,cent,L1 x Qcent,M / Qcent,L1

Qcent,M = 6,773 + 2,513 + 1,403 = 10,689 kW = 620 x 10,689 / 12,520 = 529 m3/h

MAN B&W S70MC-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 72 17-8.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 4 of 12

Nominal rated engine (L1)


Example 1
High efficiency
Specified MCR (M)
turbocharger (TCA)
Shaft power at MCR 19,620 kW 16,677 kW
Engine speed at MCR at 91.0 r/min at 81.9 r/min
Power of optmising point %MCR 100% 90%
Pumps:
Fuel oil circulating pump m3/h 8.6 8.6
Fuel oil supply pump m3/h 4.9 4.9
Jacket cooling water pump m3/h 165 165
Central cooling water pump m3/h 495 429
Seawater pump m3/h 620 529
Lubricating oil pump m3/h 400 400
Coolers:
Scavenge air cooler
Heat dissipation kW 8,150 6,773
Central water quantity m3/h 283 235
Lub. oil cooler
Heat dissipation kW 1,530 1,403
Lubricating oil quantity m3/h 400 400
Central water quantity m3/h 212 194
Jacket water cooler
Heat dissipation kW 2,840 2,513
Jacket cooling water quantity m3/h 165 165
Central water quantity m3/h 212 194
Central cooler
Heat dissipation kW 12,520 10,689
Central water quantity m3/h 495 429
Seawater quantity m3/h 620 529
Fuel oil heater: kW 225 225

Gases at ISO ambient conditions*


Exhaust gas amount kg/h 175,800 149,800
Exhaust gas temperature C 245 237.8
Air consumption kg/s 47.9 40.9
Starting air system: 30 bar (gauge)
Reversible engine
Receiver volume (12 starts) m3 2 x 8.0 2 x 8.0
Compressor capacity, total m3/h 480 480
Non-reversible engine
Receiver volume (6 starts) m3 2 x 4.5 2 x 4.5
Compressor capacity, total m3/h 270 270
Exhaust gas tolerances: temperature 15 C and amount 5%

The air consumption and exhaust gas figures are expected and refer to 100% specified MCR,
ISO ambient reference conditions and the exhaust gas back pressure 300 mm WC
The exhaust gas temperatures refer to after turbocharger
* Calculated in example 3, in this chapter

Example 1 Capacities of derated 6S70MC-C8-TII with high efficiency MAN Diesel turbocharger type TCA and
central cooling water system.

MAN B&W S70MC-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 72 17-8.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 5 of 12

Freshwater Generator
If a freshwater generator is installed and is utilis- At part load operation, lower than optimising
ing the heat in the jacket water cooling system, power, the actual jacket water heat dissipation will
it should be noted that the actual available heat be reduced according to the curves for fixed pitch
in the jacket cooling water system is lower than propeller (FPP) or for constant speed, controllable
indicated by the heat dissipation figures valid for pitch propeller (CPP), respectively, in Fig. 6.04.04.
nominal MCR (L1) given in the List of Capacities.
This is because the latter figures are used for With reference to the above, the heat actually
dimensioning the jacket water cooler and hence available for a derated diesel engine may then be
incorporate a safety margin which can be needed found as follows:
when the engine is operating under conditions
such as, e.g. overload. Normally, this margin is 1. Engine power equal to specified MCR
10% at nominal MCR. power M (equal to optimising point O).

Calculation Method For specified MCR (M) = optimising power


(O), the diagram Fig. 6.04.02 is to be used,
For a derated diesel engine, i.e. an engine having i.e. giving the percentage correction factor
a specified MCR (M) equal to optimising point (O) Qjw% and hence for optimising power PO:
different from L1, the relative jacket water heat dis- Qjw%
sipation for point M and O may be found, as previ- Qjw,O = Qjw,L1 x ___
100
x 0.9 (0.88)

[1]
ously described, by means of Fig. 6.04.02.
2. Engine power lower than optimising power.
Part load correction factor for jacket

cooling water heat dissipation For powers lower than the optimising power,
kp
the value Qjw,O found for point O by means of
1.0
the above equation [1] is to be multiplied by
0.9 the correction factor kp found in Fig. 6.04.04
0.8
and hence
0.7
Qjw = Qjw,O x kp 15%/0% [2]
0.6
FPP
0.5
where
CPP
Qjw = jacket water heat dissipation
0.4 Qjw,L1= jacket water heat dissipation at nominal
0.3 MCR (L1)
0.2
Qjw% = percentage correction factor from
Fig. 6.04.02
0.1
Qjw,O = jacket water heat dissipation at optimising
0 power (O), found by means of equation [1]
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100% kp = part load correction factor from Fig. 6.04.04
Engine load, % of optimising power (O) 0.9 = factor for safety margin of cooler, tropical
FPP : Fixed pitch propeller ambient conditions
CPP : Controllable pitch propeller, constant speed
178 59 45-7.0
The heat dissipation is assumed to be more or less
PS
FPP : kp = 0.742 x __
PO
+ 0.258 independent of the ambient temperature conditions,
yet the safety margin/ambient condition factor of
PS
CPP : kp = 0.822 x __
P
+ 0.178 about 0.88 instead of 0.90 will be more accurate for
O
ambient conditions corresponding to ISO tempera-
Fig. 6.04.04: Correction factor kp for jacket cooling tures or lower. The heat dissipation tolerance from
water heat dissipation at part load, relative to heat dis- 15% to 0% stated above is based on experience.
sipation at optimising power

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC/MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC/MC-C-TII, L70MC-C-TII,
S60MC/MC-C-TII, L60MC-C-TII
MAN Diesel 198 71 41-0.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 6 of 12
Freshwater generator system Jacket cooling water system

Expansion tank
Seawater
In Out Jacket cooling
water circuit

Condensator min max


Tjw Tjw L
M

Produced
freshwater

Evaporator B K

A
Brine out

Deaerating tank
Jacket water Jacket water pumps
cooler
Main engine
Cooling
water

Valve A: ensures that Tjw < 85 C


Valve B: ensures that Tjw > 85 5 C = 80 C
Valve B and the corresponding bypass may be omitted if, for example, the freshwater generator is equipped with an automatic
start/stop function for too low jacket cooling water temperature
If necessary, all the actually available jacket cooling water heat may be utilised provided that a special temperature control system
ensures that the jacket cooling water temperature at the outlet from the engine does not fall below a certain level

178 23 700.0

Fig. 6.04.05: Freshwater generators. Jacket cooling water heat recovery flow diagram

Jacket Cooling Water Temperature Control If necessary, all the actually available jacket cool-
ing water heat may be used provided that a special
When using a normal freshwater generator of the temperature control system ensures that the jacket
singleeffect vacuum evaporator type, the fresh- cooling water temperature at the outlet from the
water production may, for guidance, be estimated engine does not fall below a certain level. Such a
as 0.03 t/24h per 1 kW heat, i.e.: temperature control system may consist, e.g., of a
special bypass pipe installed in the jacket cooling
Mfw = 0.03 x Qjw t/24h 15%/0% [3] water system, see Fig. 6.04.05, or a special builtin
temperature control in the freshwater generator,
where e.g., an automatic start/stop function, or similar.

Mfw is the freshwater production in tons per 24 If such a special temperature control is not applied,
hours we recommend limiting the heat utilised to maxi-
mum 50% of the heat actually available at specified
and MCR, and only using the freshwater generator at
engine loads above 50%. Considering the cooler
Qjw is to be stated in kW margin of 10% and the minus tolerance of 15%,
this heat corresponds to 50 x(1.000.15)x0.9 = 38%
of the jacket water cooler capacity Qjw,M used for
dimensioning of the jacket water cooler.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC/MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC/MC-C-TII, L70MC-C-TII,
S60MC/MC-C-TII, L60MC-C-TII
MAN Diesel 198 71 41-0.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 7 of 12

Calculation of Freshwater Production for Derated Engine


Example 2:

Freshwater production from a derated 6S70MC-C8-TII with high efficiency MAN Diesel turbocharger type
TCA and fixed pitch propeller.

Based on the engine ratings below, this example will show how to calculate the expected available jacket
cooling water heat removed from the diesel engine, together with the corresponding freshwater production
from a freshwater generator.

The calculation is made for the service rating (S) of the diesel engine being 80% of the specified MCR.

Nominal MCR, (L1) PL1: 19,620 kW (100.0%) and 91.0 r/min (100.0%)

Specified MCR, (M) PM: 16,677 kW (85.0%) and 81.9 r/min (90.0%)

Optmising point, (O) PO: 16,677 kW (85.0%) and 81.9 r/min (90.0%), PO = 100.0% of PM

Service rating, (S) PS: 13,342 kW and 76.0 r/min, PS = 80.0% of PM and PS = 80.0% of PO

Ambient reference conditions: 20 C air and 18 C cooling water.

The expected available jacket cooling water heat For the service point the corresponding expected
at service rating is found as follows: obtainable freshwater production from a freshwa-
ter generator of the single effect vacuum evapora-
Qjw,L1 = 2,840 kW from List of Capacities tor type is then found from equation [3]:
Qjw% = 88.5% using 85.0% power and 90.0%
speed for O in Fig. 6.04.02 Mfw = 0.03 x Qjw = 0.03 x 1,884 = 56.5 t/24h
15%/0%
By means of equation [1], and using factor 0.88 for
actual ambient condition the heat dissipation in
the optmising point (O) is found:
Qjw%
Qjw,O = Qjw,L1 x ___
100
x 0.88

= 2,840 x ___
88.5
100
x 0.88 = 2,212 kW

By means of equation [2], the heat dissipation in


the service point (S) i.e. for 80.0% of optmising
power, is found:

kp = 0.852 using 80.0% in Fig. 6.04.04


Qjw = Qjw,O x kp = 2,212 x 0.852 = 1,884 kW
15%/0%

MAN B&W S70MC-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 72 19-1.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page  of 12

Exhaust Gas Amount and Temperature


Influencing factors

The exhaust gas data to be expected in practice b) The ambient conditions, and exhaust gas
depends, primarily, on the following three factors: backpressure:

a) The specified MCR point of the engine (point M): Tair : actual ambient air temperature, in C
pbar : actual barometric pressure, in mbar
PM : power in kW at SMCR point TCW : actual scavenge air coolant temperature,
nM : speed in r/min at SMCR point in C
pM : exhaust gas backpressure in mm WC at
and to a certain degree on the optimising point specified MCR
O with the percentage power PO% = % of SMCR
power: c) The continuous service rating of the engine
(point S), valid for fixed pitch propeller or control-
PO% = (PO/PM) x 100% lable pitch propeller (constant engine speed):

PS : continuous service rating of engine, in kW

Calculation Method

To enable the project engineer to estimate the ac- The partial calculations based on the above influ-
tual exhaust gas data at an arbitrary service rating, encing factors have been summarised in equations
the following method of calculation may be used. [4] and [5].

Mexh : exhaust gas amount in kg/h, to be found


Texh : exhaust gas temperature in C, to be found

PM ______ m Mamb% ms% ____ P


Mexh = ML1 x___ x1 + M%
1 + _______
x
x 1 + _____ x S%

kg/h +/5% [4]
PL1 100 100 100 100

Texh = TL1 + TM + TO + Tamb + TS C /+15 C [5]

where, according to List of capacities, i.e. referring to ISO ambient conditions and 300 mm WC
backpressure and specified/optimised in L1:
ML1: exhaust gas amount in kg/h at nominal MCR (L1)
TL1: exhaust gas temperature after turbocharger in C at nominal MCR (L1)

Fig. 6.04.06: Summarising equations for exhaust gas amounts and temperatures

The partial calculations based on the influencing changes in specific exhaust gas amount and
factors are described in the following: temperature are found by using as input in dia-
grams the corresponding percentage values (of
a) Correction for choice of specified MCR point L1) for specified MCR power PM% and speed nM%:
PM% = PM/PL1 x 100%
When choosing a specified MCR point M other nM% = nM/nL1 x 100%
than the nominal MCR point L1, the resulting

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 61 76-4.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page  of 12

3PECIFIED-#2POWER OF, 3PECIFIED-#2POWER OF,


0 - 0-

 
,
 ,
 
#
 

  
- -
, , #

 
, #
# ,

M- 4M #
 #

#
, ,

 

       N-        N-
3PECIFIED-#2ENGINESPEED OF, 3PECIFIED-#2ENGINESPEED OF,

mM% = 14 x ln (PM/PL1) 24 x ln (nM/nL1) TM = 15 x ln (PM/PL1) + 45 x ln (nM/nL1)


178 51 130.2
178 51 117.2

Fig. 6.04.07: Change of specific exhaust gas amount, Fig. 6.04.08: Change of exhaust gas temperature, TM
mM% in % of L1 value and independent of PO in point M, in C after turbocharger relative to L1 value
and valid for PO = PM

mM% : change of specific exhaust gas amount, in b) Correction for actual ambient conditions and
% of specific gas amount at nominal MCR backpressure
(L1), see Fig. 6.04.07.
For ambient conditions other than ISO
TM : change in exhaust gas temperature after 3046-1:2002 (E) and ISO 15550:2002 (E), and
turbocharger relative to the L1 value, in C, backpressure other than 300 mm WC at
see Fig. 6.04.08. (PO = PM) specified MCR point (M), the correction fac-
tors stated in the table in Fig. 6.04.09 may
TO : extra change in exhaust gas temperature be used as a guide, and the corresponding
when optimising point O lower than 100% M: relative change in the exhaust gas data may
PO% = (PO/PM) x 100%. be found from equations [7] and [8], shown in
Fig. 6.04.10.
TO = 0.3 x (100 PO%) [6]

Change of Change of
exhaust gas exhaust gas
Parameter Change temperature amount
Blower inlet temperature + 10 C + 16.0 C 4.1 %
Blower inlet pressure (barometric pressure) + 10 mbar 0.1 C + 0.3 %
Charge air coolant temperature (seawater temperature) + 10 C + 1.0 C + 1.9 %
Exhaust gas back pressure at the specified MCR point + 100 mm WC + 5.0 C 1.1 %

Fig. 6.04.09: Correction of exhaust gas data for ambient conditions and exhaust gas back pressure

MAN B&W S90MC-C8, K90MC-C6, S80MC-


C8, K80MC-C6, S70MC-C8, S60MC-C8,
L60MC-C7/8, S50MC-C8
MAN Diesel 198 61 77-6.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 10 of 12

Mamb% = 0.41 x (Tair 25) + 0.03 x (pbar 1000) + 0.19 x (TCW 25 ) 0.011 x (pM 300) % [7]

Tamb = 1.6 x (Tair 25) 0.01 x (pbar 1000) +0.1 x (TCW 25) + 0.05 x (pM 300) C [8]

where the following nomenclature is used:

Mamb% : change in exhaust gas amount, in % of amount at ISO conditions

Tamb : change in exhaust gas temperature, in C compared with temperatures at ISO conditions

Fig. 6.04.10: Exhaust gas correction formula for ambient conditions and exhaust gas back pressure

mS% TS C
20 20

18 15

16
10

14
5
12 M
0
10
-5
8
-10
6

-15
4

-20
2
M
0 -25
50 60 70 80 90 100 110 PS%
2 Engine load, % specified MCR power

4
50 60 70 80 90 100 110 PS%
Engine load, % specified MCR power

178 24 623.0 178 24 635.0

PS% = (PS/PM) x 100% PS% = (PS/PM) x 100%

mS%= 37 x (PS/PM)3 87 x (PS/PM)2 + 31 x (PS/PM) + 19 TS = 280 x (PS/PM)2 410 x (PS/PM) + 130

Fig. 6.04.11: Change of specific exhaust gas amount, ms% Fig. 6.04.12: Change of exhaust gas temperature, TS in
in % at part load, and valid for FPP and CPP C at part load, and valid for FPP and CPP

c) Correction for engine load

Figs. 6.04.11 and 6.04.12 may be used, as ms% : change in specific exhaust gas amount,
guidance, to determine the relative changes in % of specific amount at specified MCR
in the specific exhaust gas data when running point, see Fig. 6.04.11.
at part load, compared to the values in the
specified MCR point, i.e. using as input PS% = Ts : change in exhaust gas temperature, in C,
(PS/PM) x 100%: see Fig. 6.04.12.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/ME-B/MEC/MEGI-TII engines


MAN Diesel 198 71 40-9.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 11 of 12

Calculation of Exhaust Data for Derated Engine


Example 3:

Expected exhaust gas data for a derated 6S70MC-C8-TII with high efficiency MAN Diesel turbocharger
type TCA and fixed pitch propeller.

Based on the engine ratings below, and by means of an example, this chapter will show how to calculate
the expected exhaust gas amount and temperature at service rating, and for a given ambient reference
condition different from ISO.

The calculation is made for the service rating (S) being 80% of the specified MCR power of the diesel engine.

Nominal MCR, (L1) PL1: 19,620 kW (100.0%) and 91.0 r/min (100.0%)

Specified MCR, (M) PM: 16,677 kW (85.0%) and 81.9 r/min (90.0%)

Optmising point, (O) PO: 16,677 kW (85.0%) and 81.9 r/min (90.0%), PO = 100.0% of PM

Service rating, (S) PS: 13,342 kW and 76.0 r/min, PS = 80.0% of PM

Reference conditions

Air temperature Tair ......................................... 20 C b) Correction for ambient conditions and


Scavenge air coolant temperature TCW .......... 18 C backpressure:
Barometric pressure pbar........................ 1,013 mbar
Exhaust gas backpressure By means of equations [7] and [8]:
at specified MCR pM.......................... 300 mm WC
Mamb% = 0.41 x (20 25) + 0.03 x (1,013 1,000)
a) Correction for choice of specified MCR point M + 0.19 x (18 25) 0.011 x (300 300)%
and optmising point O:
Mamb% = + 1.11%
16,677
PM% = _____
19,620

x 100 = 85.0%
Tamb = 1.6 x (20 25) 0.01 x (1,013 1,000)
nM% = ___
81.9
91.9 x 100 = 90.0%
+ 0.1 x (18 25) + 0.05 x (300 300) C

Tamb = 8.8 C
By means of Figs. 6.04.07 and 6.04.08:
c) Correction for the engine load:
mM% = + 0.25%
TM = 7.2 C Service rating = 80% of specified MCR power
By means of Figs. 6.04.11 and 6.04.12:
As the engine is optmised in O lower than 100% M,
and PO% = 100.0% of PM mS% = + 7.1%

we get by means of equation [6] TS = 18.8 C

TO = 0.3 x (100 100.0) = 0.0 C

MAN B&W S70MC-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 72 20-1.0
MAN B&W 6.04
Page 12 of 12
Final calculation Exhaust gas data at specified MCR (ISO)
By means of equations [4] and [5], the final result is At specified MCR (M), the running point may be in
found taking the exhaust gas flow ML1 and tempera- equations [4] and [5] considered as a service point
ture TL1 from the List of Capacities: where PS% = 100, ms% = 0.0 and Ts = 0.0.

ML1 = 175,800 kg/h For ISO ambient reference conditions where


Mamb% = 0.0 and Tamb = 0.0, the corresponding
16,677
Mexh = 175,800 x _____
19,620x (1 + ____
+0.25
100
) x

calculations will be as follows:
16,677
(1 + ___
1.11
100 ) x (1 + ___

7.1) x ___
100 100
80
= 129,776 kg/h
Mexh,M = 175,800 x _____
19,620x (1 + ____
+0.25
100
) x (1 + ___


0.0
100
)

Mexh = 129,800 kg/h 5% x (1 + ___


0.0
100
) x ____

100.0
100
= 149,804 kg/h

Mexh,M = 149,800 kg/h 5%


The exhaust gas temperature
Texh,M = 245 7.2 0.0 + 0 + 0 = 237.8 C
TL1 = 245 C
Texh,M = 237.8 C 15 C
Texh = 245 7.2 0.0 8.8 18.8 = 210.2 C
The air consumption will be:
Texh = 210.2 C 15 C
149,804 x 0.982 kg/h = 147,107 kg/h <=>
147,107/3,600 kg/s = 40.9 kg/s

MAN B&W S70MC-C8-TII


MAN Diesel 198 72 20-1.0
MAN B&W

Fuel

7
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 7.01
Page 1 of 3

Pressurised Fuel Oil System

The system is so arranged that both diesel oil and If the fuel oil pipe X at inlet to engine is made as
heavy fuel oil can be used, see figure 7.01.01. a straight line immediately at the end of the en-
gine, it will be necessary to mount an expansion
From the service tank the fuel is led to an electri- joint. If the connection is made as indicated, with
cally driven supply pump by means of which a a bend immediately at the end of the engine, no
pressure of approximately 4 bar can be main- expansion joint is required.
tained in the low pressure part of the fuel circulat-
ing system, thus avoiding gasification of the fuel in
the venting box in the temperature ranges applied. Fuel Pumps and Drain

The venting box is connected to the service tank The introduction of the pump sealing arrange-
via an automatic deaerating valve, which will re- ment, the so-called umbrella type, has made it
lease any gases present, but will retain liquids. possible to omit the separate camshaft lubricating
oil system.
From the low pressure part of the fuel system the
fuel oil is led to an electricallydriven circulating The umbrella type fuel oil pump has an additional
pump, which pumps the fuel oil through a heater external leakage rate of clean fuel oil which,
and a full flow filter situated immediately before through AD, is led to a tank and can be pumped
the inlet to the engine. to the heavy fuel oil service tank or settling tank.
The flow rate is approx. 1.25 litres/cyl. h.
An in-line viscocity regulator located after the
heater controls the heating temperature according This drained clean oil will, of course, influence the
to the prescribed viscosity of the specific fuel oil. measured SFOC, but the oil is thus not wasted,
and the quantity is well within the measuring ac-
curacy of the flowmeters normally used.
Design parameters
The main purpose of the drain AF is to collect
To ensure ample filling of the fuel injection pumps, pure fuel oil from the fuel pumps as well as the
the capacity of the electricallydriven circulating unintentional leakage from the high pressure
pump is higher than the amount of fuel consumed pipes. The drain oil is lead to a tank and can be
by the diesel engine. Surplus fuel oil is recircu- pumped to the Heavy Fuel Oil service tank or to
lated from the engine through the venting box. the settling tank.

To ensure a constant fuel pressure to the fuel The AF drain is provided with a box for giving
injection pumps during all engine loads, a spring alarm in case of leakage in a high pressure pipes.
loaded overflow valve is inserted in the fuel oil
system on the engine. The size of the sludge tank is determined on the
basis of the draining intervals, the classification
The fuel oil pressure measured on the engine (at society rules, and on whether it may be vented
fuel pump level) should be 78 bar, equivalent to a directly to the engine room.
circulating pump pressure of 10 bar.
Drains AD and AF are shown in Fig. 7.03.01.
The builton overflow valves, if any, at the supply
pumps are to be adjusted to 5 bar, whereas the The main components of the pressurised fuel oil
external bypass valve is adjusted to 4 bar. The system are further explained in section 7.05.
pipes between the tanks and the supply pumps
shall have minimum 50% larger passage area than
the pipe between the supply pump and the circu-
lating pump.

MAN B&W K98MC, K98MCC, S90MC-C, K90MC-C,


S80MC, S80MC-C, K80MC-C, S70MC, S/L70MC-C,
S60MC, S/L60MC-C, S50MC
MAN Diesel 198 56 39-7.1
MAN B&W 7.01
Page 2 of 3

Fuel Oil System

From centrifuges # )

Aut. deaerating valve


Deck

Venting tank
Arr. of main engine fuel oil system.
(See Fig. 7.03.01)
Top of fuel oil service tank Diesel
Heavy fuel oil oil
service tank service
AD F tank
AF If the fuel oil pipe to engine is made as a straight line D* )
immediately before the engine, it will be necessary to
X mount an expansion unit. If the connection is made
BD as indicated, with a bend immediately before the
No valve in drain pipe engine, no expansion unit is required.
between engine and tank D* )
TE 8005 PT 8002
32 mm Nominal bore
PI PI TI TI Overflow valve
To HFO settling tank Adjusted to 4 bar
a) b)
Fuel oil
drain tank a)
overflow tank To jacket water d* )
Heater Circulating pumps Supply pumps
cooling pump
VT 8004
To sludge tank
Full flow filter.
For filter type see engine spec.

#) Approximately the following quantity of fuel oil should be treated in


the centrifuges: 0.23 l/kwh as explained in Section 7.05. The capacity of
the centrifuges to be according to manufacturers recommendation.

* ) D to have min. 50% larger passage area than d.

078 70 37-2.3.0

Diesel oil
Heavy fuel oil
Heated pipe with insulation
a) Tracing fuel oil lines: Max.150 C
b) Tracing drain lines: By jacket cooling water

The letters refer to the list of Counterflanges

Fig. 7.01.01: Fuel oil system

MAN B&W K98MC, K98MCC, S90MC-C, K90MC-C,


S80MC, S80MC-C, K80MC-C, S70MC, S/L70MC-C,
S60MC, S/L60MC-C, S50MC
MAN Diesel 198 56 39-7.2
MAN B&W 7.01
Page 3 of 3

Fuel Considerations

When the engine is stopped, the circulating Heating of fuel drain pipe
pump will continue to circulate heated heavy fuel
through the fuel oil system on the engine, thereby Owing to the relatively high viscosity of the heavy
keeping the fuel pumps heated and the fuel valves fuel oil, it is recommended that the drain pipe and
deaerated. This automatic circulation of preheated the fuel oil drain tank are heated to min. 50 C, but
fuel during engine standstill is the background max. 100 C.
for our recommendation: constant operation on
heavy fuel. The drain pipe between engine and tank can
be heated by the jacket water, as shown in Fig.
In addition, if this recommendation was not fol- 7.01.01 Fuel pipe heating as flange BD.
lowed, there would be a latent risk of diesel oil and
heavy fuels of marginal quality forming incompat-
ible blends during fuel change over or when oper- Fuel flow velocity and viscosity
ating in areas with restrictions on sulpher content
in fuel oil due to exhaust gas emission control. For external pipe connections, we prescribe the
following maximum flow velocities:
In special circumstances a changeover to diesel
oil may become necessary and this can be per- Marine diesel oil........................................... 1.0 m/s
formed at any time, even when the engine is not Heavy fuel oil . ............................................. 0.6 m/s
running. Such a changeover may become neces-
sary if, for instance, the vessel is expected to be The fuel viscosity is influenced by factors such
inactive for a prolonged period with cold engine as emulsification of water into the fuel for reduc-
e.g. due to: ing the NOx emission. This is further described in
Section 7.06.
docking
stop for more than five days An emulsification arrangement for the main engine
major repairs of the fuel system, etc. is described in our publication:

Exhaust Gas Emission Control Today and


Tomorrow

Further information about fuel oil specifications is


available in our publication:

Guidelines for Fuels and Lubes Purchasing

The publications are available at www.mandiesel-


turbo.com under Products Marine Engines &
Systems Low Speed Technical Papers.

MAN B&W K98MC, K98MCC, S90MC-C, K90MC-C,


S80MC, S80MC-C, K80MC-C, S70MC, S/L70MC-C,
S60MC, S/L60MC-C, S50MC, S50MC-C, S46MC-C
MAN Diesel 198 67 78-0.2
MAN B&W 7.02
Page 1 of 1

Fuel Oils

Marine diesel oil: Guiding heavy fuel oil specification

Marine diesel oil ISO 8217, Class DMB Based on our general service experience we have,
British Standard 6843, Class DMB as a supplement to the above mentioned stand-
Similar oils may also be used ards, drawn up the guiding HFO specification
shown below.

Heavy fuel oil (HFO) Heavy fuel oils limited by this specification have,
to the extent of the commercial availability, been
Most commercially available HFO with a viscosity used with satisfactory results on MAN B&W
below 700 cSt at 50 C (7,000 sec. Redwood I at twostroke low speed diesel engines.
100 F) can be used.
The data refers to the fuel as supplied i.e. before
For guidance on purchase, reference is made any on-board cleaning.
to ISO 8217:1996 and ISO 8217:2005, British
Standard 6843 and to CIMAC recommendations Guiding specification (maximum values)
regarding requirements for heavy fuel for diesel
engines, fourth edition 2003, in which the maxi-
Density at 15 C kg/m3 < 1.010*
mum acceptable grades are RMH 700 and RMK Kinematic viscosity
700. The abovementioned ISO and BS standards at 100 C cSt < 55
supersede BSMA 100 in which the limit was M9.
at 50 C cSt < 700

The data in the above HFO standards and speci- Flash point C > 60
fications refer to fuel as delivered to the ship, i.e. Pour point C < 30
before on-board cleaning. Carbon residue % (m/m) < 22
Ash % (m/m) <0.15
In order to ensure effective and sufficient cleaning
of the HFO, i.e. removal of water and solid con- Total sediment potential % (m/m) <0.10
taminants, the fuel oil specific gravity at 15 C (60 Water % (v/v) < 0.5
F) should be below 0.991, unless modern types Sulphur % (m/m) < 4.5
of centrifuges with adequate cleaning abilities are
Vanadium mg/kg < 600
used.
Aluminum + Silicon mg/kg < 80
Higher densities can be allowed if special treat- Equal to ISO 8217:2005 - RMK 700
ment systems are installed. / CIMAC recommendation No. 21 - K700
* Provided automatic clarifiers are installed
Current analysis information is not sufficient for
m/m = mass v/v = volume
estimating the combustion properties of the oil.
This means that service results depend on oil
properties which cannot be known beforehand. If heavy fuel oils with analysis data exceeding the
This especially applies to the tendency of the oil above figures are to be used, especially with re-
to form deposits in combustion chambers, gas gard to viscosity and specific gravity, the engine
passages and turbines. It may, therefore, be nec- builder should be contacted for advice regarding
essary to rule out some oils that cause difficulties. possible fuel oil system changes.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 80-4.5
MAN B&W 7.03
Page  of 1

Fuel Oil Pipes and Drain Pipes

3-## 3-#-## +-#-## +-## +-##


3-# 3,-##

#YL #YL
&UEL &UEL
VALVE VALVE

(IGHPRESSURE (IGHPRESSURE
PIPES PIPES

&UEL &UEL
& PUMP PUMP

4%) 4) 4%) 4)

178 57 51-5.0

Fig. 7.03.01: Fuel oil pipes

3,-## +-#-## 3-## +-#-## 3-#


+-## 3-#

#YL #YL #YL

#YL 3HOCK
,UBR ABSORBER
"YPASSVALVE


04)!,

0) ,OCALOPERATIONPANEL
,3!(
0)
$RAINBOXWITH
LEAKAGEALARM

!&


3-##ONLY !$ 4OSLUDGETANK

178 57 52-7.0
The letters refer to list of Counterflanges
The item Nos refer to Guidance values automation

Fig. 7.03.02: Fuel oil drain pipes

MAN B&W K98MC6/7, K98MC-C6/7, S90MC-C7/8,


K90MC-C6, S80MC6, S80MC-C7/8, K80MC-C6, S70MC6,
S/L70MC-C7/8, S60MC6, S/L60MC-C7/8, S50MC6
MAN Diesel 198 59 05-7.0
MAN B&W 7.03
Page  of 1

Fuel Oil Pipes and Drain Pipes

&ORE !FT
&UELVALVES

3HIPYARD 3UPPLIED
SUPPLY WITHENGINE

,3!(

,EAKAGEALARM
,EAKAGE &UELOIL
(0PIPES OUTLETUMBRELLA

&UELPUMPWITH /RIFICE
PUNCTUREVALVE
&UELOIL
$RAINPUMPFOOT RETURNPIPE "ASEPLATE

3HOCK
ABSORBER

8
#HECKINGOFTHE
SHOCKABSORBER
CONDITION
&
4) 0)
#OUNTERPRESSUREVALVE 4OSLUDGETANK
4OSLUDGE 4%) 04)!,
#LEAN(&/RETURN !%
TO(&/SERVICETANK TANK
ORSETTLINGTANK !& !%

178 38 33-2.4

Fig. 7.03.01: Fuel oil and drain pipes, standard fuel pump

&ORE !FT
&UELVALVES

3HIPYARD 3UPPLIED
SUPPLY WITHENGINE

,3!(

,EAKAGEALARM
,EAKAGE
(0PIPES
3HOCKABSORBER
$RAINPUMPHOUSING
&UELOIL
RETURNPIPE $RAINPUMPFOOT

&UELOIL "ASEPLATE
/RIFICE OUTLETUMBRELLA

#OUNTER
8 PRESSURE
VALVE
&
&UELPUMPWITH
PUNCTUREVALVE 4) 0)
4OSLUDGETANK
6)4TYPE
4OSLUDGE 4%) 04)!,
#LEAN(&/RETURN !%
TO(&/SERVICETANK TANK
ORSETTLINGTANK !& !%
178 57 54-0.0
The letters refer to list of Counterflanges
The item No. refer to Guidance values automation

Fig. 7.03.01: Fuel oil and drain pipes for S50MC-C7/8 with VIT type fuel pump, option: 4 35 104

MAN B&W S50MC-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 56 40-7.0
MAN B&W 7.04
Page  of 3

Fuel Oil Pipe Insulation

Insulation of fuel oil pipes and fuel oil drain pipes Flanges and valves
should not be carried out until the piping systems
have been subjected to the pressure tests speci- The flanges and valves are to be insulated by
fied and approved by the respective classification means of removable pads. Flange and valve pads
society and/or authorities, Fig. 7.04.01. are made of glass cloth, minimum 400 g/m2,
containing mineral wool stuffed to minimum 150
The directions mentioned below include insulation kg/m3.
of hot pipes, flanges and valves with a surface
temperature of the complete insulation of maxi- Thickness of the pads to be:
mum 55 C at a room temperature of maximum 38 Fuel oil pipes................................................. 20 mm
C. As for the choice of material and, if required, Fuel oil pipes and heating pipes together..... 30 mm
approval for the specific purpose, reference is
made to the respective classification society. The pads are to be fitted so that they lap over the
pipe insulating material by the pad thickness. At
flanged joints, insulating material on pipes should
Fuel oil pipes not be fitted closer than corresponding to the
minimum bolt length.
The pipes are to be insulated with 20 mm mineral
wool of minimum 150 kg/m3 and covered with
glass cloth of minimum 400 g/m2. Mounting

Mounting of the insulation is to be carried out in


Fuel oil pipes and heating pipes together accordance with the suppliers instructions.

Two or more pipes can be insulated with 30 mm


wired mats of mineral wool of minimum 150 kg/m3
covered with glass cloth of minimum 400 g/m2.
!!
""
&ORE &UELOILINLET
! #YL "
%
&UNNELAND
8 & PIPEMM
NOTTOBEINSULATED &UELOILDRAIN
"& "8 ! " UMBRELLA
$RAINPIPEFUELOIL
&UELOILOUTLET

!!

&UELOILINLET

(EATINGPIPE

% &UELOILOUTLET

3EENFROMCYLSIDE
(EATINGPIPE
#YL &ORE

!$
!&
"$

Fig. 7.04.01: Details of fuel oil pipes insulation, option: 4 35 121. Example from 98-50 MC engine 178 50 65 0.2

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B engines,


Engine Selection Guide MAN Diesel 198 40 518.3
MAN B&W 7.04
Page  of 3

Heat Loss in Piping

Temperature difference between pipe and room


C

20

30
s
es

40
kn
ic

50
th
n

60
tio

su 70 0
la

In 8 0
9 0
10 0
12
0
16
0
20

Heat loss watt/meter pipe


Pipe diameter mm
178 50 602.0

Fig. 7.04.02: Heat loss/Pipe cover

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B engines,


Engine Selection Guide MAN Diesel 198 40 518.3
MAN B&W 7.04
Page 3 of 3

Fuel Oil Pipe Heat Tracing

The steam tracing of the fuel oil pipes is intended 2. When the circulation pump is stopped with
to operate in two situations: heavy fuel oil in the piping and the pipes have
cooled down to engine room temperature, as
1. When the circulation pump is running, there it is not possible to pump the heavy fuel oil.
will be a temperature loss in the piping, see In this situation the fuel oil must be heated to
Fig. 7.04.02. This loss is very small, therefore pumping temperature of about 50 C.
tracing in this situation is only necessary with
very long fuel supply lines. To heat the pipe to pumping level we recom-
mend to use 100 watt leaking/meter pipe.

Fresh cooling
L
Cyl. 1 water outlet

Fuel valve

Shock absorber Drain cyl. frame

See drawing
Fuel pump
Fuel oil pipes insulation

F
BX

AF
AD
BD
X
BF

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


178 50 625.0

Fig. 7.04.03: Fuel oil pipe heat tracing

Fuel Oil and Lubricating Oil Pipe Spray Shields

In order to fulfil IMO regulations, fuel oil and lubri- To avoid leaks, the spray shields are to be in-
cating oil pipe assemblies are to be enclosed by stalled after pressure testing of the pipe system.
spray shields as shown in Fig. 7.04.04a and b.

Antisplashing tape Clamping bands

Overlap

The tape is to be wrapped in accordance with Plate 0,5 mm. thickness The width is to cover
the makers instruction for class approval head of bolts and nuts

178 52 555.2

Fig. 7.04.04a: Spray Shields by anti-splashing tape Fig. 7.04.04b: Spray Shields by clamping bands

MAN B&W K98MC/MCC, K98ME/ME-C, S90MC-C, S90ME-C,


K90MC-C, K90ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C, S80ME-C, K80MC-C,
K80ME-C, S70MC, S/L70MC-C, S/L70ME-C, S70ME-GI, S65ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 67 68-4.1

S60MC, S/L60MC-C, S/L60ME-C, S60ME-B, S60ME-GI, S50MC,


Engine Selection Guide
MAN B&W 7.04
Page  of 3

Fuel Oil Pipe Heat Tracing

The steam tracing of the fuel oil pipes is intended 2. When the circulation pump is stopped with
to operate in two situations: heavy fuel oil in the piping and the pipes have
cooled down to engine room temperature, as
1. When the circulation pump is running, there it is not possible to pump the heavy fuel oil.
will be a temperature loss in the piping, see In this situation the fuel oil must be heated to
Fig. 7.04.02. This loss is very small, therefore pumping temperature of about 50 C.
tracing in this situation is only necessary with
very long fuel supply lines. To heat the pipe to pumping level we recom-
mend to use 100 watt leaking/meter pipe.

&ORE !FT

&ROMFRESHCOOLING
WATEROUTLET

!&
"$

"8
8

&
"&

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges 183 15 33-1.2.0a

Fig. 7.04.03: Fuel oil pipe heat tracing

Fuel Oil and Lubricating Oil Pipe Spray Shields

In order to fulfil IMO regulations, fuel oil and lubri- To avoid leaks, the spray shields are to be in-
cating oil pipe assemblies are to be enclosed by stalled after pressure testing of the pipe system.
spray shields as shown in Fig. 7.04.04a and b.

!NTISPLASHINGTAPE #LAMPINGBANDS

/VERLAP

4HETAPEISTOBEWRAPPEDINACCORDANCEWITH 0LATE MMTHICKNESS 4HEWIDTHISTOCOVER


THEMAKERSINSTRUCTIONFORCLASSAPPROVAL HEADOFBOLTSANDNUTS

178 52 555.2

Fig. 7.04.04a: Spray Shields by anti-splashing tape Fig. 7.04.04b: Spray Shields by clamping bands

MAN B&W S50MC-C7/8, S50ME-C7/8, S46MC-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 67 69-6.0
MAN B&W 7.05
Page 1 of 3

Components for Fuel Oil System

Fuel oil centrifuges If it is decided after all to install an individual puri-


fier for MDO on board, the capacity should be
The manual cleaning type of centrifuges are not to based on the above recommendation, or it should
be recommended, neither for attended machinery be a centrifuge of the same size as that for HFO.
spaces (AMS) nor for unattended machinery spac-
es (UMS). Centrifuges must be selfcleaning, either The Nominal MCR is used to determine the to-
with total discharge or with partial discharge. tal installed capacity. Any derating can be taken
into consideration in borderline cases where the
Distinction must be made between installations for: centrifuge that is one step smaller is able to cover
Specified MCR.
Specific gravities < 0.991 (corresponding to ISO
8217 and British Standard 6843 from RMA to
RMH, and CIMAC from A to Hgrades Fuel oil supply pump

Specific gravities > 0.991 and (corresponding to This is to be of the screw or gear wheel type.
CIMAC Kgrades).
Fuel oil viscosity, specified..... up to 700 cSt at 50 C
For the latter specific gravities, the manufacturers Fuel oil viscosity maximum........................1000 cSt
have developed special types of centrifuges, e.g.: Pump head.......................................................4 bar
Fuel oil flow......................... see List of Capacities
Alfa Laval.........................................................Alcap Delivery pressure.............................................4 bar
Westfalia........................................................ Unitrol Working temperature.................................... 100 C
Mitsubishi............................................... EHidens II Minimum temperature..................................... 50 C

The centrifuge should be able to treat approxi- The capacity stated in List of Capacities is to be ful-
mately the following quantity of oil: filled with a tolerance of: 0% to +15% and shall also
be able to cover the backflushing, see Fuel oil filter.
0.23 litres/kWh

This figure includes a margin for: Fuel oil circulating pump

Water content in fuel oil This is to be of the screw or gear wheel type.
Possible sludge, ash and other impurities in the
fuel oil Fuel oil viscosity, specified..... up to 700 cSt at 50 C
Increased fuel oil consumption, in connection Fuel oil viscosity normal.................................20 cSt
with other conditions than ISO standard condi- Fuel oil viscosity maximum........................1000 cSt
tion Fuel oil flow......................... see List of Capacities
Purifier service for cleaning and maintenance. Pump head.......................................................6 bar
Delivery pressure........................................... 10 bar
The size of the centrifuge has to be chosen ac- Working temperature.................................... 150 C
cording to the suppliers table valid for the select-
ed viscosity of the Heavy Fuel Oil. Normally, two The capacity stated in List of Capacities is to be ful-
centrifuges are installed for Heavy Fuel Oil (HFO), filled with a tolerance of: 0% to +15% and shall also
each with adequate capacity to comply with the be able to cover the backflushing, see Fuel oil filter.
above recommendation.
Pump head is based on a total pressure drop in
A centrifuge for Marine Diesel Oil (MDO) is not a filter and preheater of maximum 1.5 bar.
must. However, MAN Diesel recommends that at
least one of the HFO purifiers can also treat MDO.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 39 512.6
MAN B&W 7.05
Page 2 of 3

Fuel Oil Heater

The heater is to be of the tube or plate heat ex- Fuel oil viscosity specified.... up to 700 cSt at 50C
changer type. Fuel oil flow..................................... see capacity of
fuel oil circulating pump
The required heating temperature for different oil Heat dissipation.................. see List of Capacities
viscosities will appear from the Fuel oil heating Pressure drop on fuel oil side.........maximum 1 bar
chart, Fig. 7.05.01. The chart is based on informa- Working pressure........................................... 10 bar
tion from oil suppliers regarding typical marine Fuel oil inlet temperature..................approx. 100 C
fuels with viscosity index 7080. Fuel oil outlet temperature............................ 150 C
Steam supply, saturated...........................7 bar abs
Since the viscosity after the heater is the control-
led parameter, the heating temperature may vary, To maintain a correct and constant viscosity of
depending on the viscosity and viscosity index of the fuel oil at the inlet to the main engine, the
the fuel. steam supply shall be automatically controlled,
usually based on a pneumatic or an electrically
Recommended viscosity meter setting is 1015 cSt. controlled system.

Approximate viscosity
after heater

Temperature cSt. sec.


after heater Rw.

C
7 43

170
Normal heating limit 10 52
160
12 59
150
15 69
140
20 87
130

120
30 125
110

100

90

80

70

60
Approximate pumping limit
50

40

30
10 15 25 35 45 55 cST/100C
30 60 100 180 380 600 cST/50C
200 400 800 1500 3500 6000 sec.Rw/100 F

178 06 280.1

Fig. 7.05.01: Fuel oil heating chart

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 39 512.6
MAN B&W 7.05
Page  of 3

Fuel oil filter Fuel oil venting box

The filter can be of the manually cleaned duplex The design of the Fuel oil venting box is shown in
type or an automatic filter with a manually cleaned Fig. 7.05.02. The size is chosen according to the
bypass filter. maximum flow of the fuel oil circulation pump,
which is listed in section 6.03.
If a double filter (duplex) is installed, it should
have sufficient capacity to allow the specified full 6ENTPIPE
NOMINAL$
amount of oil to flow through each side of the filter
at a given working temperature with a max. 0.3
bar pressure drop across the filter (clean filter). #ONE

(

If a filter with backflushing arrangement is
installed, the following should be noted. The re-
quired oil flow specified in the List of capacities,


i.e. the delivery rate of the fuel oil supply pump and
the fuel oil circulating pump, should be increased
by the amount of oil used for the backflushing, so 4OPOFFUELOIL
SERVICETANK
that the fuel oil pressure at the inlet to the main en-
(

gine can be maintained during cleaning. )NLETPIPE


NOMINAL$
(

In those cases where an automatically cleaned

(
filter is installed, it should be noted that in order
to activate the cleaning process, certain makers of
filters require a greater oil pressure at the inlet to
the filter than the pump pressure specified. There- 0IPE
NOMINAL$
fore, the pump capacity should be adequate for
this purpose, too.
(

The fuel oil filter should be based on heavy fuel oil /UTLETPIPE
NOMINAL$
of: 130 cSt at 80 C = 700 cSt at 50 C = 7000 sec
178 38 393.3
Redwood I/100 F.
Flow m3/h Dimensions in mm
Fuel oil flow.......................... see List of capacities Q (max.)* D1 D2 D3 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5
Working pressure........................................... 10 bar 1.3 150 32 15 100 600 171.3 1,000 550
Test pressure....................... according to class rule 2.1 150 40 15 100 600 171.3 1,000 550
Absolute fineness........................................... 50 m 5.0 200 65 15 100 600 171.3 1,000 550
Working temperature................... maximum 150 C 8.4 400 80 15 150 1,200 333.5 1,800 1,100
Oil viscosity at working temperature.............15 cSt 11.5 400 90 15 150 1,200 333.5 1,800 1,100
Pressure drop at clean filter.........maximum 0.3 bar 19.5 400 125 15 150 1,200 333.5 1,800 1,100
29.4 500 150 15 150 1,500 402.4 2,150 1,350
Filter to be cleaned at a pressure
43.0 500 200 15 150 1,500 402.4 2,150 1,350
drop of . .......................................maximum 0.5 bar
* The maximum flow of the fuel oil circulation pump

Note: Fig. 07.05.02: Fuel oil venting box


Absolute fineness corresponds to a nominal fine-
ness of approximately 35 m at a retaining rate of
90%. Flushing of the fuel oil system

The filter housing shall be fitted with a steam jack- Before starting the engine for the first time, the
et for heat tracing. system on board has to be flushed in accordance
with MAN Diesels recommendations Flushing of
Fuel Oil System which is available on request.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B engines,


MC/ME Engine selection guides MAN Diesel 198 47 35-0.2
MAN B&W 7.06
Page 1 of 2

Water In Fuel Emulsification

The emulsification of water into the fuel oil reduc- Safety system
es the NOx emission with about 1% per 1% water
added to the fuel up to about 20% without modifi- In case the pressure in the fuel oil line drops, the
cation of the engine fuel injection equipment. water homogenised into the Water In Fuel emul-
sion will evaporate, damaging the emulsion and
A Water In Fuel emulsion (WIF) mixed for this pur- creating supply problems. This situation is avoid-
pose and based on Heavy Fuel Oil (HFO) is stable ed by installing a third, air driven supply pump,
for a long time, whereas a WIF based on Marine which keeps the pressure as long as air is left in
Diesel Oil is only stable for a short period of time the tank S, see Fig. 7.06.01.
unless an emulsifying agent is applied.
Before the tank S is empty, an alarm is given and
As both the MAN B&W twostroke main engine the drain valve is opened, which will drain off the
and the MAN Diesel GenSets are designed to run WIF and replace it with HFO or diesel oil from the
on emulsified HFO, it can be used for a common service tank.
system.
The drain system is kept at atmospheric pressure,
It is supposed below, that both the main engine so the water will evaporate when the hot emulsion
and GenSets are running on the same fuel, either enters the safety tank. The safety tank shall be
HFO or a homogenised HFO-based WIF. designed accordingly.

Special arrangements are available on request for Impact on the auxiliary systems
a more sophisticated system in which the GenSets
can run with or without a homogenised HFO- Please note that if the engine operates on Water
based WIF, if the main engine is running on that. In Fuel emulsion (WIF), in order to reduce the NOx
emission, the exhaust gas temperature will de-
Please note that the fuel pump injection capacity crease due to the reduced air / exhaust gas ratio
shall be confirmed for the main engine as well as and the increased specific heat of the exhaust gas.
the GenSets for the selected percentage of water
in the WIF. Depending on the water content, this will have an
impact on the calculation and design of the fol-
lowing items:
Temperature and pressure Freshwater generators
Energy for production of freshwater
When water is added by emulsification, the fuel Jacket water system
viscosity increases. In order to keep the injection Waste heat recovery system
viscosity at 10-15 cSt and still be able to operate Exhaust gas boiler
on up to 700 cSt fuel oil, the heating temperature Storage tank for freshwater
has to be increased to about 170 C depending on
the water content. For further information about emulsification of wa-
ter into the fuel and use of Water In Fuel emulsion
The higher temperature calls for a higher pressure (WIF), please refer to our publication titled:
to prevent cavitation and steam formation in the
system. The inlet pressure is thus set to 13 bar. Exhaust Gas Emission Control Today and
Tomorrow
In order to avoid temperature chock when mixing
water into the fuel in the homogeniser, the water The publication is available at
inlet temperature is to be set to 7090 C. www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
Technical Papers.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/MEB/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 828.4
MAN B&W 7.06
Page 2 of 2

From
centrifuges Deck

Automatic
To special deaerating Deaerating to be
safety tank valve controlled against
expansion of water
Venting box

Diesel BX F
Heavy fuel oil
oil service
service tank
tank
X

To HFO BF AD
F. O. special service or
safety tank AF BD
settling tank

Common fuel oil supply unit 32 mm


Nom.
Overflow valve bore
adjusted to b)
12 bar Full flow a)
Homogeniser filter Main engine
Supply pumps
Water in oil F.O.
measuring drain
Filter
Booster tank
pump To HFO service
or settling tank

Circulating Heater
Fresh water
Compressed pumps
supply
air
S Safety pump
Supply air tank air operated

A2 A2 A2
A1 A1 A1
A3 A3 A3
GenSet GenSet GenSet

Fuel oil
To HFO service sludge tank To freshwater cooling
or settling tank pump suction

Diesel oil Number of auxiliary engines, pumps, coolers, etc.


Heavy fuel oil are subject to alterations according to the actual
Heated pipe with insulation plant specification.

a) Tracing fuel oil lines: Max. 150 C The letters refer to the list of Counterflanges.
b) Tracing fuel oil drain lines: Max. 90 C,
min. 50 C for installations with jacket cooling water
198 99 018.3

Fig. 7.06.01: System for emulsification of water into the fuel common to the main engine and MAN Diesel GenSets

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/MEB/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 828.4
MAN B&W

Lubricating Oil

8
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 8.01
Page 1 of 2

Lubricating and Cooling Oil System

The lubricating oil is pumped from a bottom tank by has a drain arrangement so that oil condensed in
means of the main lubricating oil pump to the lubri- the pipe can be led to a drain tank, see details in
cating oil cooler, a thermostatic valve and, through Fig. 8.07.01.
a fullflow filter, to the engine inlet RU, Fig. 8.01.01.
Drains from the engine bedplate AE are fitted on
RU lubricates main bearings, thrust bearing, axial both sides, see Fig. 8.07.02 Bedplate drain pipes.
vibration damper, crankpin bearings, piston cooling,
crosshead, camshaft and turbocharger bearings. For external pipe connections, we prescribe a
maximum oil velocity of 1.8 m/s.
The main lube oil system is common to the cam-
shaft as well. The major part of the oil is divided
between piston cooling and crosshead lubrication. Lubrication of turbochargers

From the engine, the oil collects in the oil pan, Turbochargers with slide bearings are normally
from where it is drained off to the bottom tank, see lubricated from the main engine system. AB is
Fig. 8.06.01a and b Lubricating oil tank, with cof- outlet from the turbocharger, see Figs. 8.03.01 to
ferdam. By class demand, a cofferdam must be 8.03.03, which are shown with sensors for UMS.
placed underneath the lubricating oil tank.
Figs. 8.03.01 to 8.03.03 show the lube oil pipe ar-
The engine crankcase is vented through AR by a rangements for different turbocharger makes.
pipe which extends directly to the deck. This pipe

Deck

Engine
oil

To drain tank
*
Min. 15

Thermostatic valve Pos. 005: throttle valve


E
TI TI TI PI PI RU

AR
Feeler, 45 C Fullflow filter AB

Lube. oil
Deaeration
cooler

S S

For initial fillling of pumps


Lube oil bottom tank
Pos. 006: 25 mm valve with cofferdam
for cleaning process From purifier To purifier
Lube oil pumps

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


* Venting for MAN Diesel or Mitsubishi turbochargers only
178 57 55-2.2

Fig. 8.01.01 Lubricating and cooling oil system

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 56 36-1.1
MAN B&W 8.01
Page  of 2

Lubricating and Cooling Oil Pipes

4OCAMSHAFTANDEXHVALVEACTUATOR
!FT &ORE
#ONNECTEDTOCYLFRAME #ROSSHEADBEARINGSPISTON
4) &3!,9
4%)!(9 4%)!(
43: 4) 3TARTINGAIRDISTRIBUTOR

,UBRICATORDRIVE !2 -AINBEARINGS
ONLYFOR(*LUBRICATOR
4HRUSTBEARING !XIALVIBRATIONDAMPER
3
&UELPUMP 74)!(9
/NLY ,3-#-##
%XHAUSTVALVE /NLY +,3-#-##
ACTUATOR

4ONDORDERMOMENT
COMPENSATORFOREEND
3YSTEMOILOUTLET
4%)!( IFMOUNTED

4)
/NLYFOR+-#-##
3YSTEMOILINTLET 4OCHAINDRIVE

25

0) ,UBROILTOTURBOCHARGER

04)!,9

03:
178 24 41-9.1

Fig. 8.01.02 Lubricating and Cooling Oil Pipes on engine

MAN B&W K98MC6/7, K98MC-C6/7, S90MC-C7/8,


K90MC-C6, S80MC6, S80MC-C7/8, K80MC-C6 MAN Diesel 198 59 09-4.0
MAN B&W 8.01
Page  of 2

Lubricating and Cooling Oil Pipes

!FT #AMSHAFTANDEXHAUSTVALVEACTUATORLUBROILSYSTEM &ORE

4)
&UELPUMP -AINBEARINGS
4%)!(9
43: !XIALVIBRATIONDAMPER
#ROSSHEADBEARINGSPISTON
4HRUSTBEARING !6$3EPERATEINLETINCASEOF
!2 HEADERTANK
#ONNECTEDTOFRAMEBOX
7)
%XHAUSTVALVEACTUATOR 74)!(9
/NLY ,3-#-##
3

#HAINDRIVE 3YSTEMOILOUTLET
4ONDORDERMOMENTCOMPENSATOR
&3!,9 FOREEND IFMOUNTED

4%)!( 4)
4%)!(
4)

3YSTEMOILINLET

25

0) ,UBROILTOTURBOCHARGER

04)!,9

03:

121 00 98-3.3.0

Fig. 8.01.02 Lubricating and Cooling Oil Pipes on engine

MAN B&W S70MC6, S60MC6


MAN Diesel 198 67 29-0.0
MAN B&W 8.01
Page  of 2

Lubricating and Cooling Oil Pipes

4)
&3!,9
4%)!(9
4)
43:
4%)!(
#AMSHAFTANDEXHAUSTVALVEACTUATORLUBROILSYSTEM
!FT &ORE
3TARTINGAIR
DISTRIBUTOR
#YLLUBDRIVE-ECHANICALLUBRICATOR
-AINBEARINGS
#ROSSHEADBEARINGSPISTON

!XIALVIBRATIONDAMPER
7)

74)!(9
4HRUSTBEARING /NLY 3,-##
4OCHAINDRIVE 3

!2 4ONDORDERMOMENTCOMPENSATOR
FOREENDIFMOUNTED

3YSTEMOILOUTLET

,UBROILTOTURBOCHARGER

0)

04)!,9

03:
4%)!(!,

4)

25

121 01 00-7.0.0

Fig. 8.01.02 Lubricating and Cooling Oil Pipes on engine

MAN B&W S70MC-C7/8, L70MC-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 67 30-0.0
MAN B&W 8.01
Page  of 2

Lubricating and Cooling Oil Pipes

4)
&3!,9
4%)!(9
4)
43:
4%)!(
#AMSHAFTANDEXHAUSTVALVEACTUATORLUBROILSYSTEM
!FT &ORE
3TARTINGAIR
DISTRIBUTOR
#YLLUBDRIVE-ECHANICALLUBRICATOR
-AINBEARINGS
#ROSSHEADBEARINGSPISTON

!XIALVIBRATIONDAMPER
7)

74)!(9
4HRUSTBEARING /NLY 3,-##
4OCHAINDRIVE 3

!2 4ONDORDERMOMENTCOMPENSATOR
FOREENDIFMOUNTED

3YSTEMOILOUTLET

,UBROILTOTURBOCHARGER

0)

04)!,9

03:
4%)!(!,

4)

25

121 00 99-5.1.0

Fig. 8.01.02 Lubricating and Cooling Oil Pipes on engine

MAN B&W S60MC-C7/8, L60MC-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 67 31-2.0
MAN B&W 8.02
Page  of 1

Hydraulic power supply unit

This section is not applicable

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 56 37-3.0
MAN B&W 8.03
Page 1 of 2

Lubricating Oil Pipes for Turbochargers

From system oil

PI 8103

MAN Diesel TCA


turbocharger
TI 8117 PT 8103 I AL

TE 8117 I AH

AB

121 14 96-6.1.0

Fig. 8.03.01: MAN Diesel turbocharger type TCA

From system oil

PI 8103

PT 8103 I AL

ABB TPL TI 8117


turbocharger
TE 8117 I AH

AB

126 40 85-8.3.0

Fig. 8.03.02: ABB turbocharger type TPL

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines,


Engine Selection Guide MAN Diesel 198 42 328.3
MAN B&W 8.03
Page 2 of 2

From system oil

PI 8103
E

MET turbocharger
TI 8117

TE 8117 I AH

AB

126 40 87-1.2.0

Fig. 8.03.03: Mitsubishi turbocharger type MET

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines,


Engine Selection Guide MAN Diesel 198 42 328.3
MAN B&W 8.04
Page 1 of 1

Lubricating Oil Centrifuges and List of Lubricating Oils

For Unattended Machinery Spaces (UMS), auto-


matic centrifuges with total discharge or partial
discharge are to be used. Manual cleaning cen-
trifuges can only be used for Attended Machinery
Spaces (AMS).

The nominal capacity of the centrifuge is to be


according to the suppliers recommendation for
lubricating oil, based on the figure:

0.136 litre/kWh

The Nominal MCR is used as the total installed


power.

List of lubricating oils

The circulating oil (lubricating and cooling oil)


must be of the rust and oxidation inhibited type of
oil of SAE 30 viscosity grade.

In order to keep the crankcase and piston cooling


spaces clean of deposits, the oil should have ad-
equate dispersion and detergent properties.

Alkaline circulating oils are generally superior in


this respect.

The oils listed below have all given long-term sat-


isfactory service in MAN B&W engine installations:

Circulating oil
Company SAE 30, BN 510
BP Energol OEHT 30
Castrol CDX 30
Chevron *) Veritas 800 Marine 30
ExxonMobil Mobilgard 300
Shell Melina 30 / S 30
Total Atlanta Marine D 3005
*) Includes Caltex, Chevron and Texaco

Also other brands have been used with satisfac-


tory results.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines,


Engine Selection Guide MAN Diesel 198 38 865.6
MAN B&W 8.05
Page 1 of 1

Components for Lubricating Oil System

Lubricating oil full flow filter Flushing of lubricating oil system

Lubricating oil flow............... see List of capacities Before starting the engine for the first time, the lu-
Test pressure......................according to class rules bricating oil system on board has to be cleaned in
Working temperature.............. approximately 45 C accordance with MAN Diesels recommendations:
Oil viscosity at working temp............... 90 100 cSt Flushing of Main Lubricating Oil System, which is
Pressure drop with clean filter.....maximum 0.2 bar available on request.
Filter to be cleaned
at a pressure drop........................maximum 0.5 bar

The filter working pressure and absolute fineness


is to be found in the Project Guide for the specific
engine.

Note:
8590% of all particles bigger than 25 m are
retained in surface filter with a filter fineness of 40
m absolute, and 35 m for 50 m.

The flow capacity must be within a range from


100 to 112% of the capacity stated.

The full flow filter should be located as close as


possible to the main engine.

If a double filter (duplex) is installed, it should


have sufficient capacity to allow the specified full
amount of oil to flow through each side of the filter
at a given working temperature with a pressure
drop across the filter of maximum 0.2 bar (clean
filter).

If a filter with a backflushing arrangement is in-


stalled, the following should be noted:

The required oil flow, specified in the List of


capacities, should be increased by the amount
of oil used for the backflushing, so that the
lubricating oil pressure at the inlet to the main
engine can be maintained during cleaning.

If an automatically cleaned filter is installed, it


should be noted that in order to activate the
cleaning process, certain makes of filter require
a higher oil pressure at the inlet to the filter than
the pump pressure specified. Therefore, the
pump capacity should be adequate for this pur-
pose, too.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/-GI, ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 87-7.4
MAN B&W 8.06
Page 1 of 1

Lubricating Oil Tank

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 559.1
MAN B&W 8.07
Page 1 of 1

Crankcase Venting and Bedplate Drain Pipes

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 560.1
MAN B&W

Cylinder Lubrication

9
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 9.01
Page 1 of 1

Cylinder Lubricating Oil System

The cost of the cylinder lubricating oil is one of the Modern highrated twostroke engines have a
largest contributions to total operating costs, next relatively great demand for detergency in the cyl-
to the fuel oil cost. Another aspect is that the lu- inder oil. Therefore cylinder oils should be chosen
brication rate has a great influence on the cylinder according to the below list.
condition, and thus on the overhauling schedules
and maintenance costs. A BN 70 cylinder oil is to be used as the default
choice of oil and it may be used on all fuel types.
It is therefore of the utmost importance that the However, in case of the engine running on fuel
cylinder lubricating oil system as well as its opera- with sulphur content lower than 1.5 % for more
tion is optimised. than 1 to 2 weeks, we recommend to change to a
lower BN cylinder oil such as BN 40-50.

Cylinder lubricators and service tank The cylinder oils listed below have all given long-
term satisfactory service during heavy fuel opera-
The cylinder lubricators can be either the electronic tion in MAN B&W engine installations:
MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators or a me-
chanical type driven by the engine. Basic design is Company Cylinder oil Cylinder oil
MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators, EoD: 4 42 SAE 50, BN 60-80 SAE 50, BN 40-50
104. The options are listed in the Extent of Delivery. BP Energol CLO 50 M Energol CL 505
Energol CL 605 Energol CL-DX 405
The cylinder lube oil is supplied from a gravity- Castrol Cyltech 70 / 80AW Cyltech 40 SX / 50 S
feed cylinder oil service tank to where it is being Chevron *) Taro Special HT 70 Taro Special HT LS 40
pumped from the cylinder oil storage tank. The ExxonMobil Mobilgard 570 Mobilgard L540
size of the cylinder oil service tank depends on Shell Alexia 50 Alexia LS
the owners and yards requirements, and it is Total Talusia Universal Talusia LS 40
Talusia HR 70
normally dimensioned for minimum two days
consumption. *) Includes Caltex, Chevron and Texaco

The cylinder lubricating oil consumption could be Also other brands have been used with satisfac-
monitored by installing a flow meter on the pres- tory results.
sure side of the pump in the supply line to the
service tank, if required by the shipowner. Pro- Cylinder oil feed rate (dosage)
vided the oil level in the service tank is kept the
same every time the flow meter is being read, the The recommendations are valid for all plants,
accuracy is satisfactory. whether controllable pitch or fixed pitch propellers
are used.
A cylinder lubricating oil supply system for engine
plants with MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators In case of average sulphur content, the average
is shown in Fig. 9.02.02 and for plants with me- cylinder oil feed rate at all loads for MAN B&W
chanical cylinder lubricators in Fig. 9.03.03. In both Alpha Cylinder Lubricator is 0.65 g/kWh for types
cases a dual system for supply of two different BN 98-60 and 0.70 g/kWh for types 50-26. Adjustment
cylinder oils is shown. of the cylinder oil dosage of the MAN B&W Alpha
Cylinder Lubricator to the sulphur content in the
fuel being burnt is further explained in Section 9.02.
Cylinder oils
The nominal cylinder oil feed rate at nominal MCR
Cylinder oils should, preferably, be of the SAE 50 for a mechanical cylinder lubricator is typically
viscosity grade. 0.8 - 1.2 g/kWh for K/L engines and 1.0 - 1.5 g/kWh
for S engines.

MAN B&W MC Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 46-3.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page 1 of 7

MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System

The MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubrication system, System control units
see Figs. 9.02.02 and 9.02.03, is designed to sup-
ply cylinder oil intermittently, every 2 to 20 engine The cylinder lubrication system is controlled by
revolutions with electronically controlled timing the Master Control Unit (MCU) which calculates
and dosage at a defined position. the injection frequency on the basis of the engine-
speed signal given by the tacho signal (ZE) and
Cylinder lubricating oil is fed to the engine by the fuel index.
means of a pump station which as standard is
mounted on the engine, EoD: 4 42 150 (for all Lubricating control functions such as mep de-
MC/MC-C engines except S35MC7), or could pendent and load change dependent are all
be placed in the engine room, option: 4 42 152 incorporated in the MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lu-
(standard execution for S35MC7). brication system.

The pump station has two pumps (one operating, The MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricator is pre
the other stand-by with automatic start up) with ferably to be controlled in accordance with the
in-line filters and a heater, see Fig. 9.02.02. Alpha Adaptive Cylinder oil Control (Alpha ACC)
feed rate system. The Alpha ACC is explained in
The oil fed to the injectors is pressurised by the following page.
means of one or two Alpha Lubricators placed
on each cylinder and equipped with small The MCU is equipped with a Backup Control Unit
multipiston pumps, see Fig. 9.02.03. (BCU) which, if the MCU malfunctions, activates
an alarm and takes control automatically or manu-
Accumulator tanks on the lubricator inlet pipes ally, via a Switch Board Unit (SBU), Fig. 9.02.04.
ensure adequate filling of the lubricator while ac-
cumulators on the outlet pipes serve to dampen The MCU, BCU and SBU together comprise the
the pressure fluctuations. The oil pipes fitted on Alpha Cylinder Lubricator Control Unit (ALCU) in
the engine is shown in Fig. 9.02.03. shape of a single steel cabinet which is, as stand-
ard, located in the Engine Control Room. Fig.
On engines with double lubricators, a by-pass 9.02.05 shows the wiring diagram for the MAN
valve allows for circulating and heating the cyl- B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System.
inder oil before starting the engine under cold
engine room conditions. On engines with one lu- The yard supply should be according to the items
bricator per cylinder, this is done by means of the shown in Fig. 9.02.02 within the broken line.
valve on the cylinderblock intended for emptying
the accumulator.

Prior to start-up, the cylinders can be pre-lubricat-


ed and, during the runningin period, the operator
can choose to increase the lubricating oil feed
rate to a max. setting of 200%.

MAN B&W MC Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 49-9.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page 2 of 7

Alpha Adaptive Cylinder Oil Control (Alpha ACC)

It is a wellknown fact that the actual need for Basic lubricating oil setting:
cylinder oil quantity varies with the operational Bore 60 and above = 0.20 g/kWh x S%
conditions such as load and fuel oil quality. Con- Bore 50 and below = 0.26 g/kWh x S%
sequently, in order to perform the optimal lubrica- with a minimum setting of 0.60 g/kWh, i.e. the set-
tion costeffectively as well as technically the ting should be kept constant from about 3% (bore
cylinder lubricating oil dosage should follow such 60 and above) and 2.3% (bore 50 and below) sul-
operational variations accordingly. phur and downwards.

The Alpha lubricating system offers the possibility Due to the sulphur dependency, the average cyl-
of saving a considerable amount of cylinder lubri- inder oil dosages rely on the sulphur distribution
cating oil per year and, at the same time, to obtain in worldwide fuel bunkers. Based on deliveries all
a safer and more predictable cylinder condition. over the world, the resulting yearly specific cylin-
der oil dosage is close to 0.65 g/kWh (bore 60 and
The name of the algorithm which controls the above) and 0.7 g/kWh (bore 50 and above).
cylinder oil dosage proportional to the sulphur
content in the fuel is Alpha Adaptive Cylinder oil Engines with 60 cm bore and above:
Control, Alpha ACC. Absolute dosage (g/kWh)
1.40
1.30
Working principle 1.20
1.10
1.00
0.90
The basic feed rate control should be adjusted in 0.80
relation to the actual fuel quality and amount be- 0.70
0.60
ing burnt at any given time. The sulphur percent- 0.50
0.40
age is a good indicator in relation to wear, and an 0.30
0.20
oil dosage proportional to the sulphur level will 0.10

give the best overall cylinder condition. 0.00


0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4
Sulphur %

The following two criteria determine the control: 178 61 184.0

Engines with 50 cm bore and below:


The cylinder oil dosage shall be proportional to
the sulphur percentage in the fuel Absolute dosage (g/kWh)
1.40
1.30

The cylinder oil dosage shall be proportional to 1.20


1.10
the engine load (i.e. the amount of fuel entering 1.00

the cylinders). 0.90


0.80
0.70
0.60
The implementation of the above two criteria will 0.50
lead to an optimal cylinder oil dosage, proportion- 0.40
0.30
al to the amount of sulphur entering the cylinders. 0.20
0.10
0.00
Basic and minimum setting with Alpha ACC 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4
Sulphur %

178 61 196.0
The recommendations are valid for all plants,
whether controllable pitch or fixed pitch propellers Fig 9.02.01: Cylinder lubricating oil dosage with Alpha
are used. ACC at all loads (BN 70 cylinder oil) after running-in

Safe and very lubricatingeconomical control after Further information on cylinder oil as a function of
running-in is obtained with a basic setting accord- fuel oil sulphur content and alkalinity of lubricating
ing to the formula: oil is available from MAN Diesel.

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 97-7.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page  of 7

Pump Station and MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators on Engine

$ECK

3ERVICETANK 3ERVICETANK
&ILLINGPIPE FORLOW". FORHIGH". &ILLINGPIPE
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
 &LOWMETER 
&LOWMETER

& ,3 ,3 &
)NTERLOCK
MMNOMINALBORE
3TORAGETANK 3TORAGETANK
FORLOW". FORHIGH".
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
-IN MM
3HIPBUILDER

3HIPBUILDER
$. $.

  $.
!# !5


!#
 )FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDONENGINE 0UMP

)FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDINENGINEROOM STATION
 )FREQUIREDBYTHESHIPOWNER

!5
$.

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation
078 78 46-0.0.0a

Fig. 9.02.02: Cylinder lubricating oil supply system for two different BN oils

#YLINDER

:6# 3OLENOIDVALVE
,UBRICATOR !CCUMULATOR ,UBRICATOR

:4# &EEDBACKSENSOR
!CCU !CCU

#IRCULATIONVALVE

!5
!#

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges #) In case of COLD engine room conditions, open the valve
The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation to circulate and heat up the cylinder oil. The valve is then
to be closed before starting.
121 36 61-8.4.0a

Fig. 9.02.03: MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubricators with piping and instrumentation on engine

MAN B&W K98MC6/7, K98MC-C6/7,


S90MC-C7/8, K90MC-C6 MAN Diesel 198 64 17-4.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page  of 7

Pump Station and MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators on Engine

$ECK

3ERVICETANK 3ERVICETANK
&ILLINGPIPE FORLOW". FORHIGH". &ILLINGPIPE
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
 &LOWMETER 
&LOWMETER

& ,3 ,3 &
)NTERLOCK
MMNOMINALBORE
3TORAGETANK 3TORAGETANK
FORLOW". FORHIGH".
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
-IN MM
3HIPBUILDER

3HIPBUILDER
$. $.

  $.
!# !5


!#
 )FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDONENGINE 0UMP

)FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDINENGINEROOM STATION
 )FREQUIREDBYTHESHIPOWNER

!5
$.

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation
078 78 46-0.0.0a

Fig. 9.02.02: Cylinder lubricating oil supply system for two different BN oils

#YLINDER

:6# 3OLENOIDVALVE
,UBRICATOR !CCUMULATOR ,UBRICATOR

:4# &EEDBACKSENSOR
!CCU !CCU

#IRCULATIONVALVE

!5
!#

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges #) In case of COLD engine room conditions, open the valve
The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation to circulate and heat up the cylinder oil. The valve is then
to be closed before starting.
121 36 61-8.4.0b

Fig. 9.02.03: MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubricators with piping and instrumentation on engine

MAN B&W S80MC6, S80MC-C7/8, K80MC-C6


MAN Diesel 198 64 18-6.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page  of 7

Pump Station and MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators on Engine

$ECK

3ERVICETANK 3ERVICETANK
&ILLINGPIPE FORLOW". FORHIGH". &ILLINGPIPE
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
 &LOWMETER 
&LOWMETER

& ,3 ,3 &
)NTERLOCK
MMNOMINALBORE
3TORAGETANK 3TORAGETANK
FORLOW". FORHIGH".
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
-IN MM
3HIPBUILDER

3HIPBUILDER
$. $.

  $.
!# !5


!#
 )FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDONENGINE 0UMP

)FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDINENGINEROOM STATION
 )FREQUIREDBYTHESHIPOWNER

!5
$.

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation
078 78 46-0.0.0b

Fig. 9.02.02: Cylinder lubricating oil supply system for two different BN oils

#YLINDER

:6# 3OLENOIDVALVE
,UBRICATOR !CCUMULATOR ,UBRICATOR

:4# &EEDBACKSENSOR
!CCU !CCU

#IRCULATIONVALVE

!5
!#

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges #) In case of COLD engine room conditions, open the valve
The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation to circulate and heat up the cylinder oil. The valve is then
to be closed before starting.
121 36 61-8.4.0b

Fig. 9.02.03: MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubricators with piping and instrumentation on engine

MAN B&W S70MC6, S70MC-C7/8, L70MC-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 64 19-8.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page  of 7

Pump Station and MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators on Engine

$ECK

3ERVICETANK 3ERVICETANK
&ILLINGPIPE FORLOW". FORHIGH". &ILLINGPIPE
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
 &LOWMETER 
&LOWMETER

& ,3 ,3 &
)NTERLOCK
MMNOMINALBORE
3TORAGETANK 3TORAGETANK
FORLOW". FORHIGH".
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
-IN MM
3HIPBUILDER

3HIPBUILDER
$. $.

  $.
!# !5


!#
 )FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDONENGINE 0UMP

)FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDINENGINEROOM STATION
 )FREQUIREDBYTHESHIPOWNER

!5
$.

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation
078 78 46-0.0.0b

Fig. 9.02.02: Cylinder lubricating oil supply system for two different BN oils

#YLINDER

:6# 3OLENOIDVALVE
!CCUMULATOR ,UBRICATOR

:4# &EEDBACKSENSOR
!CCU

#IRCULATIONVALVE

!5
!#

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges #) In case of COLD engine room conditions, open the valve
The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation to circulate and heat up the cylinder oil. The valve is then
to be closed before starting.
121 36 61-8.4.0c

Fig. 9.02.03: MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubricators with piping and instrumentation on engine

MAN B&W S60MC6, S60MC-C7/8, L60MC-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 64 20-8.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page  of 7

Pump Station and MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricators on Engine

$ECK

3ERVICETANK 3ERVICETANK
&ILLINGPIPE FORLOW". FORHIGH". &ILLINGPIPE
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
 &LOWMETER 
&LOWMETER

& ,3 ,3 &
)NTERLOCK
MMNOMINALBORE
3TORAGETANK 3TORAGETANK
FORLOW". FORHIGH".
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
-IN MM
3HIPBUILDER

3HIPBUILDER
$. $.

  $.
!# !5


!#
 )FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDONENGINE 0UMP

)FPUMPSTATIONISPLACEDINENGINEROOM STATION
 )FREQUIREDBYTHESHIPOWNER

!5
$.

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation
078 78 46-0.0.0c

Fig. 9.02.02: Cylinder lubricating oil supply system for two different BN oils

#YLINDER

:6# 3OLENOIDVALVE
!CCUMULATOR ,UBRICATOR

:4# &EEDBACKSENSOR
!CCU

#IRCULATIONVALVE

!5
!#

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges #) In case of COLD engine room conditions, open the valve
The item No. refer to Guidance values Automation to circulate and heat up the cylinder oil. The valve is then
to be closed before starting.
121 36 61-8.4.0c

Fig. 9.02.03: MAN B&W Alpha cylinder lubricators with piping and instrumentation on engine

MAN B&W S50MC6, S50MC-C7/8


MAN Diesel 198 64 22-1.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page 4 of 7

Lubricator Control System

The external electrical system must be capable of and slow down (Normally Open) for:
providing the MCU and BCU with an un-interrupt-
ible supply of 24 Volt DC power. Electronic cylinder lubricator system

The MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubricator System The system has a connection for coupling it to a
is equipped with the following (Normally Closed) computer system or a Display Unit (HMI panel) so
alarms: that engine speed, fuel index, injection frequency,
alarms, etc. can be monitored.
MCU fail
MCU power fail The HMI panel for mounting in Engine Control
MCU common alarm Room (option: 4 42 660) or on the engine (option:
BCU in control 4 42 160) can be delivered separately.
BCU fail
BCU power fail

For 98-70 MC/MC-C engines

Cylinder

Solenoid valve Solenoid valve

Accu
Lubricator Lubricator
mulator

Sensor Sensor

AU Pump station
with To other cylinders
AC standby pump

Pump control
unit

To other
cylinders

Alarm
Tacho signal
Switch Backup Master system
Board Control Control
Unit Unit Unit
Safety
Index signal
system

Alpha Cylinder Lubricator Control Unit

HMI panel

For the actual number of cylinder lubrication points on the specific engine see Fig. 9.02.03
178 24 312.2

Fig. 9.02.04a: Control of the MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System, two lubricators per cylinder, 98-70 MC/MC-C

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 98-9.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page 5 of 7

Wiring Diagram

Pump station On engine Engine Control Room

TE

Prelubrication
PE

Alarm
system

Alpha Lubricator
Pump
Control Unit
control unit
(ALCU)
Slow down
system

Uninterruptible
power supply

Display unit
(HMI panel)
Intermediate Intermediate Intermediate
box box box

Lubri Lubri ZE ZE ZE ZE
cator cator
1 2 Pickups Tacho Index
signal signal
Per cylinder

178 46 540.3

Fig. 9.02.05a: Wiring diagram for MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System, two lubricators per cylinder,
98-70 MC/MC-C

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 98-9.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page 6 of 7

For 60-50 MC/MC-C engines

Cylinder

Solenoid valve

Accu
Lubricator
mulator

Sensor

AU Pump station
with To other cylinders
AC standby pump

Pump control
unit

To other
cylinders

Alarm
Tacho signal
Switch Backup Master system
Board Control Control
Unit Unit Unit
Safety
Index signal
system

Alpha Cylinder Lubricator Control Unit

HMI panel

For the actual number of cylinder lubrication points on the specific engine see Fig. 9.02.03
178 47 13-9.3

Fig. 9.02.04b: Control of the MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System, one lubricator per cylinder,
60-50 MC/MC-C

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 98-9.0
MAN B&W 9.02
Page 7 of 7

Wiring Diagram

Pump station On engine Engine Control Room

TE

Prelubrication
PE

Alarm
system

Alpha Lubricator
Pump
Control Unit
control unit
(ALCU)
Slow down
system

Uninterruptible
power supply

Display unit
(HMI panel)
Intermediate Intermediate Intermediate
box box box

ZE ZE ZE ZE
Lubri
cator
Pickups Tacho Index
signal signal
Per cylinder

178 47 16-4.2

Fig. 9.02.05b: Wiring diagram for MAN B&W Alpha Cylinder Lubrication System, one lubricator per cylinder,
60-50 MC/MC-C

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 98-9.0
MAN B&W 9.03
Page 1 of 2

Mechanical Cylinder Lubricators

Mechanical cylinder lubricator(s), can be mounted Mainly for plants with controllable pitch propeller,
on the fore end of the engine, the size of which will the lubricators could, alternatively, be fitted with a
decide the number of lubricators needed. If driven mechanical lubrication system which controls the
by the engine in sync with the crankshaft move- dosage in proportion to the Mean Effective Pres-
ment, the lubricators could deliver timed injection sure (MEP).
of the cylinder lubrication oil.
An Engine Speed Dependent as well as a MEP
The lubricator(s) should have a built-in capability Dependent mechanical lubricator could be
for adjustment of the oil quantity and be provided equipped with a Load Change Dependent sys-
with a sight glass for each lubricating point. tem, by which the cylinder feed oil rate is auto-
matically increased during starting, manoeuvring
The lubricators should be fitted with: and, preferably, during sudden load changes, see
Electric heating coils Fig. 9.03.02.
Low flow and low level alarms.
In that case, the signal for the Load Change De-
In the Engine Speed Dependent design, the lu- pendent system comes from the electronic gov-
bricator pumps a fixed amount of oil to the cylin- ernor.
ders for each engine revolution.

K98MC/MC-C7, S90MC-C8, K90MC-C6 98-50 MC/MC-C engines

Control air from Electronic governor


manoeuvring system (digital type)
(7 bar)

Solenoid valve

FS 8251 AL

LS 8250 AL Lubricator
AC

178 59 504.0

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges Fig 9.03.02: Load change dependent mechanical
The piping is delivered with and fitted onto the engine lubricator
178 54 137.1

Fig 9.03.01: Piping and instrumentation for a


mechanical cylinder lubricator

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 99-9.0
MAN B&W 9.03
Page 2 of 2

S80MC-C8, K80MC-C6 S/L60MC-C8, S50MC-C8

Fore Aft

LS 8250 AL

FS 8251 AL

AC

FS 8251 AL

LS 8250 AL
AC 58 cylinder engines: 2 Lubricators
912 cylinder engines: 3 Lubricators

178 57 659.0 178 57 718.0

S/L70MC-C8

Fore Aft

LS 8250 AL

FS 8251 AL

AC

56 cylinder engines: 2 Lubricators


78 cylinder engines: 3 Lubricators

178 57 706.0

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The piping is delivered with and fitted onto the engine

Fig 9.03.01: Piping and instrumentation for a mechanical cylinder lubricator

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 79 99-9.0
MAN B&W 9.03
Page  of 2

Cylinder Lubricating Oil Supply System

$ECK

3ERVICETANK 3ERVICETANK
FORLOW". FORHIGH".
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
&ILLINGPIPE &ILLINGPIPE

&LOWMETER  &LOWMETER


& &
-IN MM

3TORAGETANK 3TORAGETANK
FORLOW". !# FORHIGH".
CYLINDEROIL CYLINDEROIL
MMNOMINALBORE

 )FREQUIREDBYTHESHIPOWNER

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


078 78 45-9.0.0

Fig. 9.03.03: Cylinder lubricating oil supply system for two different BN cylinder oils, for mechanical lubricators

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 65 98-2.0
MAN B&W

Piston Rod Stuffing


Box Drain Oil

10
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 10.01
Page 1 of 1

Stuffing Box Drain Oil System

For engines running on heavy fuel, it is important


that the oil drained from the piston rod stuffing
boxes is not led directly into the system oil, as
the oil drained from the stuffing box is mixed with
sludge from the scavenge air space.

The performance of the piston rod stuffing box on


the engines has proved to be very efficient, pri- Yards supply
marily because the hardened piston rod allows a AG
higher scraper ring pressure. 32 mm
nom. bore

The amount of drain oil from the stuffing boxes is


about 5 10 litres/24 hours per cylinder during
normal service. In the runningin period, it can be
higher. LS AH

The relatively small amount of drain oil is led to Oily waste drain tank
Drain
the general oily waste drain tank or is burnt in the tank

incinerator, Fig. 10.01.01. (Yards supply).


198 97 448.1

Fig. 10.01.01: Stuffing box drain oil system

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 39 740.5
MAN B&W

Central Cooling
Water System

11
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 11.01
Page 1 of 1

Central Cooling Water System

The water cooling can be arranged in several con- For information on the alternative Seawater Cool-
figurations, the most common system choice be- ing System, see Chapter 12.
ing a Central cooling water system.

Advantages of the central cooling system: An arrangement common for the main engine
and MAN Diesel auxiliary engines is available on
Only one heat exchanger cooled by seawater, request.
and thus, only one exchanger to be overhauled
For further information about common cooling
All other heat exchangers are freshwater cooled water system for main engines and auxiliary en-
and can, therefore, be made of a less expensive gines please refer to our publication:
material
Uni-concept Auxiliary Systems for Two-Stroke Main
Few noncorrosive pipes to be installed Engines and Four-Stroke Auxiliary Engines

Reduced maintenance of coolers and compo- The publication is available at


nents www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
Increased heat utilisation. Technical Papers.

Disadvantages of the central cooling system:

Three sets of cooling water pumps (seawater,


central water and jacket water.

Higher first cost.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 46 965.4
MAN B&W 11.02
Page 1 of 2

Central Cooling Water System

Central cooling water Open at sea


Jacket cooling water A Closed in port
Sea water
Deaerating Expansion tank Closed at sea
B Open in port
Port service for fresh water
Deaerating tank
Thermostatic alarm device
valve
Sea water
outlet

A L M

Lub. oil
cooler
Central N
cooler

P K

Central cooling
water pumps
Jacket Deaerating
water cool. tank Main engine
B Scavenge
Central cooling air cooler(s)
water pump aux. Thermostatic
eng. (port service) valve Jacket water
pumps

B
Fresh water
generator
A B
Sea water
pumps

Sea water
pump aux. F3 F3 F3
eng. (port
service)
Sea water
inlet

G2 G1 G2 G1 G2 G1
Sea water
inlet

178 50 218.1

Fig. 11.02.01: Central cooling system

The central cooling water system is characterised air cooler as low as possible also applies to the
by having only one heat exchanger cooled by central cooling system. This means that the tem-
seawater, and by the other coolers, including the perature control valve in the FWLT circuit is to be
jacket water cooler, being cooled by the freshwa- set to minimum 10 C, whereby the temperature
ter low temperature (FWLT) system. follows the outboard seawater temperature when
this exceeds 10 C.
In order to prevent too high a scavenge air tem-
perature, the cooling water design temperature in For external pipe connections, we prescribe the
the FWLT system is normally 36 C, correspond- following maximum water velocities:
ing to a maximum seawater temperature of 32 C.
Jacket water................................................. 3.0 m/s
Our recommendation of keeping the cooling water Central cooling water (FWLT)..................... 3.0 m/s
inlet temperature to the main engine scavenge Seawater...................................................... 3.0 m/s

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 99-7.3
MAN B&W 11.02
Page 2 of 2

Central Cooling System, common for Main Engine and MAN Diesel GenSets

Design features and working principle The main engine jacket system has an independ-
ent pump circuit with a jacket water pump, circu-
The camshaft lubricating oil cooler, is omitted in lating the cooling water through the main engine
plants using the unilubricating oil system for the to the fresh water generator, and the jacket water
main engine. cooler.

The low and high temperature systems are direct- A thermostatically controlled 3way valve, at the
ly connected to gain the advantage of preheating jacket cooler outlet mixes cooled and uncooled
the main engine and GenSets during standstill. water to maintain an outlet water temperature of
8085 C from the main engine.
As all fresh cooling water is inhibited and common
for the central cooling system, only one common
expansion tank, is necessary for deaeration of Operation in port
both the low and high temperature cooling sys-
tems. This tank accommodates the difference in During operation in port, when the main engine
water volume caused by changes in the tempera- is stopped but one or more GenSets are running,
ture. valves A are closed and valves B are opened.

To prevent the accumulation of air in the cooling A small central water pump, will circulate the
water system, a deaerating tank, is located below necessary flow of water for the air cooler, the lu-
the expansion tank. bricating oil cooler, and the jacket cooler of the
GenSets. The auxiliary enginesdriven pumps and
An alarm device is inserted between the deaerat- the previously mentioned integrated loop ensure
ing tank and the expansion tank so that the oper- a satisfactory jacket cooling water temperature at
ating crew can be warned if excess air or gas is the GenSets outlet.
released, as this signals a malfunction of engine
components. The main engine and the stopped GenSets are
preheated as described for the jacket water sys-
tem.
Operation at sea
The other data for the jacket cooling water system
The seawater cooling pump, supplies seawater can be found in Chapter 06.06.
from the sea chests through the central cooler,
and overboard. Alternatively, some shipyards use For further information about a common cooling
a pumpless scoop system. water system for main engines and MAN Diesel
auxiliary engines please refer to our publication:
On the freshwater side, the central cooling water
pump, circulates the lowtemperature fresh water, Uni-concept Auxiliary Systems for Two-Stroke Main
in a cooling circuit, directly through the lubricating Engines and Four-Stroke Auxiliary Engines
oil cooler of the main engine, the GenSets and the
scavenge air cooler(s). The publication is available at
www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
The jacket water cooling system for the GenSets Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
is equipped with enginedriven pumps and a by Technical Papers.
pass system integrated in the lowtemperature
system.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 99-7.3
MAN B&W 11.03
Page 1 of 2

Components for Central Cooling Water System

Seawater cooling pumps Central cooling water pumps

The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type. The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type.

Seawater flow...................... see List of Capacities Central cooling water flow.... see List of Capacities
Pump head....................................................2.5 bar Pump head....................................................2.5 bar
Test pressure......................according to class rules Delivery pressure................depends on location of
Working temperature, normal......................032 C expansion tank
Working temperature..................... maximum 50 C Test pressure......................according to class rules
Working temperature...................................... 80 C
The flow capacity must be within a range from Design temperature....................................... 100 C
100 to 110% of the capacity stated.
The flow capacity must be within a range from
The differential pressure of the pumps is to be de- 100 to 110% of the capacity stated.
termined on the basis of the total actual pressure
drop across the cooling water system. The List of Capacities covers the main engine
only. The differential pressure provided by the
pumps is to be determined on the basis of the to-
Central cooler tal actual pressure drop across the cooling water
system.
The cooler is to be of the shell and tube or plate
heat exchanger type, made of seawater resistant
material. Central cooling water thermostatic valve

Heat dissipation...................... see List of Capacities The low temperature cooling system is to be
Central cooling water flow...... see List of Capacities equipped with a threeway valve, mounted as a
Central cooling water temperature, outlet.......... 36 C mixing valve, which bypasses all or part of the
Pressure drop on central cooling side.....max. 0.2 bar fresh water around the central cooler.
Seawater flow......................... see List of Capacities
Seawater temperature, inlet.............................. 32 C The sensor is to be located at the outlet pipe from
Pressure drop on the thermostatic valve and is set so as to keep a
seawater side................................. maximum 0.2 bar temperature level of minimum 10 C.

The pressure drop may be larger, depending on


the actual cooler design.

The heat dissipation and the seawater flow figures


are based on MCR output at tropical conditions,
i.e. a seawater temperature of 32 C and an ambi-
ent air temperature of 45 C.

Overload running at tropical conditions will slightly


increase the temperature level in the cooling sys-
tem, and will also slightly influence the engine
performance.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 39 872.5
MAN B&W 11.03
Page 2 of 2

Jacket water system Lubricating oil cooler

Due to the central cooler the cooling water inlet See Chapter 8 Lubricating Oil.
temperature is about 4 C higher for for this sys-
tem compared to the seawater cooling system.
The input data are therefore different for the scav- Jacket water cooler
enge air cooler, the lube oil cooler and the jacket
water cooler. The cooler is to be of the shell and tube or plate
heat exchanger type.
The heat dissipation and the central cooling water
flow figures are based on an MCR output at tropi- Heat dissipation.................. see List of Capacities
cal conditions, i.e. a maximum seawater tempera- Jacket water flow................ see List of Capacities
ture of 32 C and an ambient air temperature of Jacket water temperature, inlet....................... 80 C
45 C. Pressure drop on jacket water side.....max. 0.2 bar
Central cooling water flow.... see List of Capacities
Central cooling water
Jacket water cooling pump temperature, inlet...............................approx. 42 C
Pressure drop on Central
The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type. cooling water side.................................max. 0.2 bar
Jacket water flow................ see List of Capacities
Pump head....................................................3.0 bar The other data for the jacket cooling water system
Delivery pressure................depends on location of can be found in Chapter 12.
expansion tank
Test pressure......................according to class rules For further information about a common cooling
Working temperature...................................... 80 C water system for main engines and MAN Diesel
Design temperature....................................... 100 C auxiliary engines, please refer to our publication:

The flow capacity must be within a range from Uni-concept Auxiliary Systems for Two-Stroke Main
100 to 110% of the capacity stated. Engines and Four-Stroke Auxiliary Engines

The stated of capacities cover the main engine The publication is available at
only. The pump head of the pumps is to be de- www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
termined on the basis of the total actual pressure Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
drop across the cooling water system. Technical Papers.

Scavenge air cooler

The scavenge air cooler is an integrated part of


the main engine.

Heat dissipation...................... see List of Capacities


Central cooling water flow...... see List of Capacities
Central cooling temperature, inlet..................... 36 C
Pressure drop on FWLT water side..... approx. 0.5 bar

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 39 872.5
MAN B&W

Seawater
Cooling System

12
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 12.01
Page 1 of 1

Seawater Systems

The water cooling can be arranged in several con-


figurations, the most simple system choices being
seawater and central cooling water system:

A seawater cooling system and a jacket cool-


ing water system

The advantages of the seawater cooling system


are mainly related to first cost, viz:

Only two sets of cooling water pumps (seawater


and jacket water)

Simple installation with few piping systems.

Whereas the disadvantages are:

Seawater to all coolers and thereby higher


maintenance cost

Expensive seawater piping of noncorrosive ma-


terials such as galvanised steel pipes or CuNi
pipes.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 924.4
MAN B&W 12.02
Page 1 of 1

Seawater Cooling System

The seawater cooling system is used for cooling, The interrelated positioning of the coolers in the
the main engine lubricating oil cooler, the jacket system serves to achieve:
water cooler and the scavenge air cooler, see Fig.
12.02.01. The lowest possible cooling water inlet tem-
perature to the lubricating oil cooler in order to
The lubricating oil cooler for a PTO stepup gear obtain the cheapest cooler. On the other hand,
should be connected in parallel with the other in order to prevent the lubricating oil from stiff-
coolers. The capacity of the seawater pump is ening in cold services, the inlet cooling water
based on the outlet temperature of the seawater temperature should not be lower than 10 C
being maximum 50 C after passing through the
coolers with an inlet temperature of maximum The lowest possible cooling water inlet tempera-
32 C (tropical conditions), i.e. a maximum tem- ture to the scavenge air cooler, in order to keep
perature increase of 18 C. the fuel oil consumption as low as possible.

The valves located in the system fitted to adjust


the distribution of cooling water flow are to be
provided with graduated scales.

Lubricating
Seawater oil cooler
pumps

Thermostatic
valve P
Seawater
outlet
Scavenge
air cooler

Jacket water
cooler

Seawater
inlet

Seawater
inlet

198 98 132.5

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges

Fig. 12.02.01: Seawater cooling system

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 936.5
MAN B&W 12.03
Page  of 1

Seawater Cooling Pipes

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/ME-B/MEC/MEGI engines


MAN Diesel 198 49 30-2.1
MAN B&W 12.04
Page 1 of 1

Components for Seawater Cooling System

Seawater cooling pump Scavenge air cooler

The pumps are to be of the centrifugal type. The scavenge air cooler is an integrated part of
the main engine.
Seawater flow...................... see List of Capacities
Pump head....................................................2.5 bar Heat dissipation.................. see List of Capacities
Test pressure....................... according to class rule Seawater flow . ................... see List of Capacities
Working temperature..................... maximum 50 C Seawater temperature,
for seawater cooling inlet, max....................... 32 C
The flow capacity must be within a range from Pressure drop on
100 to 110% of the capacity stated. cooling water side............ between 0.1 and 0.5 bar

The heat dissipation and the seawater flow are


Lubricating oil cooler based on an MCR output at tropical conditions,
i.e. seawater temperature of 32 C and an ambient
See Chapter 8 Lubricating Oil. air temperature of 45 C.

Jacket water cooler Seawater thermostatic valve

The cooler is to be of the shell and tube or plate The temperature control valve is a threeway valve
heat exchanger type, made of seawater resistant which can recirculate all or part of the seawater to
material. the pumps suction side. The sensor is to be locat-
ed at the seawater inlet to the lubricating oil cooler,
Heat dissipation.................. see List of Capacities and the temperature level must be a minimum of
Jacket water flow................ see List of Capacities +10 C.
Jacket water temperature, inlet....................... 80 C
Pressure drop Seawater flow...................... see List of Capacities
on jacket water side.....................maximum 0.2 bar Temperature range,
Seawater flow...................... see List of Capacities adjustable within..................................+5 to +32 C
Seawater temperature, inlet ........................... 38 C
Pressure drop on
seawater side...............................maximum 0.2 bar

The heat dissipation and the seawater flow are


based on an MCR output at tropical conditions,
i.e. seawater temperature of 32 C and an ambient
air temperature of 45 C.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 39 811.3
MAN B&W 12.05
Page 1 of 1

Jacket Cooling Water System

The jacket cooling water system is used for cool- The venting pipe in the expansion tank should end
ing the cylinder liners, cylinder covers and ex- just below the lowest water level, and the expan-
haust valves of the main engine and heating of the sion tank must be located at least 5 m above the
fuel oil drain pipes, see Fig. 12.05.01. engine cooling water outlet pipe.

The jacket water pump) draws water from the The freshwater generator, if installed, may be con-
jacket water cooler outlet and delivers it to the nected to the seawater system if the generator
engine. does not have a separate cooling water pump.
The generator must be coupled in and out slowly
At the inlet to the jacket water cooler there is a over a period of at least 3 minutes.
thermostatically controlled regulating valve, with
a sensor at the engine cooling water outlet, which For external pipe connections, we prescribe the
keeps the main engine cooling water outlet at a following maximum water velocities:
temperature of 80 C.
Jacket water................................................. 3.0 m/s
The engine jacket water must be carefully treated, Seawater...................................................... 3.0 m/s
maintained and monitored so as to avoid corro-
sion, corrosion fatigue, cavitation and scale for-
mation. It is recommended to install a preheater
if preheating is not available from the auxiliary
engines jacket cooling water system.

High level alarm


Venting pipe or automatic Alarm must be given if excess air
venting valve to be arranged is separated from the water in the Expansion tank
in one end of discharge pipe. deaerating tank
(Opposite end of discharge
to pump) Low level alarm

LS 8412 AL

Orifice for adjustment of Alarm device box, Normally closed valve.


PT 8413 I cooling water pressure see Fig. 12.07.02 To be opened when the
M L system is filled with
cooling water. (Manually
Tracing of fuel oil
or automatically)
drain pipe
Preheater
Preheater pump
AN Regulating valve
AF
*) BD TI
AH
PI
K
TI TI

AE AE PI
Deaerating tank, Freshwater
Jacket water
Jacket water pumps, see Fig. 12.07.01 generator
cooler
3 bar head
Main
engine
From tracing of fuel oil drain pipe *)
Water inlet for
cleaning turbocharger
Drain from bedplate/cleaning
turbocharger to waste tank Fresh cooling water drain

Jacket cooling water *) Flange BD and the tracing line are not applicable on MC/MCC engines type 42 and smaller
Sea water
Fuel oil

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges, Fig. 5.10.01


178 50 172.5

Fig. 12.05.01: Jacket cooling water system

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 948.6
MAN B&W 12.06
Page 1 of 1

Jacket Cooling Water Pipes

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 49 31-4.1
MAN B&W 12.07
Page 1 of 1

Components for Jacket Cooling Water System

Freshwater generator The preheater capacity depends on the required


preheating time and the required temperature
If a generator is installed in the ship for produc- increase of the engine jacket water. The tem-
tion of freshwater by utilising the heat in the jacket perature and time relationships are shown in Fig.
water cooling system it should be noted that the 12.08.01.
actual available heat in the jacket water system
is lower than indicated by the heat dissipation In general, a temperature increase of about 35 C
figures given in the List of capacities. This is (from 15 C to 50 C) is required, and a preheating
because the latter figures are used for dimension- time of 12 hours requires a preheater capacity of
ing the jacket water cooler and hence incorporate about 1% of the engine`s nominal MCR power.
a safety margin which can be needed when the
engine is operating under conditions such as, e.g.
overload. Normally, this margin is 10% at nominal Expansion tank
MCR.
The total expansion tank volume has to be ap-
The calculation of the heat actually available at proximate 10% of the total jacket cooling water
specified MCR for a derated diesel engine is stat- amount in the system.
ed in Chapter 6 List of capacities.

For illustration of installation of fresh water gen- Fresh water treatment


erator see Fig. 12.05.01.
MAN Diesels recommendations for treatment of
the jacket water / freshwater are available on re-
Jacket water thermostatic valve quest.

The temperature control system can be equipped


with a threeway valve mounted as a diverting
valve, which bypass all or part of the jacket water
around the jacket water cooler.

The sensor is to be located at the outlet from the


main engine, and the temperature level must be
adjustable in the range of 7090 C.

Jacket water preheater

When a preheater is installed in the jacket cool-


ing water system, its water flow, and thus the
preheater pump capacity (4 46 625), should be
about 10% of the jacket water main pump capac-
ity. Based on experience, it is recommended that
the pressure drop across the preheater should be
approx. 0.2 bar. The preheater pump and main
pump should be electrically interlocked to avoid
the risk of simultaneous operation.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/ME-B/MEC/MEGI engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 96-1.4
MAN B&W 12.08
Page 1 of 1

Temperature at Start of Engine

In order to protect the engine, some minimum Temperature Preheater


temperature restrictions have to be considered increase of
jacket water
capacity in
% of nominal
before starting the engine and, in order to avoid MCR power

corrosive attacks on the cylinder liners during C 1.25%

starting. 60
1.50% 1.00% 0.75%

Normal start of engine 50

0.50%
Normally, a minimum engine jacket water temper-
ature of 50 C is recommended before the engine 40
is started and run up gradually to 90% of speci-
fied MCR speed.
30
For running between 90% and 100% of specified
MCR speed, it is recommended that the load be
increased slowly i.e. over a period of 30 minutes. 20

Start of cold engine 10

In exceptional circumstances where it is not pos-


sible to comply with the above-mentioned recom- 0
mendation, a minimum of 20 C can be accepted 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70

before the engine is started and run up slowly to hours


Preheating time
90% of specified MCR speed.
178 16 631.0

However, before exceeding 90% specified MCR Fig. 12.08.01: Jacket water preheater
speed, a minimum engine temperature of 50 C
should be obtained and, increased slowly i.e.
over a period of at least 30 minutes. Preheating of diesel engine

The time period required for increasing the jacket


water temperature from 20 C to 50 C will de- Preheating during standstill periods
pend on the amount of water in the jacket cooling
water system, and the engine load. During short stays in port (i.e. less than 45 days),
it is recommended that the engine is kept pre-
Note: heated, the purpose being to prevent temperature
The above considerations are based on the as- variation in the engine structure and correspond-
sumption that the engine has already been well ing variation in thermal expansions and possible
runin. leakages.

The jacket cooling water outlet temperature should


be kept as high as possible and should before
startingup be increased to at least 50 C, either
by means of cooling water from the auxiliary en-
gines, or by means of a builtin preheater in the
jacket cooling water system, or a combination.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 39 860.2
MAN B&W

Starting and Control Air


13
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 13.01
Page 1 of 1

Starting and Control Air Systems

The starting air of 30 bar is supplied by the start- The components of the starting and control air
ing air compressors to the starting air receivers systems are further desribed in Section 13.02.
and from these to the main engine inlet A.
Starting air and control air for the GenSets can be
Through a reduction station, filtered compressed supplied from the same starting air receivers, as
air at 7 bar is supplied to the control air for ex- for the main engine.
haust valve air springs, through engine inlet B
For information about a common starting air sys-
Through a reduction valve, compressed air is sup- tem for main engines and MAN Diesel auxiliary
plied at 10 bar to AP for turbocharger cleaning engines, please refer to our publication:
(soft blast), and a minor volume used for the fuel
valve testing unit. Uni-concept Auxiliary Systems for Two-Stroke Main
Engines and Four-Stroke Auxiliary Engines
Please note that the air consumption for control
air, safety air, turbocharger cleaning, sealing air The publication is available at
for exhaust valve and for fuel valve testing unit are www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
momentary requirements of the consumers. Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
Technical Papers.

Reduction valve

Reduction station
Pipe, DN25 mm To fuel valve
testing unit

Starting air
Filter, receiver 30 bar
40 m

Pipe, DN25 mm PI
To
bilge

B C 1) AP
A

Main Pipe a, DN *)
engine

Oil & water


separator
Starting air
receiver 30 bar

PI
To bilge

Air compressors

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


*) The nominal dimension of Pipe a depends on the engine type
1) Engine inlet C is only applicable for MC and MC-C engines
079 61 01-7.1.1a

Fig. 13.01.01: Starting and control air systems

MAN B&W Engine Selection Guide,


MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/-GI engines MAN Diesel 198 38 985.4
MAN B&W 13.02
Page  of 1

Components for Starting Air System

Starting air compressors Reduction valve for turbocharger cleaning etc

The starting air compressors are to be of the Reduction . ........................ from 3010 bar to 7 bar
watercooled, twostage type with intercooling. (Tolerance 10%)

More than two compressors may be installed to Flow rate, free air ............. 2,600 Normal liters/min
supply the total capacity stated. equal to 0.043 m3/s

Air intake quantity: The consumption of compressed air for control air,
Reversible engine, exhaust valve air springs and safety air as well as
for 12 starts ........................ see List of capacities air for turbocharger cleaning and fuel valve testing
Nonreversible engine, is covered by the capacities stated for air receiv-
for 6 starts .......................... see List of capacities ers and compressors in the list of capacities.
Delivery pressure ......................................... 30 bar

Starting and control air pipes


Starting air receivers
The piping delivered with and fitted onto the main
The starting air receivers shall be provided with engine is shown in the following figures in Section
man holes and flanges for pipe connections. 13.03:

The volume of the two receivers is: Fig. 13.03.01 Starting air pipes
Reversible engine, Fig. 13.03.02 Air spring pipes, exhaust valves
for 12 starts ...................... see List of capacities *
Nonreversible engine,
for 6 starts ........................ see List of capacities * Turning gear
Working pressure ......................................... 30 bar
Test pressure .................... according to class rule The turning wheel has cylindrical teeth and is fit-
ted to the thrust shaft. The turning wheel is driven
* The volume stated is at 25 C and 1,000 mbar by a pinion on the terminal shaft of the turning
gear, which is mounted on the bedplate.

Reduction station for control and safety air Engagement and disengagement of the turning
gear is effected by displacing the pinion and ter-
In normal operating, each of the two lines supplies minal shaft axially. To prevent the main engine
one engine inlet. During maintenance, three isolat- from starting when the turning gear is engaged,
ing valves in the reduction station allow one of the the turning gear is equipped with a safety arrange-
two lines to be shut down while the other line sup- ment which interlocks with the starting air system.
plies both engine inlets, see Fig. 13.01.01.
The turning gear is driven by an electric motor
Reduction . ........................ from 3010 bar to 7 bar with a builtin gear and brake. Key specifications
(Tolerance 10%) of the electric motor and brake are stated in Sec-
tion 13.04.
Flow rate, free air .............. 2,100 Normal liters/min
equal to 0.035 m3/s
Filter, fineness .............................................. 40 m

MAN B&W K98MC/MCC6/7, S90MC-C7/8, K90MC-C6, S80MC6,


S80MC-C7/8, K80MC-C6, S70MC6, S/L70MC-C7/8,
S60MC6, S/L60MC-C7/8, S50MC6, S50MC-C7/8
MAN Diesel 198 60 483.0
MAN B&W 13.03
Page 1 of 1

Starting and Control Air Pipes

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 59 03-3.2
MAN B&W

Scavenge Air

14
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 14.01
Page 1 of 1

Scavenge Air System

The engine is supplied with scavenge air from The scavenge air system is an integrated part of
turbochargers, located on the exhaust side of the the main engine, see Figs. 14.01.01 and
engine. However, some engines can be fitted with 14.02.01.
one turbocharger located on the aft end of the
engine. The engine power figures and the data in the list
of capacities are based on MCR at tropical condi-
The compressor of the turbocharger draws air tions, i.e. a seawater temperature of 32 C, or a
from the engine room, through an air filter, and freshwater temperature of 36 C, and an ambient
the compressed air is cooled by the scavenge air intake temperature of 45 C.
air cooler, one per turbocharger. The scavenge
air cooler is provided with a water mist catcher,
which prevents condensate water from being car-
ried with the air into the scavenge air receiver and
to the combustion chamber.

Exhaust gas
receiver

Exhaust valve
Turbocharger

Cylinder liner

Scavenge
gas receiver

Scavenge
air cooler

Water mist
catcher

178 07 274.2

Fig. 14.01.01: Scavenge Air System

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 48 60-6.3
MAN B&W 14.02
Page 1 of 3

Auxiliary Blowers

The engine is provided with a minimum of two Emergency running


electrically driven auxiliary blowers, the actual
number depending on the number of cylinders as If one of the auxiliary blowers is out of function,
well as the turbocharger make and amount. Be- the other auxiliary blower will function in the sys-
tween the scavenge air cooler and the scavenge tem, without any manual adjustment of the valves
air receiver, nonreturn valves are fitted which being necessary.
close automatically when the auxiliary blowers
start supplying the scavenge air.
Scavenge air cooler requirements
The auxiliary blowers start operating consecu-
tively before the engine is started and will ensure The data for the scavenge air cooler is specified in
complete scavenging of the cylinders in the start- the description of the cooling water system chosen.
ing phase, thus providing the best conditions for a
safe start. For further information, please refer to our publi-
cation titled:
During operation of the engine, the auxiliary blow-
ers will start automatically whenever the blower Influence of Ambient Temperature Conditions
inlet pressure drops below a preset pressure,
corresponding to an engine load of approximately The publication is available at
25-35%. The blowers will continue to operate until www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
the blower inlet pressure again exceeds the preset Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
pressure plus an appropriate hysteresis (i.e. taking Technical Papers.
recent pressure history into account), correspond-
ing to an engine load of approximately 30-40%.

Running with auxiliary blower

Running with turbocharger


178 44 70-5.1

Fig. 14.02.01: Auxiliary blowers for scavenge air system

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 65 86-2.3
MAN B&W 14.02
Page 2 of 3

Control of the Auxiliary Blowers

The auxiliary blowers are fitted onto the main en- The pressure switch P controls the run/stop
gine and controlled by a system comprising: signals, while pressure switch B is part of the
auxiliary blower alarm circuit.
1 pc Control Panel
1 pc Starter Panel per Auxiliary Blower The control panel is yards supply. It can be or-
2 pc Pressure Switches dered as an option: 4 55 650.

Referring to the diagram of the auxiliary blower The starter panels with starters for the auxiliary
control system, Fig. 14.02.02: blower motors are not included, they can be or-
dered as an option: 4 55 653. (The starter panel
The Control Panel controls the run/stop signals design and function is according to MAN Diesels
to all Auxiliary Blower Starter Panels. The Con- diagram, however, the physical layout and choice
trol Panel consists of an operation panel and a of components has to be decided by the manu-
terminal row interconnected by a 1,200 mm long facturer).
wire harness.
Heaters for the blower motors are available as an
The Auxiliary Blower Starter Panels control and option: 4 55 155.
protect the Auxiliary Blower motors, one panel
with starter per blower.

Control panel On engine


Alarm system

Telegraph system PS 8603 Pressure switch P

Safety system

24V DC Power supply PS 8604 Pressure switch B


from ship

Engine Control Room ECR

Engine room

Aux. blower Aux. blower Aux. blower Aux. blower Aux. blower
starter panel 1 starter panel 2 starter panel 3 starter panel 4 starter panel 5

M M M M M

Auxiliary Motor Auxiliary Motor Auxiliary Motor Auxiliary Motor Auxiliary Motor
blower heater blower heater blower heater blower heater blower heater

Power Power Power Power Power


cable cable cable cable cable

513 53 301.0.0

Fig. 14.02.02: Diagram of auxiliary blower control system

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 65 86-2.3
MAN B&W 14.02
Page 3 of 3

Operation Panel for the Auxiliary Blowers

On the operation panel, three control modes are The operation panel and terminal row have to be
available to run/stop the blowers: mounted in the Engine Control Room Manoeu-
vring Console, see Section 16.01.
AUTO Run/stop is automatically controlled by
scavenge air pressure The control panel for the auxiliary blowers includ-
ing the operation panel, wiring harness and termi-
MANUAL Start of all blowers in sequence at nal row is shown in Fig. 14.02.03.
intervals of 6 sec

OFF The auxiliary blowers are stopped after a


set period of time, 30 sec for instance.

MAIN ENGINE
AUXILIARY BLOWER CONTROL
AUXILIARY AUXILIARY AUXILIARY
BLOWER 1 BLOWER 2 BLOWER 3
RUNNING RUNNING RUNNING

AUXILIARY AUXILIARY AUXILIARY


1,200mm wire harness, BLOWER 4 BLOWER 5 BLOWER 6
shielded by 20mm jacket RUNNING RUNNING RUNNING
Harness to be fixed to structure
AUTO
OFF MANUAL

IN SERVICE LAMP TEST

K5 K10 K7

Terminal row, to be mounted in


the Manoeuvring Console

512 36 604.0.0

Fig. 14.02.03: Control panel including operation panel, wiring harness and terminal row, option: 4 55 650

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 65 874.0
MAN B&W 14.03
Page 1 of 1

Scavenge Air Pipes

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 63-1.1
MAN B&W 14.04
Page 1 of 1

Electric Motor for Auxiliary Blower

Please note that the information is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 48 64-3.1
MAN B&W 14.05
Page 1 of 2

Scavenge Air Cooler Cleaning System

The air side of the scavenge air cooler can be The system is equipped with a drain box with a
cleaned by injecting a grease dissolving media level switch, indicating any excessive water level.
through AK to a spray pipe arrangement fitted to
the air chamber above the air cooler element. The piping delivered with and fitted on the engine
is shown in Fig 14.05.01.

Drain from water mist catcher


Auto Pump Overboard System
Sludge is drained through AL to the drain water
collecting tank and the polluted grease dissolvent It is common practice on board to lead drain wa-
returns from AM, through a filter, to the chemical ter directly overboard via a collecting tank. Before
cleaning tank. The cleaning must be carried out pumping the drain water overboard, it is recom-
while the engine is at standstill. mended to measure the oil content. If above
15ppm, the drain water should be lead to the
Dirty water collected after the water mist catcher clean bilge tank / bilge holding tank.
is drained through DX and led to the bilge tank
via an open funnel, see Fig. 14.05.02. If required by the owner, a system for automatic
disposal of drain water with oil content monitoring
The AL drain line is, during running, used as a could be built as outlined in Fig. 14.05.02.
permanent drain from the air cooler water mist
catcher. The water is led through an orifice to pre-
vent major losses of scavenge air.

AK AK

LS 8611 AH

DX
AL AM DX

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item no refer to Guidance values automation
178 56 35-4.2

Fig. 14.05.01: Air cooler cleaning pipes

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/MEC, S90MC-C/MEC,


K90MC-C/ME/MEC, S80MC/MC-C/MEC, K80MC-C/MEC,
S70MC/MC-C/MEC/MEGI, L70MC-C/MEC, S65MEC/MEGI,
MAN Diesel 198 76 84-9.0

S60MC/MC-C/MEC/MEGI/ME-B, L60MC-C/MEC, S50ME-B9


MAN B&W 14.05
Page 2 of 2

Auto Pump Overboard System

DX AL

Oil in water
Drain water High level alarm
monitor

Hull
collecting tank (15ppm oil)
Start pump

Stop pump
Low level alarm
Overboard

Clean bilge tank /


To oily water bilge holding tank
separator

079 21 94-1.0.0c

Fig. 14.05.02: Suggested automatic disposal of drain water, if required by owner (not a demand from MAN Diesel)

Air Cooler Cleaning Unit

AK
PI

DN=25 mm

Air cooler Air cooler

Freshwater
(from hydrophor)

DX AL

Recirculation
DN=50 mm
AM

DN=50 mm

TI
Circulation pump
Chemical
cleaning tank Filter Drain from air cooler
1 mm mesh size cleaning & water mist
catcher in air cooler

Heating coil

To fit the chemical


makers requirement Sludge pump suction

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges

Information on tank capacity is to be found in


the Project Guide for the relevant engine type.
079 21 94-1.0.0a

Fig. 14.05.03: Air cooler cleaning system with Air Cooler Cleaning Unit, option: 4 55 665

MAN B&W Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 39 02-2.5
MAN B&W 14.06
Page 1 of 1

Scavenge Air Box Drain System

The scavenge air box is continuously drained The system delivered with and fitted on the engine
through AV to a small pressurised drain tank, is shown in Fig. 14.03.02 Scavenge air space,
from where the sludge is led to the sludge tank. drain pipes.
Steam can be applied through BV, if required, to
facilitate the draining. See fig. 14.06.01.
Further information on number of cylinders
The continuous drain from the scavenge air box and capacity of drain tank
must not be directly connected to the sludge tank
owing to the scavenge air pressure. The pres- The information is to be found in the Project Guide
surised drain tank must be designed to withstand for the relevant engine type.
full scavenge air pressure and, if steam is applied,
to withstand the steam pressure available.

Deck/Roof

DN 50 mm

Min. 15

DN 15 mm
Normally open.
BV AV To be closed in case of fire
in the scavenge air box.

Orifice 10 mm

Min. distance
1,000 mm

Steam inlet pressure 310 bar. DN 65 mm


If steam is not available, 7 bar
compressed air can be used.

DN 50 mm

Drain
tank

Normally closed.
Sludge tank Tank to be emptied
for fuel oil during service with
centrifuges valve open.

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


079 61 03-0.2.0

Fig. 14.06.01: Scavenge air box drain system

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 39 13-0.5
MAN B&W 14.07
Page 1 of 2

Fire Extinguishing System for Scavenge Air Space

Fire in the scavenge air space can be extin- The corresponding internal system fitted on the
guished by steam, this being the standard ver- engine is shown in Fig. 14.07.02, comprising:
sion, or, optionally, by water mist or CO2.
Fire extinguishing in scavenge air space (steam)
The external system, pipe and flange connections or
are shown in Fig. 14.07.01, comprising: Fire extinguishing in scavenge air space (water
mist) or
Fire extinguishing system for scavenge air space, Fire extinguishing in scavenge air space (CO2).
basic: 4 55 140 Steam
or option: 4 55 142 Water mist
or option: 4 55 143 CO2 Further information on Steam, Freshwater and
CO2 test pressure and quantities

The information is to be found in the Project Guide


for the relevant engine type.

Basic solution: Steam extinguishing Option: CO 2 extinguishing


(Option for 26MC) CO 2 test pressure: 150 bar
Steam pressure: 310 bar

AT AT

DN 40mm
(20mm for 35MC/MCC/MEB, 26MC)
DN 20mm
Normal position
open to bilge

CO 2 bottles

Option: Water mist extinguishing CO 2


(Basic for 26MC)
Fresh water presssure: min. 3.5 bar At least two bottles ought to be installed.
In most cases, one bottle should be sufficient
to extinguish fire in three cylilnders, while two
or more bottles would be required to extinguish
AT fire in all cylinders.

DN 40mm To prevent the fire from spreading to the next


(20mm for 35MC/MCC/MEB, 26MC) cylinder(s), the ballvalve of the neighbouring
cylinder(s) should be opened in the event of
fire in one cylinder.
Normal position
open to bilge

079 61 02-9.0.1d

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges

Fig. 14.07.01: Fire extinguishing system for scavenge air space

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 48 65-5.4
MAN B&W 14.07
Page 2 of 2

Fire Extinguishing Pipes in Scavenge Air Space

General design (except K90MCC6/7, K80MCC6, S60MC6):


Exhaust side

Cyl. 1

Manoeuvering side

TE 8610 I AH Y Extinguishing agent:

CO2, Steam or Freshwater

AT

Drain pipe, bedplate


(Only for steam or freshwater)
126 40 81-0.6.0a

K90MCC6/7, K80MCC6, S60MC6:

TE 8610 I AH Y
Exhaust side

Cyl. 1

Manoeuvering side

Extinguishing agent:

CO2, Steam or Freshwater

AT

Drain pipe, bedplate


(Only for steam or freshwater)
126 40 81-0.6.0b

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges

Fig. 14.07.02: Fire extinguishing pipes in scavenge air space

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/ME-B/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 48 65-5.4
MAN B&W

Exhaust Gas

15
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 15.01
Page 1 of 1

Exhaust Gas System

The exhaust gas is led from the cylinders to the Turbocharger arrangement and cleaning systems
exhaust gas receiver where the fluctuating pres-
sures from the cylinders are equalised and from The turbochargers are arranged on the exhaust
where the gas is led further on to the turbocharg- side of the engine. However, some engines can be
ers at a constant pressure. See Fig. 15.01.01. fitted with one turbocharger located on the aft end.

Compensators are fitted between the exhaust The engine is designed for the installation of MAN,
valve housings and the exhaust gas receiver and ABB or MHI turbochargers, the number can be
between the receiver and the turbocharger. A pro- from one to four.
tective grating is placed between the exhaust gas
receiver and the turbocharger. The turbocharger All makes of turbochargers are fitted with an ar-
is fitted with a pickup for monitoring and remote rangement for soft blast cleaning of the turbine
indication of the turbocharger speed. side. Water washing of the compressor side is ei-
ther fitted or available as an option for some turbo-
The exhaust gas receiver and the exhaust pipes chargers as indicated in Figs. 15.02.02 - 15.02.04.
are provided with insulation, covered by steel
plating. Further information is found in the Project Guide
for the relevant engine.

Exhaust gas
receiver

Exhaust valve
Turbocharger

Cylinder liner

Scavenge air
receiver

Scavenge
air cooler

Water mist
catcher

178 07 274.1

Fig. 15.01.01: Exhaust gas system on engine

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 39 046.3
MAN B&W 15.02
Page 1 of 3

Exhaust Gas Pipes

*)
TC 8702 I AH AL YH YL Cyl. 1

To scavenge air receiver

TI 8702 PI 8601

PI 8706

Exhaust gas receiver

Turbocharger

TI 8701

TC 8701 I AH YH ST 8801 I

Flange connection D
*) AL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 50C
TI 8707 YL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 60C

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item no. refer to Guidance Values Automation
121 15 27-9.2.0

Fig. 15.02.01: Exhaust gas pipes

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C, K98ME/MEC, S90MC-C/MEC,


K90MC-C, K90ME/MEC, S80MC/MC-C, S80MEC,
K80MC-C, K80MEC, S70MC/MC-C, S70MEC/MEGI,
MAN Diesel 198 40 709.3

L70MC-C, L70MEC, S60ME-C/ME-G, L60ME-C


MAN B&W 15.02
Page 1 of 3

Exhaust Gas Pipes


*)
TC 8702 I AH AL YH YL Cyl. 1

To scavenge air receiver

TI 8702 PI 8601

PI 8706

Exhaust gas receiver

Turbocharger

TI 8701

TC 8701 I AH YH ST 8801 I

Flange connection D
*) AL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 50C
TI 8707 YL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 60C

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item no. refer to Guidance Values Automation
121 15 27-9.2.0

Fig. 15.02.01a: Exhaust gas pipes, with turbocharger located on exhaust side of engine, option 4 59 122

ST 8801 IR Aft Fore

TI 8707 TI 8702

*)
TC 8702 I AH AL YH YL
Flange connection D

Exhaust gas receiver


Turbocharger

PI 8706 TI 8701

PI 8601 TC 8701 I AH YH

*) AL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 50C


To scavenge air receiver YL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 60C

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item no. refer to Guidance Values Automation
The piping is delivered with and fitted onto the engine
178 38 692.2

Fig.15.02.01b: Exhaust gas pipes, with turbocharger located on aft end of engine, option 4 59 124

MAN B&W S65MC-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC/60MC-C,


S60ME-B, L60MC-C MAN Diesel 198 64 029.1
MAN B&W 15.02
Page 1 of 3

Exhaust Gas Pipes

ST 8801 IR Aft Fore

TI 8707 TI 8702

*)
TC 8702 I AH AL YH YL
Flange connection D

Exhaust gas receiver


Turbocharger

PI 8706 TI 8701

PI 8601 TC 8701 I AH YH

*) AL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 50C


To scavenge air receiver YL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 60C

The letters refer to List of flanges


The position numbers refer to List of instruments
The piping is delivered with and fitted onto the engine 178 38 692.2

Fig.15.02.01a: Exhaust gas pipes, with turbocharger located on aft end of engine, option 4 59 121

*)
TC 8702 I AH AL YH YL Cyl. 1

To scavenge air receiver

TI 8702 PI 8601

PI 8706

Exhaust gas receiver

Turbocharger

TI 8701

TC 8701 I AH YH ST 8801 I

Flange connection D
*) AL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 50C
TI 8707 YL: Deviation alarm/Cylinder 60C

The letters refer to list of Counterflanges


The item no. refer to Guidance Values Automation
121 15 27-9.2.0

Fig. 15.02.01b: Exhaust gas pipes, with turbocharger located on exhaust side of engine, option 4 59 123

MAN B&W S50MC6, S50MC-C/MEC7/8, S50ME-B8/9,


S46MC-C7/8, S46ME-B8, S42MC7, S40ME-B9, S40MC-C9,
S35MC-C9, S35MC7, L35MC6, S35ME-B9, S26MC6
MAN Diesel 198 40 699.4
MAN B&W 15.02
Page 2 of 3

Cleaning Systems

PI 8804
AN

Compressor cleaning

MAN Diesel TCA turbocharger

To bedplate drain, AE

121 15 21-8.0.0

Fig. 15.02.02: MAN Diesel TCA turbocharger, water washing of turbine side

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C, K98ME/MEC, S90MC-C, S90MEC,


K90MC-C, K90ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C, S80MEC, K80MC-C,
K80MEC, S70MC, S/L70MC-C, S/L70MEC, S70MEGI,
MAN Diesel 198 40 710.5

S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC, S/L60MC-C, S/L60MEC,


S60ME-GI/ME-B
MAN B&W 15.02
Page 2 of 3

Cleaning Systems
Compressor cleaning

MAN Diesel TCA turbocharger

To bedplate drain, AE
178 61 90-0.0

Fig. 15.02.02: MAN Diesel TCA turbocharger, water washing of compressor side, option: 4 59 145

PI 8803
AP

Dry cleaning turbine side


Drain

ABB Turbocharger

Compressor cleaning

To bedplate drain, AE

178 61 87-7.0.0

Fig. 15.02.03: Soft blast cleaning of turbine side and water washing of compressor side for ABB turbochargers

MAN B&W S50MC6, S50MC-C/MEC7/8, S50ME-B8/9,


S46MC-C7/8, S46ME-B8, S42MC7, S40ME-B9, S40MC-C9,
S35MC-C9, S35MC7, L35MC6, S35ME-B9, S26MC6
MAN Diesel 198 79 164.0
MAN B&W 15.02
Page 3 of 3

Cleaning Systems

PI 8804

AN
Water inlet

Inlet valve
ABB TPL Turbocharger
Drain cock

Compressor cleaning

Water cleaning nozzle

To bedplate drain, AE
121 36 75-1.0.0

Fig. 15.02.03: Water washing of turbine and compressor sides for ABB, TPL turbochargers

PI 8803
AP

Drain
Dry cleaning turbine side

Scavenge air receiver

121 36 88-3.2.0

Fig. 15.02.04: Soft blast cleaning of turbine side

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C, K98ME/MEC, S90MC-C,


S90MEC, K90MC-C, K90ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C,
S80MEC, K80MC-C, K80MEC
MAN Diesel 198 40 722.3
MAN B&W 15.02
Page 3 of 3

Cleaning Systems

PI 8804

AN
Water inlet

Inlet valve
ABB TPL Turbocharger
Drain cock

Compressor cleaning

Water cleaning nozzle

To bedplate drain, AE
121 36 75-1.0.0

Fig. 15.02.03: Water washing of turbine and compressor sides for ABB, TPL turbochargers

PI 8803
AP

Drain
Dry cleaning turbine side

126 40 93-0.2.0

Fig. 15.02.04: Soft blast cleaning of turbine side

MAN B&W S70MC, S/L70MC-C, S/L70MEC, S70MEGI,


S65ME-C/ME-GI, S60MC, S/L60MC-C, S/L60MEC,
S60ME-GI/ME-B
MAN Diesel 198 40 734.7
MAN B&W 15.03
Page 1 of 1

Exhaust Gas System for Main Engine

At the specified MCR of the engine, the total In connection with dimensioning the exhaust gas
backpressure in the exhaust gas system after the piping system, the following parameters must be
turbocharger (as indicated by the static pressure observed:
measured in the piping after the turbocharger)
must not exceed 350 mm WC (0.035 bar). Exhaust gas flow rate
Exhaust gas temperature at turbocharger outlet
In order to have a backpressure margin for the Maximum pressure drop through exhaust gas
final system, it is recommended at the design system
stage to initially use a value of about 300 mm WC Maximum noise level at gas outlet to atmos-
(0.030 bar). phere
Maximum force from exhaust piping on
The actual backpressure in the exhaust gas turbocharger(s)
system at specified MCR depends on the gas Sufficient axial and lateral elongation ability of
velocity, i.e. it is proportional to the square of the expansion joints
exhaust gas velocity, and hence inversely propor- Utilisation of the heat energy of the exhaust gas.
tional to the pipe diameter to the 4th power. It has
by now become normal practice in order to avoid Items that are to be calculated or read from tables
too much pressure loss in the pipings to have an are:
exhaust gas velocity at specified MCR of about
35 m/sec, but not higher than 50 m/sec. Exhaust gas mass flow rate, temperature and max-
imum back pressure at turbocharger gas outlet
Diameter of exhaust gas pipes
Exhaust gas piping system for main engine Utilisation of the exhaust gas energy
Attenuation of noise from the exhaust pipe outlet
The exhaust gas piping system conveys the gas Pressure drop across the exhaust gas system
from the outlet of the turbocharger(s) to the at- Expansion joints.
mosphere.

The exhaust piping is shown schematically in


Fig. 15.04.01.

The exhaust system for the main engine com-


prises:

Exhaust gas pipes


Exhaust gas boiler
Silencer
Spark arrester (if needed)
Expansion joints (compensators)
Pipe bracings.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 39 058.2
MAN B&W 15.04
Page 1 of 2

Components of the Exhaust Gas System

Exhaust gas compensator after turbocharger It should be noted that the exhaust gas tempera-
ture and flow rate are influenced by the ambient
When dimensioning the compensator for the conditions, for which reason this should be con-
expansion joint on the turbocharger gas outlet sidered when the exhaust gas boiler is planned.
transition piece, the exhaust gas piece and com-
ponents are to be so arranged that the thermal At specified MCR, the maximum recommended
expansions are absorbed by expansion joints. The pressure loss across the exhaust gas boiler is nor-
heat expansion of the pipes and the components mally 150 mm WC.
is to be calculated based on a temperature in-
crease from 20 C to 250 C. This pressure loss depends on the pressure loss-
es in the rest of the system as mentioned above.
Therefore, if an exhaust gas silencer/spark arrest-
Exhaust gas boiler er is not installed, the acceptable pressure loss
across the boiler may be somewhat higher than
Engine plants are usually designed for utilisation the max. of 150 mm WC, whereas, if an exhaust
of the heat energy of the exhaust gas for steam gas silencer/spark arrester is installed, it may be
production or for heating the thermal oil system. necessary to reduce the maximum pressure loss.
The exhaust gas passes an exhaust gas boiler
which is usually placed near the engine top or in The above mentioned pressure loss across the
the funnel. exhaust gas boiler must include the pressure loss-
es from the inlet and outlet transition pieces.

D4

Exhaust gas outlet D0 Exhaust gas outlet


to the atmosphere to the atmosphere
Exhaust gas
Exhaust gas silencer
silencer

D4

D0

Slide support Exhaust gas


Exhaust gas boiler
Slide support boiler
Fixed support
D4
Fixed support
D0 Exhaust gas compensator
D4
Exhaust gas compensator
Transition piece

Turbocharger gas
outlet flange D0

Main engine with


turbocharger on aft end Main engine with turbochargers
on exhaust side

178 42 783.2 178 33 467.4

Fig. 15.04.01a: Exhaust gas system, one turbocharger Fig. 15.04.01b: Exhaust gas system, two or more TCs

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 39 071.2
MAN B&W 15.04
Page 2 of 2

Exhaust gas silencer Spark arrester

The typical octave band sound pressure levels To prevent sparks from the exhaust gas being
from the diesel engines exhaust gas system at a spread over deck houses, a spark arrester can be
distance of one meter from the top of the exhaust fitted as the last component in the exhaust gas
gas uptake are available on request. system.

The need for an exhaust gas silencer can be de- It should be noted that a spark arrester contrib-
cided based on the requirement of a maximum utes with a considerable pressure drop, which is
permissible noise level at a specific position. often a disadvantage.

The exhaust gas noise data is valid for an exhaust It is recommended that the combined pressure
gas system without boiler and silencer, etc. loss across the silencer and/or spark arrester
should not be allowed to exceed 100 mm WC at
The noise level is at nominal MCR at a distance of specified MCR. This depends, of course, on the
one metre from the exhaust gas pipe outlet edge pressure loss in the remaining part of the system,
at an angle of 30 to the gas flow direction. thus if no exhaust gas boiler is installed, 200 mm
WC might be allowed.
For each doubling of the distance, the noise level
will be reduced by about 6 dB (farfield law).

When the noise level at the exhaust gas outlet to


the atmosphere needs to be silenced, a silencer
can be placed in the exhaust gas piping system
after the exhaust gas boiler.

The exhaust gas silencer is usually of the absorp-


tion type and is dimensioned for a gas velocity of
approximately 35 m/s through the central tube of
the silencer.

An exhaust gas silencer can be designed based


on the required damping of noise from the ex-
haust gas given on the graph.

In the event that an exhaust gas silencer is re-


quired this depends on the actual noise level
requirement on the bridge wing, which is normally
maximum 6070 dB(A) a simple flow silencer of
the absorption type is recommended. Depending
on the manufacturer, this type of silencer nor-
mally has a pressure loss of around 20 mm WC at
specified MCR.

MAN B&W MC/ME Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 40 77-1.1
MAN B&W

Engine Control System


16
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 1 of 11

Engine Control System

The engine is provided with a pneumatic/electric Manoeuvring Consoles


manoeuvring and fuel oil regulating system, which
transmits orders from the separate manoeuvring The Engine Control System for the MC / MC-C
consoles to the engine. engine is prepared for conventional remote con-
trol, having an interface to the Bridge Control (BC)
By means of the regulating system it is possible system and the Engine Side Console (ESC).
to start, stop, reverse the engine and control the
engine speed. The speed setting device on the ma- The main Engine Control Room (ECR) manoeu-
noeuvring consoles gives a speed setting signal to vring console is to be located in the engine con-
the governor, dependent on the desired number of trol room. The console with buttons, lamps, etc.
rpm. recommended by MAN Diesel is shown in Fig.
16.01.07. Components for remote control for a
At shutdown, the fuel injection is stopped by typical installation with bridge control is shown in
activating the puncture valves in the fuel pumps, Fig. 16.01.05.
independent of the speed position of the speed
setting device. The layout of the Engine Side Console and instru-
ment panel is shown in Fig. 16.01.06a, b and c.
The layout of the Engine Control System is shown The console and an electronic speed setting
in Fig. 16.01.01 and a diagram of the pneumatic device, the governor, are located on the manoeu-
manoeuvring system in Fig. 16.01.02. vring side of the engine.

In the event of breakdown of the normal pneumat-


ic/electric manoeuvring system, the engine can be
operated from the Engine Side Console.
On Bridge
Bridge Control

In Engine Control Room

ECR panel

In Engine Room/On Engine

ESC Governor

Pressure transmitter for scavenge air Actuator for fuel pump

RPM pickups

178 58 06-8.0

Fig. 16.01.01: Engine Control System Layout

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 56 34-8.2
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 2 of 11

Diagram of Manoeuvring System

317 74 06-9.0.0

Fig. 16.01.02a: Diagram of manoeuvring system for reversible engine with FPP, slow turning and VIT

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C-TII, S90MC-C-TII, K90MC-C-TII,


S80MC/MC-C-TII, K80MC-C-TII, S70MC-TII, S/L70MC-C-TII,
S65MC-C-TII, S60MC-TII, S/L60MC-C-TII, S50MC/MC-C-TII
MAN Diesel 198 79 02-0.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 3 of 11

Manoeuvring System on Engine

The basic manoeuvring diagram is applicable for The slow turning valve diverts the starting air to
reversible engines, i.e. those with Fixed Pitch Pro- partially bypass the main starting valve. During
peller (FPP), and shown in Fig. 16.01.02. slow turning the engine will rotate so slowly that,
in the event that liquids have accumulated on the
The lever on the Engine Side Console can be set piston top, the engine will stop before any harm
to either Manual or Remote position, see Fig. occurs.
16.01.06a, b and c.

In the Manual position the engine is controlled Low load operation


from the Engine Side Console by the push
buttons START, STOP, and the AHEAD/ASTERN. For operation at low load, a cylinder cut-out sys-
The speed is set by the Manual speed setting by tem is provided on engine types 98, 90 and 80,
the handwheel. EoD: 4 65 255.

In the Remote position all signals to the engine


are electronic, the START, STOP, AHEAD and Control System for Plants with CPP
ASTERN signals activate the solenoid valves ZV applicable for engine types 70 and smaller
1137 C, ZV 1136 C, ZV 1141 C and ZV 1142 C re-
spectively, shown in Figs. 16.01.02 and 16.01.05, Where a controllable pitch propeller is installed,
and the speed setting signal via the electronic the control system is to be designed in such a way
governor and the actuator E 1182 C. that the operational requirements for the whole
plant are fulfilled.
The electrical signal comes from the remote con-
trol system, i.e. the Bridge Control (BC) console, Special attention should be paid to the actual op-
or from the Engine Control Room (ECR) console. eration mode, e.g. combinator curve with/without
constant frequency shaft generator or constant
engine speed with a power take off.
Shut down system
The following requirements have to be fulfilled:
The engine is stopped by activating the puncture
valve located in the fuel pump either at normal The control system is to be equipped with a
stopping or at shut down by activating solenoid load control function limiting the maximum
valve ZV 1103 C, see Fig. 16.01.02. torque (fuel pump index) in relation to the engine
speed, in order to prevent the engine from being
loaded beyond the limits of the load diagram
Slow turning
The control system must ensure that the engine
The standard manoeuvring system does not load does not increase at a quicker rate than
feature slow turning before starting, but for Unat- permitted by the scavenge air pressure
tended Machinery Spaces (UMS) we strongly rec-
ommend the addition of the slow turning device Load changes have to take place in such a way
shown in Fig. 16.01.02 as well as Fig. 16.01.03, that the governor can keep the engine speed
option: 4 50 140. within the required range.

Please contact the engine builder to get specific


data.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C, S90MC-C, K90MC-C,


S80MC/MC-C, K80MC-C, S70MC, S/L70MC-C,
S65MC-C, S60MC, S/L60MC-C, S50MC/MC-C
MAN Diesel 198 79 05-6.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 4 of 11

Sequence Diagram

MAN Diesels requirements for the control sys-


tem are indicated graphically in Fig. 16.01.08a,
Sequence diagram.

The diagram shows the functions as well as the


delays which must be considered in respect to
starting Ahead and starting Astern, as well as
for the activation of the slow down and shut down
functions.

On the right of the diagram, a situation is shown


where the order Astern is over-ridden by an
Ahead order the engine immediately starts
Ahead if the engine speed is above the specified
starting level.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 79 08-1.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 5 of 11

Starting Air System

ZS 1112 C

Service / Blocked

ZS 1111 C

A
ZS 1116 C
Main starting valve

ZS 1117 C

Slow turning
valve

16X2

16X2
28

ZV 1114 C Slow turning

Starting air
distributor

Starting valve

78

Pos. Qty. Description

Engine control
28 1 3/4-way solenoid valve
room console
78 1 Switch, yards supply

Additional components for slow turning are the slow turning valve in bypass and position nos. 28 and 78
The item No. refers to Guidance values automation
The letter refers to list of Counterflanges
The piping is delivered with and fitted onto the engine

178 58 11.5-0

Fig. 16.01.03: Starting air system, with slow turning, option: 4 50 140

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 79 08-1.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 6 of 11

Governor Parts and Mode of Operation

The engine is, as standard, provided with an elec- Governor for Conventional plants
tronic/mechanical type of fuel pump actuator of a
make approved by MAN Diesel. A typical example of a conventional marine in-
stallation is:
The speed setting of the actuator is determined by
an electronic signal from the electronic governor An engine directly coupled to a fixed pitch pro-
of a make approved by MAN Diesel. The actuator peller.
shaft is connected to the fuel regulating shaft by
means of a mechanical linkage. With a view to such an installation, the engine is,
as standard, equipped with a conventional elec-
When selecting the governor, the complexity of tronic governor with actuator of a make approved
the installation has to be considered. We normally by MAN Diesel, e.g.:
distinguish between conventional and advanced
marine installations. 4 65 172 Lyngs Marine

The governor consists of the following elements: 4 65 174 Kongsberg Maritime

Actuator 4 65 175 Nabtesco

Revolution transmitter (pick-ups) 4 65 176 Mitsui Zosen Systems Research

Electronic governor panel 4 65 177 Siemens.

Power supply unit


Governor for Advanced plants
Pressure transmitter for scavenge air.
For more advanced marine installations, such as,
The actuator, revolution transmitter and the pres- for example:
sure transmitter are mounted on the engine.
Plants with flexible coupling in the shafting sys-
The electronic governors must be tailor-made, tem
and the specific layout of the system must be mu-
tually agreed upon by the customer, the governor Geared installations
supplier and the engine builder.
Plants with disengageable clutch for discon-
It should be noted that the shut down system, the necting the propeller
governor and the remote control system must be
compatible if an integrated solution is to be ob- Plants with shaft generator with great require-
tained. ment for frequency accuracy.

The minimum speed is 20-25% of the engines


nominal speed when an electronic governor is ap-
plied.

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C, S90MC-C, K90MC-C,


S80MC/MC-C, K80MC-C, S70MC, S/L70MC-C,
S65MC-C, S60MC, S/L60MC-C, S50MC/MC-C
MAN Diesel 198 79 09-3.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 7 of 11

Governor and Remote Control Components

ual
Man ol
tr
con

r
erno
G ov o l
n t r
co

r ack
Fuel

ZS 1122 C

Actuator for fuel rack


E 1182 C Engine side handwheel

178 58 12-7.0

Fig. 16.01.04: Electronic governor

Remote

Manual
MIN
START

MAX
STOP

Telegraph
Control room
Ahead Astern
Bridge control
Astern
Ahead

Start
Stop
ZS 1140 C

ZS 709

ZS 708

PS 1134 C

ZS 1136 C
ZS 1108 C

ZS 1142 C

ZS 1137 C
ZS 1107 C

ZS 1141 C

178 58 13-9.0

Fig. 16.01.05: Components for remote control of reversible engine with FPP with bridge control

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 79 11-5.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 8 of 11

Engine Side Control Console with diagram

REMOTE

MANUAL
MAX

ASTERN

START

AHEAD
MIN

START STOP

STOP
STOP

178 58 15-2.0

Fig. 16.01.06a: Engine Side Control console, for reversible engine

REMOTE
AHEAD
MANUAL

START STOP ASTERN

PS 1106 C
*7
VIT
PS 1118 C 2 Ahead

1 3 Astern

Supply
4 Stop
PS 1118 C
5 Start

6 Remote

* Terminal 7 only connected on engines with VIT type fuel pumps

178 58 16-4.0

Fig. 16.01.06b: Diagram of Engine Side Control console

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 79 11-5.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 9 of 11

Engine Side Control Console and Instrument Panel

START

STOP

STOP
MAX

MIN
REM E EMERGENCY AH D ASTERN

START

STOP
Components included for: The instrument panel includes:

Fixed pitch propeller: For reversible engine:

Remote control manual engine side control Tachometer for engine

Ahead Astern handle Indication for engine side control

Start button Indication for control room control (remote)

Stop button Indication for bridge control (remote)

Indication for Ahead

Indication for Astern

Indication for auxiliary blower running

Indication and buzzer for wrong way alarm

Indication for turning gear engaged

Indication for Shut down

Push button for canceling Shut down, with indica-


tion

178 58 14-0.0

Fig. 16.01.06c: Engine Side Control console and instrument panel

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 79 11-5.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 10 of 11

Engine Control Room Console

6 10

178 58 17-6.0

1 Free space for mounting of safety panel 8 Switch and lamp for cancelling of limiters for
Engine builders supply governor
2 Tachometer(s) for turbocharger(s) 9 Engine control handle, option: 4 65 625 from engine
3 Indication lamps for: maker
Ahead * 10 Pressure gauges for:
Astern Scavenge air
Engine Side Control Lubricating oil, main engine
Control Room Control Cooling oil, main engine
Wrong way alarm Jacket cooling water
Turning gear engaged Sea cooling water
Main starting valve in service Lubricating oil, camshaft
Main starting valve in blocked mode Fuel oil before filter
Remote control Fuel oil after filter
Shut down Starting air
(Spare) Control air supply
Lamp test * 10 Thermometer:
4 Tachometer for main engine Jacket cooling water
5 Revolution counter Lubricating oil water
6 Switch and lamps for auxiliary blowers
7 Free spares for mounting of bridge control
equipment for main engine

Note: If an axial vibration monitor is ordered (option: 4 * These instruments have to be ordered as option:
31 116 ) the manoeuvring console has to be extended 4 75 645 and the corresponding analogue sensors on
by a remote alarm/slow down indication lamp. the engine as option: 4 75 128.

Fig. 16.01.07: Instruments and pneumatic components for Engine Control Room console, yards supply

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 79 11-5.0
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 11 of 11

Sequence diagram for engines with Fixed Pitch Propeller

178 58 22-3.0

Fig. 16.01.08a: Sequence diagram for fixed pitch propeller, MC/MC-C types 98-60

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C, S90MC-C, K90MC-C,


S80MC/MC-C, K80MC-C, S70MC, S/L70MC-C,
S65MC-C, S60MC, S/L60MC-C
MAN Diesel 198 66 37-8.1
MAN B&W 16.01
Page 11 of 11

Sequence diagram for engines with Fixed Pitch Propeller

178 58 18-8.0

Fig. 16.01.08a: Sequence diagram for fixed pitch propeller, MC/MC-C types 50-26

MAN B&W S50MC/MC-C, S46MC/C, S42MC, S40MC-C,


S/L35MC, S35MC-C, S26MC MAN Diesel 198 66 39-1.2
MAN B&W 16.02
Page 1 of 1

Controllable Pitch Propeller

This section is not applicable

for

98-80 MC/MC-C

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C, S90MC-C, K90MC-C,


S80MC-C, K80MC-C MAN Diesel 198 79 75-0.0
MAN B&W 16.02
Page 1 of 1

Controllable Pitch Propeller

This section is available on request

for

70-26 MC/MC-C

MAN B&W S/L70MC-C, S/L60MC-C, S50MC-C,


S46MC-C, S42MC, S40MC-C, S35MC/MC-C,
L35MC, S26MC
MAN Diesel 198 79 77-4.0
MAN B&W 16.03
Page 1 of 2

Engine Control System Interface to Surrounding Systems

To support the navigator, the vessels are equip For the safety system, a combined shut down
ped with a ship control system, which includes and slow down panel approved by MAN Diesel
subsystems to supervise and protect the main is available as an option in the Extent of Delivery,
propulsion engine. e.g.:

The monitoring systems and instrumentation are 4 75 610a Lyngs Marine


explained in detail in Chapter 18.
4 75 610b Kongsberg Maritime

Alarm system 4 75 610c Nabtesco

The alarm system has no direct effect on the En 4 75 610d Siemens


gine Control System (ECS). The alarm alerts the
operator of an abnormal condition. 4 75 610f Mitsui Zosen Systems Research.

The alarm system is an independent system, in Where separate shut down and slow down panels
general covering more than the main engine itself, are installed only panels approved by MAN Diesel
and its task is to monitor the service condition must be used.
and to activate the alarms if a normal service limit
is exceeded. In any case, the remote control system and the
safety system (shut down and slow down panel)
The signals from the alarm sensors can be used must be compatible.
for the slow down function as well as for remote
indication.
Telegraph system

Slow down system The telegraph system is an independent system.

The engine safety system is an independent sys This system enables the navigator to transfer the
tem with its respective sensors on the main en commands of engine speed and direction of rota
gine, fulfilling the requirements of the respective tion from the Bridge, the engine control room or
classification society and MAN Diesel. the Engine Side Console (ESC).

Safety system Remote Control system

The engine safety system is an independent sys The remote control system normally has two alter
tem with its respective sensors on the main en native control stations:
gine, fulfilling the requirements of the respective
classification society and MAN Diesel. the Bridge Control console
the Engine Control Room console
If a critical value is reached for one of the meas
uring points, the input signal from the safety The remote control system is to be delivered by a
system must cause either a cancellable or a supplier approved by MAN Diesel.
noncancellable shut down signal to the ECS.

The safety system is included as standard in the


extent of delivery.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 66 41-3.1
MAN B&W 16.03
Page 2 of 2

As an option in the Extent of Delivery, a bridge Auxiliary equipment system


control system from suppliers approved by MAN
Diesel is available: The input signals for Auxiliary system ready are
given partly based on the status for:
for Fixed Pitch propeller plants, e.g.:
fuel oil system
4 95 601 Lyngs Marine lube oil system
cooling water systems
4 95 606 Siemens
and partly from the ECS itself:
4 95 607 Nabtesco
turning gear disengaged
4 95 608 Mitsui Zosen Systems Research main starting valve in service position
control air valve for air spring open
4 95 615 Kongsberg Maritime auxiliary blowers running
control air valve open
and for Controllable Pitch propeller plants, e.g.: safety air valve open
governor in control
4 95 604 Lyngs Marine valve for starting air distributor open.

4 95 916 Kongsberg Maritime


Engine monitoring
4 95 619 MAN Diesel Alphatronic.
In order to assist the engineer in runnning the
diesel engine at its optimum performance, a MAN
Power Management system Diesels PMI system, type PT/S off-line or on-line
could be applied as an option.
The system handles the supply of electrical power
onboard, i.e. the starting and stopping of the gen The MAN Diesels PMI system, type PT/S off-line
erating sets as well as the activation / deactivation monitors engine parameters such as:
of the main engine Shaft Generator (SG), if fitted.
cylinder pressure
The normal function involves starting, synchro fuel oil injection pressure
nising, phasingin, transfer of electrical load and scavenge air pressure
stopping of the generators based on the electrical engine speed.
load of the grid on board.
This and other engine monitoring systems are fur
The activation / deactivation of the SG is to be ther explained in Chapter 18 in this Project Guide.
done within the engine speed range which fulfils
the specified limits of the electrical frequency.
Instrumentation

Chapter 18 includes lists of instrumentation for:

The CoCos-EDS on-line system


The class requirements and MAN Diesels re
quirements for alarms, slow down and shut down
for Unattended Machinery Spaces.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C engines


MAN Diesel 198 66 41-3.1
MAN B&W

Vibration Aspects

17
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W 17.01
Page 1 of 1

C C
Vibration Aspects

The vibration characteristics of the twostroke low A


speed diesel engines can for practical purposes
be split up into four categories, and if the adequate
countermeasures are considered from the early
project stage, the influence of the excitation sour
ces can be minimised or fully compensated. B

In general, the marine diesel engine may influence


the hull with the following:
External unbalanced moments
These can be classified as unbalanced 1st and
2nd order external moments, which need to be
considered only for certain cylinder numbers
Guide force moments D
Axial vibrations in the shaft system
Torsional vibrations in the shaft system.

The external unbalanced moments and guide force A Combustion pressure


moments are illustrated in Fig. 17.01.01. B Guide force
C Staybolt force
In the following, a brief description is given of their D Main bearing force
origin and of the proper countermeasures needed
to render them harmless.
1st order moment vertical 1 cycle/rev.
2nd order moment, vertical 2 cycle/rev.
External unbalanced moments

The inertia forces originating from the unbalanced


rotating and reciprocating masses of the engine
create unbalanced external moments although the 1st order moment, horizontal
external forces are zero. 1 cycle/rev.

Of these moments, the 1st order (one cycle per revo-


lution) and the 2nd order (two cycles per revolution)
need to be considered for engines with a low num
ber of cylinders. On 7cylinder engines, also the 4th
order external moment may have to be examined. Guide force moment,
The inertia forces on engines with more than 6 cylin H transverse Z cycles/rev.
ders tend, more or less, to neutralise themselves. Z is 1 or 2 times number of cylinder

Countermeasures have to be taken if hull resonance


occurs in the operating speed range, and if the vibra
tion level leads to higher accelerations and/or veloci
ties than the guidance values given by international
Guide force moment,
standards or recommendations (for instance related X transverse Z cycles/rev.
to special agreement between shipowner and ship Z = 1, 2, 3 ... 11, 12, 14
yard). The natural frequency of the hull depends
on the hulls rigidity and distribution of masses, 178 06 828.2
whereas the vibration level at resonance depends
mainly on the magnitude of the external moment Fig. 17.01.01: External unbalanced moments and guide
and the engines position in relation to the vibration force moments
nodes of the ship.

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 41 405.3
MAN B&W 17.02
Page 1 of 2

2nd Order Moments on 4, 5 and 6-cylinder Engines

The 2nd order moment acts only in the vertical Compensator solutions
direction. Precautions need only to be considered
for 4, 5 and 6-cylinder engines in general. Several solutions are available to cope with the
2nd order moment, as shown in Fig. 17.03.02, out
Resonance with the 2nd order moment may oc- of which the most cost efficient one can be cho-
cur in the event of hull vibrations with more than sen in the individual case.
3 nodes. Contrary to the calculation of natural
frequency with 2 and 3 nodes, the calculation of The information about compensator solutions is
the 4 and 5-node natural frequencies for the hull to be found in the Project Guide for the relevant
is a rather comprehensive procedure and often engine type.
not very accurate, despite advanced calculation
methods.
Determine the need
A 2nd order moment compensator comprises two
counterrotating masses running at twice the en- A decision regarding the vibrational aspects and
gine speed. the possible use of compensators must be taken
at the contract stage. If no experience is available
from sister ships, which would be the best basis
for deciding whether compensators are necessary
or not, it is advisable to make calculations to de-
Cycles/min. *) Natural frequency termine which of the solutions should be applied.
cycles/min.

300
If the compensator is initially omitted, measure-
ments taken during the sea trial, or later in service
S50MEC
250
and with fully loaded ship, will be able to show if a
compensator has to be fitted at all.
S60MEC 5n
200
od
e
S70MEC

S80MEC Preparation for compensators


S90MEC 150
4 no
de
If no calculations are available at the contract
100
3 n od stage, we advise to make preparations for the fit-
e
ting of an electrically driven moment compensator
50
2 n od in the steering compartment, see Section 17.03.
e
dwt
The information about preparation for compensa-
20,000 40,000 60,000 80,000 tors is to be found in the Project Guide for the rel-
*) Frequency of engine moment
evant engine type.
M2V = 2 x engine speed

178 60 917.0 Basic design regarding compensators

Fig. 17.02.01: Statistics of vertical hull vibrations in tank- The information is to be found in the Project Guide
ers and bulk carriers, example from S90-50ME-C for the relevant engine type.

The available options for 5 and 6-cylinder engines


are listed in the Extent of Delivery. For 4-cylinder
engines, the information is available on request.

MAN B&W Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 80 02-6.0
MAN B&W 17.02
Page 2 of 2

1st Order Moments on 4cylinder Engines

This section is only applicable for engines type Since resonance with both the vertical and the
70 and smaller. horizontal hull vibration mode is rare, the standard
engine is not prepared for the fitting of 1st order
1st order moments act in both vertical and hori- moment compensators.
zontal direction. For our twostroke engines with
standard balancing these are of the same magni- Data on 1st order moment compensators and
tudes. preparation as well as options in the Extent of De-
livery are available on request.
For engines with five cylinders or more, the 1st
order moment is rarely of any significance to the
ship. It can, however, be of a disturbing magnitude
in fourcylinder engines.

Resonance with a 1st order moment may occur Adjustable


for hull vibrations with 2 and/or 3 nodes. This counterweights
resonance can be calculated with reasonable ac-
curacy, and the calculation will show whether a
compensator is necessary or not on fourcylinder
engines. Aft

A resonance with the vertical moment for the 2 Fore


node hull vibration can often be critical, whereas
the resonance with the horizontal moment occurs
at a higher speed than the nominal because of the Fixed Adjustable
higher natural frequency of horizontal hull vibra- counterweights counterweights
tions.

Balancing 1st order moments

As standard, fourcylinder engines are fitted with


1st order moment balancers in shape of adjust-
able counterweights, as illustrated in Fig. 17.02.02.
Fixed
These can reduce the vertical moment to an insig- counterweights
nificant value (although, increasing correspond-
ingly the horizontal moment), so this resonance is
easily dealt with. A solution with zero horizontal
moment is also available.

1st order moment compensators

In rare cases, where the 1st order moment will


cause resonance with both the vertical and the
horizontal hull vibration mode in the normal speed
range of the engine, a 1st order compensator can 178 16 787.0

be introduced as an option, reducing the 1st order


moment to a harmless value. Fig. 17.02.02: Examples of counterweights

MAN B&W Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 80 02-6.0
MAN B&W 17.03
Page 1 of 2

Electrically Driven Moment Compensator

If it is decided not to use chain driven moment The decision whether or not to install compen-
compensators and, furthermore, not to prepare sators can be taken at a much later stage of a
the main engine for compensators to be fitted project, since no special version of the engine
later, another solution can be used, if annoying structure has to be ordered for the installation.
2nd order vibrations should occur: An electrically
driven moment compensator synchronised to the No preparation for a later installation nor an ex-
correct phase relative to the external force or mo- tra chain drive for the compensator on the fore
ment can neutralise the excitation. end of the engine is required. This saves the
cost of such preparation, often left unused.
This type of compensator needs an extra seating
fitted, preferably, in the steering gear room where Compensators could be retrofit, even on ships
vibratory deflections are largest and the effect of in service, and also be applied to engines with a
the compensator will therefore be greatest. higher number of cylinders than is normally con-
sidered relevant, if found necessary.
The electrically driven compensator will not give
rise to distorting stresses in the hull, but it is more The compensator only needs to be active at
expensive than the engine-mounted compensa- speeds critical for the hull girder vibration. Thus,
tors. It does, however, offer several advantages it may be activated or deactivated at specified
over the engine mounted solutions: speeds automatically or manually.

When placed in the steering gear room, the Combinations with and without moment com-
compensator is not as sensitive to the position- pensators are not required in torsional and axial
ing of the node as the compensators 2) and 3) vibration calculations, since the electrically
mentioned in Section 17.02. driven moment compensator is not part of the
mass-elastic system of the crankshaft.

Furthermore, by using the compensator as a vi-


bration exciter a ships vibration pattern can easily
be identified without having the engine running,
e.g. on newbuildings at an advanced stage of
construction. If it is verified that a ship does not
need the compensator, it can be removed and re-
used on another ship.

It is a condition for the application of the rotating


force moment compensator that no annoying lon-
gitudinal hull girder vibration modes are excited.
Based on our present knowledge, and confirmed
by actual vibration measurements onboard a ship,
we do not expect such problems.

Further to compensating 2nd order moments,


electrically driven moment compensators are also
available for balancing other forces and moments.
The available options are listed in the Extent of
178 57 45-6.0
Delivery.

Fig. 17.03.01: MAN Diesel 2nd order electrically driven moment compensator, separately mounted,
option: 4 31 255

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 42 221.5

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-B8, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC, S/L35MC, S26MC
MAN B&W 17.03
Page 2 of 2

Moment compensator Compensating moment


Aft end, option: 4 31 203 F2C x Lnode
outbalances M2V

2
M2V
2 Node AFT

F2C
Lnode

Moment from compensator


M2C reduces M2V

Moment compensator
Fore end, option: 4 31 213 M2V

M2C

2 2
Electrically driven moment compensator

Compensating moment
FD x Lnode
outbalances M2V

Centre line
crankshaft M2V
FD
Node Aft
3 and 4node vertical hull girder mode

L n
D od
4 Node e

3 Node

178 27 104.1

Fig. 17.03.02: Compensation of 2nd order vertical external moments

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C/ME/ME-C, S90MC-C/ME-C,


K90MC-C/ME/ME-C, S80MC/MC-C/ME-C, K80MC-C/ME-C,
S70MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI, L70MC-C/ME-C, S65ME-C/ME-GI,
MAN Diesel 198 42 221.5

S60MC/MC-C/ME-C/ME-GI/ME-B, L60MC-C/ME-C,
S50MC/MC-C/ME-B8, S46MC-C/ME-B, S42MC, S/L35MC, S26MC
MAN B&W 17.04
Page 1 of 2

Power Related Unbalance

To evaluate if there is a risk that 1st and 2nd or- Based on service experience from a great number
der external moments will excite disturbing hull of large ships with engines of different types and
vibrations, the concept Power Related Unbal- cylinder numbers, the PRUvalues have been
ance (PRU) can be used as a guidance, see classified in four groups as follows:
Tables 17.04.01a, b and c below.
PRU Nm/kW Need for compensator
___________
PRU = External moment
Nm/kW 0 - 60 Not relevant
Engine power
60 - 120 Unlikely
With the PRUvalue, stating the external moment 120 - 220 Likely
relative to the engine power, it is possible to give 220 - Most likely
an estimate of the risk of hull vibrations for a spe-
cific engine.

5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl. 10 cyl. 11 cyl. 12 cyl. 14 cyl.


S90MC-C8 5,270 kW/cyl at 78 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW N.a. 0.0 24.1 2.1 29.0 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW N.a. 169.7 27.2 0.0 36.9 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
S80MC-C8 4,180 kW/cyl at 78 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW N.a. 0.0 9.1 26.6 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW N.a. 142.8 35.5 0.0 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
S70MC-C8 3,270 kW/cyl at 91 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW 16.0 0.0 6.8 20.0 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW 184.5 107.0 26.6 0.0 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
S60MC-C8 2,380 kW/cyl at 105 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW 13.7 0.0 5.8 17.2 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW 158.7 92.0 22.9 0.0 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
S50MC-B8 1,660 kW/cyl at 127 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW 11.1 0.0 4.7 13.8 12.6 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW 127.5 74.0 18.4 0.0 16.1 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.

Based on external moments in layout point L1


N.a. Not applicable
*) Available on request
Data for 4-cylinder engines (ie. for types 70 and smaller) is available on request

Table 17.04.01a: Power Related Unbalance (PRU) values in Nm/kW for S-MCMC-C/engines

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 46 737.2
MAN B&W 17.04
Page 2 of 2

5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl. 10 cyl. 11 cyl. 12 cyl. 14 cyl.


L70MC-C8 3,270 kW/cyl at 108 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW 19.3 0.0 8.2 24.1 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW 200.1 116.0 28.9 0.0 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
L60MC-C8 2,340 kW/cyl at 123 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW 15.4 0.0 6.5 19.2 16.0 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW 159.6 92.5 23.0 0.0 26.4 N.a. N.a. N.a. N.a.

Based on external moments in layout point L1


N.a. Not applicable
*) Available on request
Data for 4-cylinder engines (ie. for types 70 and smaller) is available on request

Table 17.04.01b: Power Related Unbalence (PRU) values in Nm/kW for L-MCMC-C engines

5 cyl. 6 cyl. 7 cyl. 8 cyl. 9 cyl. 10 cyl. 11 cyl. 12 cyl. 14 cyl.


K98MC7 6,230 kW/cyl at 97 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW N.a. 0.0 14.4 6.1 20.4 15.4 2.0 0.0 5.7
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW N.a. 188.2 46.8 0.0 16.7 14.3 2.7 0.0 0.0
K98MC-C7 6,020 kW/cyl at 104 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW N.a. 0.0 14.8 6.3 20.9 15.7 2.0 0.0 5.8
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW N.a. 180.9 45.0 0.0 16.1 13.9 2.6 0.0 0.0
K90MC-C6 4,570 kW/cyl at 104 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW N.a. 0.0 15.4 45.3 41.4 1.7 0.4 0.0 N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW N.a. 175.9 43.7 0.0 38.3 1.2 0.8 0.0 N.a.
K80MC-C6 3,610 kW/cyl at 104 r/min
PRU acc. to 1st order, Nm/kW N.a. 0.0 12.2 35.9 32.8 1.4 0.5 0.0 N.a.
PRU acc. to 2nd order, Nm/kW N.a. 151.9 37.8 0.0 33.1 0.9 0.8 0.0 N.a.

Based on external moments in layout point L1


N.a. Not applicable
*) Available on request

Table 17.04.01c: Power Related Unbalance (PRU) values in Nm/kW for K-MC/MC-C engines

Calculation of External Moments

In the table at the end of this chapter, the exter-


nal moments (M1) are stated at the speed (n1) and
MCR rating in point L1 of the layout diagram.

For other speeds (nA), the corresponding external mo-


ments (MA) are calculated by means of the formula:
nA 2
MA = M1 x __ { }
n kNm
1

MAN B&W 98-50 MC/MC-C Engine Selection Guide


MAN Diesel 198 46 737.2
MAN B&W 17.05
Page 1 of 3

Guide Force Moments

The socalled guide force moments are caused We recommend using the hydraulic top bracing
by the transverse reaction forces acting on the which allow adjustment to the loading conditions
crossheads due to the connecting rod/crankshaft of the ship. Mechanical top bracings with stiff
mechanism. These moments may excite engine connections are available on request.
vibrations, moving the engine top athwartships
and causing a rocking (excited by Hmoment) or With both types of top bracing, the above-men-
twisting (excited by Xmoment) movement of the tioned natural frequency will increase to a level
engine as illustrated in Fig. 17.05.01. where resonance will occur above the normal en-
gine speed. Details of the top bracings are shown
The guide force moments corresponding to the in Chapter 05.
MCR rating (L1) are stated in Table 17.07.01.

Definition of Guide Force Moments


Top bracing
Over the years it has been discussed how to de-
The guide force moments are harmless except fine the guide force moments. Especially now that
when resonance vibrations occur in the engine/ complete FEMmodels are made to predict hull/
double bottom system. engine interaction, the propeller definition of these
moments has become increasingly important.
As this system is very difficult to calculate with the
necessary accuracy, MAN Diesel strongly recom-
mend, as standard, that top bracing is installed Htype Guide Force Moment (MH)
between the engines upper platform brackets
and the casing side. Each cylinder unit produces a force couple con-
sisting of:
The vibration level on the engine when installed in 1. A force at crankshaft level
the vessel must comply with MAN Diesel vibration 2. Another force at crosshead guide level. The po-
limits as stated in Fig. 17.05.02. sition of the force changes over one revolution
as the guide shoe reciprocates on the guide.

Htype Xtype

Top bracing level

Middle position of guide plane

Lz MH Lz DistX
L L Cyl.X M x
Crankshaft centre line

Lx Lx Engine seating level

Z X

178 06 816.4

Fig. 17.05.01: Htype and Xtype guide force moments

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 42 233.4
MAN B&W 17.05
Page 2 of 3

Vibration Limits Valid for Single Order Harmonics

m
m

m
10

1
5x10 2 mm/s


10
5
m
m
/s 2
10 2 mm/s

m
m
1
10
50mm/s

t
en
em

ac
0m

pl
/s

is
2
m

D
m
2

25mm/s
m
m
1

10
Velocity 4
m
m
/s 2
10 mm/s

m
m
2
10

Ac
ce
le
ra
tio
n

10
3
m
m
/s 2
1 mm/s
m
m
3
10

5x10 1 mm/s
60 100 10 1.000 10 6.000 c/min
m 2
m
m m
/s 2 /s 2

1 Hz 10 Hz Frequency 100 Hz

Zone : Acceptable
Zone : Vibration will not damage the main engine, however,
under adverse conditions, annoying/harmful vibration
responses may appear in the connected structures
Zone : Not acceptable
078 81 27-6.1

Fig.17.05.02: Vibration limits

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 42 233.4
MAN B&W 17.05
Page 3 of 3

As the deflection shape for the Htype is equal The Xtype guide force moment is then defined
for each cylinder the Nth order Htype guide force as:
moment for an Ncylinder engine with regular fir-
ing order is: MX = BiMoment/L [kNm]

N x MH(one cylinder) For modelling purpose the size of the four (4) forc-
es can be calculated:
For modelling purposes the size of the forces in
the force couple is: Force = MX /L X [kN]

Force = MH/L [kN] where:

where L is the distance between crankshaft level L X is the horizontal length between force points
and the middle position of the crosshead guide
(i.e. the length of the connecting rod.) Similar to the situation for the Htype guide force
moment, the forces may be applied in positions
As the interaction between engine and hull is at suitable for the FEM model of the hull. Thus the
the engine seating and the top bracing positions, forces may be referred to another vertical level L Z
this force couple may alternatively be applied in above crankshaft centre line. These forces can be
those positions with a vertical distance of (L Z). calculated as follows:
Then the force can be calculated as:
M xL
ForceZ = MH/L Z [kN] ForceZ, one point = _____
Lxx L
[kN]

Any other vertical distance may be applied, so as


to accomodate the actual hull (FEM) model. In order to calculate the forces it is necessary
to know the lengths of the connecting rods = L,
The force couple may be distributed at any which are:
number of points in the longitudinal direction. A
reasonable way of dividing the couple is by the
number of top bracing and then applying the forc- Engine Type L in mm
es at those points. K98MC6/7 3,220
K98MCC6/7 3,090
ForceZ, one point = ForceZ, total/Ntop bracing, total [kN]
S90MCC7/8 3,270
K90MC-C6 3,159
Xtype Guide Force Moment (MX ) S80MC6 3,504
S80MCC7/8 3,280
The Xtype guide force moment is calculated K80MCC6 2,920
based on the same force couple as described
S70MC6 3,066
above. However as the deflection shape is twist-
ing the engine each cylinder unit does not contrib- S70MCC7/8 2,870
ute with an equal amount. The centre units do not L70MCC7/8 2,660
contribute very much whereas the units at each S65MCC8 2,730
end contributes much. S60MC6 2,628
S60MCC7/8 2,460
A socalled Bimoment can be calculated (Fig.
L60MCC7/8 2,280
17.05.02):
S50MC6 2,190
Bimoment = [forcecouple(cyl.X) x distX] S50MCC7/8 2,050
in kNm2

MAN B&W K98MC/MC-C, S90MC-C, K90MC-C,


S80MC/MC-C, K80MC-C, S70MC/MC-C, L70MC-C,
S60MC/MC-C, L60MC-C, S50MC/MC-C
MAN Diesel 198 59 045.3
MAN B&W 17.06
Page 1 of 2

Axial Vibrations

When the crank throw is loaded by the gas pressure The socalled QPT (Quick Passage of a barred speed
through the connecting rod mechanism, the arms of range Technique), is an alternative to a torsional
the crank throw deflect in the axial direction of the vibration damper, on a plant equipped with a control-
crankshaft, exciting axial vibrations. Through the thrust lable pitch propeller. The QPT could be implemented
bearing, the system is connected to the ships hull. in the governor in order to limit the vibratory stresses
during the passage of the barred speed range.
Generally, only zeronode axial vibrations are of
interest. Thus the effect of the additional bending The application of the QPT, option: 4 31 108, has to
stresses in the crankshaft and possible vibrations of be decided by the engine maker and MAN Diesel
the ship`s structure due to the reaction force in the based on final torsional vibration calculations.
thrust bearing are to be consideraed.
Sixcylinder engines, require special attention. On
An axial damper is fitted as standard on all engines, min- account of the heavy excitation, the natural frequen-
imising the effects of the axial vibrations, EoD: 4 31 111. cy of the system with one-node vibration should
be situated away from the normal operating speed
range, to avoid its effect. This can be achieved by
Torsional Vibrations changing the masses and/or the stiffness of the
system so as to give a much higher, or much lower,
The reciprocating and rotating masses of the engine natural frequency, called undercritical or overcritical
including the crankshaft, the thrust shaft, the inter- running, respectively.
mediate shaft(s), the propeller shaft and the propeller
are for calculation purposes considered a system of Owing to the very large variety of possible shafting
rotating masses (inertias) interconnected by torsional arrangements that may be used in combination with
springs. The gas pressure of the engine acts through a specific engine, only detailed torsional vibration cal-
the connecting rod mechanism with a varying torque culations of the specific plant can determine whether
on each crank throw, exciting torsional vibration in or not a torsional vibration damper is necessary.
the system with different frequencies.

In general, only torsional vibrations with one and Undercritical running


two nodes need to be considered. The main critical
order, causing the largest extra stresses in the shaft The natural frequency of the one-node vibration is
line, is normally the vibration with order equal to the so adjusted that resonance with the main critical
number of cylinders, i.e., six cycles per revolution on order occurs about 3545% above the engine speed
a six cylinder engine. This resonance is positioned at at specified MCR.
the engine speed corresponding to the natural tor-
sional frequency divided by the number of cylinders. Such undercritical conditions can be realised by
choosing a rigid shaft system, leading to a relatively
The torsional vibration conditions may, for certain high natural frequency.
installations require a torsional vibration damper, op-
tion: 4 31 105. The characteristics of an undercritical system are
normally:
Plants with 11 or 12-cylinder engines type 98-80 re- Relatively short shafting system
quire a torsional vibration damper. Probably no tuning wheel
Turning wheel with relatively low inertia
Based on our statistics, this need may arise for the Large diameters of shafting, enabling the use of
following types of installation: shafting material with a moderate ultimate tensile
Plants with controllable pitch propeller strength, but requiring careful shaft alignment,
Plants with unusual shafting layout and for special (due to relatively high bending stiffness)
owner/yard requirements Without barred speed range.
Plants with 8cylinder engines.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/GI, ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 42 245.4
MAN B&W 17.06
Page 2 of 2

Critical Running

When running undercritical, significant varying Torsional vibrations in overcritical conditions may,
torque at MCR conditions of about 100150% of in special cases, have to be eliminated by the use
the mean torque is to be expected. of a torsional vibration damper.

This torque (propeller torsional amplitude) induces Overcritical layout is normally applied for engines
a significant varying propeller thrust which, under with more than four cylinders.
adverse conditions, might excite annoying longi-
tudinal vibrations on engine/double bottom and/or Please note:
deck house. We do not include any tuning wheel or torsional
vibration damper in the standard scope of supply,
The yard should be aware of this and ensure that as the proper countermeasure has to be found af-
the complete aft body structure of the ship, in- ter torsional vibration calculations for the specific
cluding the double bottom in the engine room, is plant, and after the decision has been taken if and
designed to be able to cope with the described where a barred speed range might be acceptable.
phenomena.
For further information about vibration aspects,
please refer to our publications:
Overcritical running
An Introduction to Vibration Aspects
The natural frequency of the onenode vibration
is so adjusted that resonance with the main criti- Vibration Characteristics of Two-stroke Engines
cal order occurs about 3070% below the engine
speed at specified MCR. Such overcritical con- The publications are available at
ditions can be realised by choosing an elastic www.mandieselturbo.com under Products
shaft system, leading to a relatively low natural Marine Engines & Systems Low Speed
frequency. Technical Papers.

The characteristics of overcritical conditions are:

Tuning wheel may be necessary on crankshaft


fore end

Turning wheel with relatively high inertia

Shafts with relatively small diameters, requiring


shafting material with a relatively high ultimate
tensile strength

With barred speed range, EoD: 4 07 015, of


about 10% with respect to the critical engine
speed.

MAN B&W MC/MC-C, ME/ME-C/MEB/GI engines


MAN Diesel 198 42 269.3
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, K98MC7 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14

1-9-13-8-
1-8-7-3- 1-5-11-6- 1-8-12-4-
1-5-3-4- 1-7-2-5-4- 1-8-3-4-7- 1-6-7-3-5- 4-3-10-
Firing type : 5-9-4-2- 2-7-9-4- 2-9-10-5-
2-6 3-6 2-5-6 8-2-4-9 14-6-2-7-
10-6 3-8-10 3-7-11-6
11-12-5

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 20 14 2 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 20 14 2 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 21 2 4 0 1
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 71 57 74 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 17 0 0 2 5 4 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 0 628 305 1,141 959 135 0 493
1. Order : Vertical a) 0 628 305 1,141 959 135 0 493
2. Order : Vertical 7,031 c) 2,041 0 938 889 183 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 328 932 379 465 752 835 656 0
6. Order : Vertical 0 1 0 82 41 6 0 0
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 2,398 1,764 1,257 645 236 188 209 242
2 x No. of cyl. 105 121 122 - - - - -
3 x No. of cyl. - - - - - - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 0 332 161 604 611 71 0 260
2. Order : 60 18 0 8 155 2 0 0
3. Order : 1,316 1,440 2,116 2,500 3,058 3,644 4,560 6,142
4. Order : 1,449 4,118 1,673 2,054 3,149 3,692 2,898 0
5. Order : 0 371 5,331 1,973 210 3,399 0 3,384
6. Order : 0 58 0 3,707 1,858 268 0 0
7. Order : 0 0 18 643 2,681 284 0 40
8. Order : 296 23 0 451 279 1,737 592 0
9. Order : 400 45 6 69 94 242 1,386 408
10. Order : 88 251 0 115 3 180 0 0
11. Order : 0 147 217 85 78 245 0 629
12. Order : 0 10 38 132 59 75 0 0
13. Order : 0 2 123 49 133 6 0 2
14. Order : 32 0 0 65 157 127 0 0
15. Order : 81 2 1 125 39 160 280 2
16. Order : 29 8 0 63 114 158 58 0

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the 2nd
order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W K98MC7


MAN Diesel 198 59 48-8.1
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, K98MC-C7 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14

1-9-13-8-
1-8-7-3- 1-5-11-6- 1-8-12-4-
1-5-3-4- 1-7-2-5-4- 1-8-3-4-7- 1-6-7-3-5- 4-3-10-
Firing type : 5-9-4-2- 2-7-9-4-3- 2-9-10-5-
2-6 3-6 2-5-6 8-2-4-9 14-6-2-7-
10-6 8-10 3-7-11-6
11-12-5

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 19 9 2 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 19 9 2 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 20 1 3 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 58 46 60 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 12 0 0 1 3 3 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 0 624 303 1,135 948 134 0 490
1. Order : Vertical a) 0 624 303 1,135 948 134 0 490
2. Order : Vertical 6,540 c) 1,899 0 873 840 170 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 267 758 308 378 613 680 533 0
6. Order : Vertical 0 1 0 59 29 4 0 0
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 2,148 1,573 1,112 556 197 175 246 297
2 x No. of cyl. 123 149 143 - - - - -
3 x No. of cyl. - - - - - - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 0 306 148 556 562 66 0 239
2. Order : 43 12 0 6 153 1 0 0
3. Order : 1,432 1,566 2,302 2,720 3,275 3,964 4,960 6,681
4. Order : 1,400 3,980 1,617 1,985 3,046 3,569 2,801 0
5. Order : 0 345 4,967 1,838 195 3,166 0 3,153
6. Order : 0 54 0 3,461 1,734 250 0 0
7. Order : 0 0 17 598 2,493 264 0 37
8. Order : 273 21 0 415 257 1,600 545 0
9. Order : 359 40 5 62 84 218 1,245 367
10. Order : 76 217 0 99 3 157 0 0
11. Order : 0 143 210 83 75 237 0 611
12. Order : 0 12 47 162 73 93 0 0
13. Order : 0 3 161 65 173 8 0 2
14. Order : 42 0 0 84 202 163 0 0
15. Order : 100 3 1 155 49 199 348 2
16. Order : 35 10 0 76 138 192 70 0

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the 2nd
order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W K98MC-C7


MAN Diesel 198 59 27-3.0
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, S90MC-C8 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 6 7 8 9

Firing type : 1-5-3-4-2-6 1-7-2-5-4-3-6 1-8-3-4-7-2-5-6 1-6-7-3-5-8-2-4-9

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 28 0 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 0 889 88 1,374
1. Order : Vertical a) 0 889 88 1,374
2. Order : Vertical 5,370 c) 1,005 0 1,753
4. Order : Vertical 362 1,205 417 520
6. Order : Vertical 0 4 0 132
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 2,927 2,150 1,520 930
2 x No. of cyl. 113 151 153 -
3 x No. of cyl. - - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 0 709 70 1,097
2. Order : 806 151 0 263
3. Order : 1,507 1,933 2,451 2,953
4. Order : 1,477 4,923 1,706 2,126
5. Order : 0 254 5,734 1,953
6. Order : 0 143 0 4,216
7. Order : 0 58 9 170
8. Order : 322 55 0 86
9. Order : 456 33 3 59
10. Order : 102 338 0 27
11. Order : 0 183 232 18
12. Order : 0 6 37 163
13. Order : 0 5 134 46
14. Order : 37 4 0 53
15. Order : 90 6 1 177
16. Order : 33 6 0 11
a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the 2nd
order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W S90MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 29-7.1
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, K90MC-C6 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

1-5-11-6- 1-8-12-4-2-
1-7-2-5-4- 1-8-3-4-7- 1-6-7-3-5- 1-8-7-3-5-
Firing type : 1-5-3-4-2-6 2-7-9-4-3- 9-10-5-3-7-
3-6 2-5-6 8-2-4-9 9-4-2-10-6
8-10 11-6

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 0 2 2 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 2 2 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 0 3 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 51 42 0
6. Order : Vertical 7 0 0 0 0 2 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 0 493 1,654 1,700 76 20 0
1. Order : Vertical a) 0 493 1,654 1,700 76 20 0
2. Order : Vertical 4,817 c) 1,398 0 1,572 53 42 0
4. Order : Vertical 171 486 197 246 343 441 342
6. Order : Vertical 0 1 0 34 22 2 0
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 1,492 1,058 743 393 79 105 162
2 x No. of cyl. 81 88 82 - - - -
3 x No. of cyl. - - - - - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 0 221 742 762 34 9 0
2. Order : 96 28 0 31 1 1 0
3. Order : 1,012 1,107 1,419 1,991 2,177 2,835 3,545
4. Order : 938 2,667 1,083 1,351 1,881 2,421 1,877
5. Order : 0 225 2,820 1,115 443 2,074 0
6. Order : 0 34 0 2,233 1,455 161 0
7. Order : 0 0 69 87 1,598 163 0
8. Order : 163 13 0 43 179 968 326
9. Order : 200 22 20 27 67 121 699
10. Order : 39 112 0 10 126 81 0
11. Order : 0 77 99 9 98 129 0
12. Order : 0 7 27 121 49 56 0
13. Order : 0 2 79 31 48 5 0
14. Order : 22 0 0 32 52 88 0
15. Order : 53 2 5 105 46 107 186
16. Order : 18 5 0 6 58 100 36

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the 2nd
order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W K90MC-C6


MAN Diesel 198 59 31-1.0
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, S80MC-C8 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 6 7 8

Firing type : 1-5-3-4-2-6 1-7-2-5-4-3-6 1-8-3-4-7-2-5-6

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 21 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 0 266 891
1. Order : Vertical a) 0 266 891
2. Order : Vertical 3,583 c) 1,040 0
4. Order : Vertical 242 687 279
6. Order : Vertical 0 1 0
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 2,338 1,742 1,234
2 x No. of cyl. 177 211 -
3 x No. of cyl. - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 0 216 723
2. Order : 616 179 0
3. Order : 1,165 1,274 1,633
4. Order : 1,050 2,984 1,212
5. Order : 0 276 3,458
6. Order : 0 45 0
7. Order : 0 0 97
8. Order : 232 18 0
9. Order : 334 37 33
10. Order : 81 230 0
11. Order : 0 161 206
12. Order : 0 13 51
13. Order : 0 3 158
14. Order : 45 0 0
15. Order : 108 3 11
16. Order : 38 11 0

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the 2nd
order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W S80MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 32-0.0
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, K80MC-C6 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

1-5-11-6- 1-8-12-4-2-
1-7-2-5-4- 1-8-3-4-7- 1-6-7-3-5- 1-8-7-3-5-
Firing type : 1-5-3-4-2-6 2-7-9-4-3- 9-10-5-3-7-
3-6 2-5-6 8-2-4-9 9-4-2-10-6
8-10 11-6

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 0 1 1 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 1 1 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 0 2 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 47 38 0
6. Order : Vertical 8 0 0 0 0 2 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 0 309 1,037 1,066 49 19 0
1. Order : Vertical a) 0 309 1,037 1,066 49 19 0
2. Order : Vertical 3,288 c) 954 0 1,073 32 33 0
4. Order : Vertical 138 393 160 199 278 357 276
6. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 29 21 2 0
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 1,248 885 623 336 68 98 154
2 x No. of cyl. 77 77 70 - - - -
3 x No. of cyl. - - - - - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 0 164 552 567 26 10 0
2. Order : 146 42 0 48 1 1 0
3. Order : 822 899 1,153 1,424 1,771 2,306 2,883
4. Order : 732 2,080 845 1,054 1,470 1,890 1,464
5. Order : 0 178 2,236 884 352 1,646 0
6. Order : 0 27 0 1,581 1,171 130 0
7. Order : 0 0 55 70 1,287 132 0
8. Order : 132 10 0 35 144 782 263
9. Order : 164 18 16 0 55 99 574
10. Order : 33 92 0 9 104 67 0
11. Order : 0 69 89 8 88 116 0
12. Order : 0 6 25 98 45 51 0
13. Order : 0 1 69 27 42 4 0
14. Order : 18 0 0 27 44 73 0
15. Order : 45 1 4 78 39 90 157
16. Order : 15 4 0 5 48 83 30

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the 2nd
order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W K80MC-C6


MAN Diesel 198 59 34-4.0
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, S70MC-C8 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 5 6 7 8

Firing type : 1-4-3-2-5 1-5-3-4-2-6 1-7-2-5-4-3-6 1-8-3-4-7-2-5-6

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 0 15 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 261 0 156 522
1. Order : Vertical a) 261 0 156 522
2. Order : Vertical 3,016 c) 2,098 c) 609 0
4. Order : Vertical 18 141 402 163
6. Order : Vertical 1 0 1 0
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 2,084 1532 1139 820
2 x No. of cyl. 169 72 83 85
3 x No. of cyl. 57 - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 225 0 134 449
2. Order : 692 481 140 0
3. Order : 493 891 974 1,249
4. Order : 87 674 1,914 778
5. Order : 0 0 174 2,181
6. Order : 48 0 28 0
7. Order : 336 0 0 61
8. Order : 212 147 11 0
9. Order : 11 211 24 21
10. Order : 0 49 138 0
11. Order : 4 0 81 104
12. Order : 25 0 5 20
13. Order : 22 0 1 56
14. Order : 2 17 0 0
15. Order : 0 43 1 4
16. Order : 2 15 4 0

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 5 and 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the
2nd order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W S70MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 35-6.0
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, L70MC-C8 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 5 6 7 8

Firing type : 1-4-3-2-5 1-5-3-4-2-6 1-7-2-5-4-3-6 1-8-3-4-7-2-5-6

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 0 11 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 315 0 188 630
1. Order : Vertical a) 315 0 188 630
2. Order : Vertical 3,272 c) 2,276 c) 661 0
4. Order : Vertical 16 124 353 143
6. Order : Vertical 1 0 1 0
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 1,704 1,233 913 636
2 x No. of cyl. 125 67 82 79
3 x No. of cyl. 54 - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 210 0 125 420
2. Order : 382 266 77 0
3. Order : 383 692 757 971
4. Order : 79 609 1,731 703
5. Order : 0 0 153 1,923
6. Order : 41 0 25 0
7. Order : 291 0 0 52
8. Order : 177 123 10 0
9. Order : 8 170 19 17
10. Order : 0 39 110 0
11. Order : 3 0 68 87
12. Order : 25 0 5 20
13. Order : 25 0 1 62
14. Order : 2 18 0 0
15. Order : 0 44 1 4
16. Order : 2 15 4 0

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 5 and 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the
2nd order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W L70MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 38-1.0
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, S60MC-C8 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 5 6 7 8

Firing type : 1-4-3-2-5 1-5-3-4-2-6 1-7-2-5-4-3-6 1-8-3-4-7-2-5-6

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 0 11 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 163 0 97 326
1. Order : Vertical a) 163 0 97 326
2. Order : Vertical 1,884 c) 1,311 c) 380 0
4. Order : Vertical 11 88 251 102
6. Order : Vertical 1 0 0 0
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 1,312 964 717 516
2 x No. of cyl. 107 45 52 54
3 x No. of cyl. 36 - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 140 0 83 279
2. Order : 438 305 89 0
3. Order : 315 570 623 799
4. Order : 55 425 1,208 491
5. Order : 0 0 109 1,373
6. Order : 30 0 18 0
7. Order : 212 0 0 38
8. Order : 133 93 7 0
9. Order : 7 133 15 13
10. Order : 0 31 87 0
11. Order : 2 0 51 65
12. Order : 16 0 3 13
13. Order : 14 0 1 35
14. Order : 1 11 0 0
15. Order : 0 27 1 3
16. Order : 1 10 3 0

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 5 and 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the
2nd order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W S60MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 40-3.0
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, L60MC-C8 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 5 6 7 8 9

1-9-2-5-7-3-6-
Firing type : 1-4-3-2-5 1-5-3-4-2-6 1-7-2-5-4-3-6 1-8-3-4-7-2-5-6
4-8

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 0 7 0 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 180 0 107 360 338
1. Order : Vertical a) 180 0 107 360 338
2. Order : Vertical 1,870 c) 1,301 c) 378 0 557
4. Order : Vertical 9 71 201 82 297
6. Order : Vertical 1 0 0 0 9
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 1,066 774 575 401 239
2 x No. of cyl. 79 42 52 50 -
3 x No. of cyl. 34 - - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 129 0 77 257 241
2. Order : 325 226 66 0 97
3. Order : 294 532 582 746 446
4. Order : 51 390 1,108 450 1,632
5. Order : 0 0 96 1,204 1,383
6. Order : 26 0 15 0 436
7. Order : 183 0 0 33 54
8. Order : 112 78 6 0 19
9. Order : 5 107 12 11 0
10. Order : 0 24 69 0 6
11. Order : 2 0 43 55 6
12. Order : 16 0 3 13 24
13. Order : 15 0 1 39 45
14. Order : 1 11 0 0 48
15. Order : 0 28 1 3 23
16. Order : 1 10 3 0 4

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 5 and 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the
2nd order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W L60MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 42-7.0
MAN B&W 17.07
Page  of 1

External Forces and Moments, S50MC-C8 Layout point L1 - SFOC

No of cylinder : 5 6 7 8 9

1-6-7-3-5-8-2-
Firing type : 1-4-3-2-5 1-5-3-4-2-6 1-7-2-5-4-3-6 1-8-3-4-7-2-5-6
4-9

External forces [kN] :


1. Order : Horizontal 0 0 0 0 0
1. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 0
2. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 0
4. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 0
6. Order : Vertical 0 7 0 0 0
External moments [kNm] :
1. Order : Horizontal a) 92 0 55 183 188
1. Order : Vertical a) 92 0 55 183 188
2. Order : Vertical 1,060 c) 738 c) 214 0 241
4. Order : Vertical 6 50 141 57 72
6. Order : Vertical 0 0 0 0 16
Guide force H-moments in [kNm] :
1 x No. of cyl. 758 558 415 299 185
2 x No. of cyl. 62 26 30 31 -
3 x No. of cyl. 21 - - - -
Guide force X-moments in [kNm] :
1. Order : 79 0 47 159 163
2. Order : 264 184 53 0 60
3. Order : 192 348 380 487 602
4. Order : 32 247 703 285 356
5. Order : 0 0 63 793 313
6. Order : 17 0 10 0 601
7. Order : 122 0 0 22 28
8. Order : 77 54 4 0 14
9. Order : 4 77 9 8 0
10. Order : 0 18 50 0 5
11. Order : 1 0 30 38 3
12. Order : 9 0 2 7 28
13. Order : 8 0 0 20 8
14. Order : 1 6 0 0 9
15. Order : 0 16 0 2 27
16. Order : 1 6 2 0 2

a) 1st order moments are, as standard, balanced so as to obtain equal values for horizontal and vertical moments for
all cylinder numbers.

c) 5 and 6-cylinder engines can be fitted with 2nd order moment compensators on the aft and fore end, reducing the
2nd order external moment.

Table 17.07.01

MAN B&W S50MC-C8


MAN Diesel 198 59 44-0.0
MAN B&W

Appendix

A
MAN Diesel
MAN B&W Appendix A
Page 1 of 3

Symbols for Piping

No. Symbol Symbol designation No. Symbol Symbol designation

1 General conventional symbols 2.14 Spectacle flange

1.1 Pipe 2.15 Bulkhead fitting water tight, flange

1.2 Pipe with indication of direction of flow 2.16 Bulkhead crossing, nonwatertight

1.3 Valves, gate valves, cocks and flaps 2.17 Pipe going upwards

1.4 Appliances 2.18 Pipe going downwards

1.5 Indicating and measuring instruments 2.19 Orifice

2 Pipes and pipe joints 3 Valves, gate valves, cocks and flaps

2.1 Crossing pipes, not connected 3.1 Valve, straight through

2.2 Crossing pipes, connected 3.2 Valves, angle

2.3 Tee pipe 3.3 Valves, three way

2.4 Flexible pipe 3.4 Nonreturn valve (flap), straight

2.5 Expansion pipe (corrugated) general 3.5 Nonreturn valve (flap), angle

Nonreturn valve (flap), straight, screw


2.6 Joint, screwed 3.6
down

Nonreturn valve (flap), angle, screw


2.7 Joint, flanged 3.7
down

2.8 Joint, sleeve 3.8 Flap, straight through

2.9 Joint, quickreleasing 3.9 Flap, angle

2.10 Expansion joint with gland 3.10 Reduction valve

2.11 Expansion pipe 3.11 Safety valve

2.12 Cap nut 3.12 Angle safety valve

2.13 Blank flange 3.13 Selfclosing valve

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 662.3
MAN B&W Appendix A
Page 2 of 3

No. Symbol Symbol designation No. Symbol Symbol designation

3.14 Quickopening valve 4 Control and regulation parts

3.15 Quickclosing valve 4.1 Handoperated

3.16 Regulating valve 4.2 Remote control

3.17 Kingston valve 4.3 Spring

3.18 Ballvalve (cock) 4.4 Mass

3.19 Butterfly valve 4.5 Float

3.20 Gate valve 4.6 Piston

3.21 Doubleseated changeover valve 4.7 Membrane

3.22 Suction valve chest 4.8 Electric motor

Suction valve chest with nonreturn


3.23 4.9 Electromagnetic
valves

Doubleseated changeover valve,


3.24 5 Appliances
straight

3.25 Doubleseated changeover valve, angle 5.1 Mudbox

3.26 Cock, straight through 5.2 Filter or strainer

3.27 Cock, angle 5.3 Magnetic filter

3.28 Cock, threeway, Lport in plug 5.4 Separator

3.29 Cock, threeway, Tport in plug 5.5 Steam trap

3.30 Cock, fourway, straight through in plug 5.6 Centrifugal pump

3.31 Cock with bottom connection 5.7 Gear or screw pump

Cock, straight through, with bottom


3.32 5.8 Hand pump (bucket)
conn.

3.33 Cock, angle, with bottom connection 5.9 Ejector

Cock, threeway, with bottom connec-


3.34 5.10 Various accessories (text to be added)
tion

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 662.3
MAN B&W Appendix A
Page 3 of 3

No. Symbol Symbol designation No. Symbol Symbol designation

Indicating instruments with ordinary


5.11 Piston pump 7
symbol designations

6 Fittings 7.1 Sight flow indicator

6.1 Funnel 7.2 Observation glass

6.2 Bellmounted pipe end 7.3 Level indicator

6.3 Air pipe 7.4 Distance level indicator

6.4 Air pipe with net 7.5 Counter (indicate function)

6.5 Air pipe with cover 7.6 Recorder

6.6 Air pipe with cover and net

6.7 Air pipe with pressure vacuum valve

Air pipe with pressure vacuum valve with


6.8
net

6.9 Deck fittings for sounding or filling pipe

Short sounding pipe with selfclosing


6.10
cock

6.11 Stop for sounding rod

The symbols used are in accordance with ISO/R 5381967, except symbol No. 2.19

178 30 614.1

Fig. A.01.01: Symbols for piping

MAN B&W MC/MCC, ME/MEC/MEGI/ME-B engines


MAN Diesel 198 38 662.3

Você também pode gostar